a05b41b40aa8e66140ca291f03b6b4896d5b6240
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.85"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 .new
1990 Exim used to
1991 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1992 withdrawn.
1993 .wen
1994
1995
1996
1997 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1998 .cindex "lookup modules"
1999 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2000 .cindex ".so building"
2001 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2002 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2003 on demand.
2004 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2005 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2006 dependencies.
2007 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2008
2009 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2010 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2011 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2012 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2013 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2014 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2015
2016 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2017 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2018 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2019 on demand:
2020 .code
2021 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2022 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2023 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2024 .endd
2025
2026
2027 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2028 .cindex "build directory"
2029 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2030 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2031 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2032 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2033 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2034 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2035 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2036
2037 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2038 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2039 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2040 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2041 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2042 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2043 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2044 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2045
2046 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2047 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2048 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2049
2050
2051
2052 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2053 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2054 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2055 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2056 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2057 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2058 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2059 .code
2060 FULLECHO='' make -e
2061 .endd
2062 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2063 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2064 given in addition to the short output.
2065
2066
2067
2068 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2069 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2070 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2071 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2072 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2073 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2074 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2075 order:
2076 .display
2077 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2078 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile_&
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2084 .endd
2085 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2086 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2088 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2089 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2090 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2091 and are often not needed.
2092
2093 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2094 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2095 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2096 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2097 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2098 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2099 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2100 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2101 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2102
2103
2104 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2105 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2106 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2107 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2108 default values are.
2109
2110
2111 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2112 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2113 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2114 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2115 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2116 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2117 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2118 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2119 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2120 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2121 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2122 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2123 containing the lines
2124 .code
2125 CC=cc
2126 CFLAGS=-std1
2127 .endd
2128 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2129 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2130
2131 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2132 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2133 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2134
2135
2136 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2140 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2141 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2142 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2143 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2144 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2145 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2146 .code
2147 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2148 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2149 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2150 .endd
2151 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2152 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2153 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2154 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2155 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2156 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2157 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2158 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2159 errors.
2160
2161 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2163 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2164 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2165 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2166 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2167 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2168 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2169 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2170 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2171 syntax. For instance:
2172 .code
2173 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2175 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2176 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2177 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2179 .endd
2180
2181 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2182 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2183 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2184 .code
2185 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2186 .endd
2187 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2188 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2189
2190 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2191 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2192 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2193 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2194 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2195 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2196 .code
2197 X11=/usr/X11R6
2198 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2199 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2200 .endd
2201 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2202 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2203 .code
2204 X11=/usr/openwin
2205 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2206 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2207 .endd
2208 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2209 definition of all three of these variables into your
2210 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2211
2212 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2213 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2214 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2215 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2216 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2217
2218 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2219 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2220 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2221 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2222 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2223 libraries.
2224
2225 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2226 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2227 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2228 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2229 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2230
2231
2232 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2233 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2234 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2235 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2236 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2237 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2238 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2239 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2240
2241
2242
2243 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2244 .cindex "building Eximon"
2245 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2246 where the files that are involved are
2247 .display
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2254 .endd
2255 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2256 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2257 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2259 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2260 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2261 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2262 .ecindex IIDbuex
2263
2264
2265 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2266 .cindex "installing Exim"
2267 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2268 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2269 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2270 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2271 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2272 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2273 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2274 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2275 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2276 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2277 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2278 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2279
2280 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2281 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2282 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2283 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2284 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2285 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2286 alternative files, no default is installed.
2287
2288 .cindex "system aliases file"
2289 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2290 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2291 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2292 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2293 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2294 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2295 and outputs a comment to the user.
2296
2297 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2298 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2299 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2300 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2301 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2302
2303 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2304 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2305 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2306 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2307 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2308 over SMTP.
2309
2310 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2311 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2312 command such as
2313 .code
2314 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2315 .endd
2316 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2317 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2318 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2319 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2320 but this usage is deprecated.
2321
2322 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2323 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2324 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2325 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2326 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2327 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2328
2329 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2330 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2331 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2332 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2333 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2334 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2335 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2336
2337 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2338 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2339 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2340 command:
2341 .code
2342 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2343 .endd
2344 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2345 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2346 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2347 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2348 command:
2349 .code
2350 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2351 .endd
2352 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2353 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2354
2355 .ilist
2356 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2357 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2358 .next
2359 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2360 installed binary.
2361 .endlist
2362
2363 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2364 .code
2365 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2366 .endd
2367 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2368 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2369 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2370 .code
2371 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2372 .endd
2373
2374
2375
2376 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2377 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2378 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2379 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2380 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2381 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2382
2383 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2384 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2385 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2386
2387
2388
2389 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2390 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2391 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2392 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2393 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2394 necessary.
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2400 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2401 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2402 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2403 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2404 .code
2405 exim -bV
2406 .endd
2407 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2408 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2409 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2410 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2411 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2412 example,
2413 .display
2414 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2415 .endd
2416 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2417 .display
2418 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2419 .endd
2420 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2421 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2422 user agent. For example:
2423 .code
2424 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 From: user@your.domain.example
2426 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2427 Subject: Testing Exim
2428
2429 This is a test message.
2430 ^D
2431 .endd
2432 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2433 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2434 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2435
2436 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2437 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2438 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2439 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2440 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2441 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2442 .display
2443 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2444 .endd
2445 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2446 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2447 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2448 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2449 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2450
2451 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2452 .cindex "lock files"
2453 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2454 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2455 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2456 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2457 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2458 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2459 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2460 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2461 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2462 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2463 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2464 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2465
2466 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2467 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2468 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2469 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2470 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2471 incoming SMTP mail.
2472
2473 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2474 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2475 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2476 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2477 production version.
2478
2479
2480 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2481 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2482 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2483 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2484 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2485 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2486 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2487 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2488 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2489 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2490 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2491 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2492 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2493
2494 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2495 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2496 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2497 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2498 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2499 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2500 as follows:
2501 .code
2502 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2503 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2505 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2506 .endd
2507 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2508 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2509 favourite user agent.
2510
2511 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2512 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2513 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2514 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2515 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2516 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2517
2518
2519
2520 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2521 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2522 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2523 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2524 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2525 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2526 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2527 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2528 configuration file.
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2534 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2535 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2536 .code
2537 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2538 .endd
2539 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2540 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2541 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2542 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2543 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2544 .code
2545 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2546 .endd
2547 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2548
2549 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2550 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2551 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558
2559 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2560 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2561 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2562 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2563 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2564 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2565 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2566 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2567 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2568
2569
2570 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2571 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2573 were present before any other options.
2574 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2575 standard output.
2576 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2577 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2578 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2579
2580 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2581 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2582 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2583 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2584 format.
2585
2586 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2588 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2589 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2590
2591 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2592 .cindex "queue runner"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2595 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2596
2597 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2598 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2599 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2600 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2601 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2602 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2603 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2604 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2605
2606
2607 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2608 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2609 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2610 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2611 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2612 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2613
2614 .ilist
2615 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2616 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2617 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2618 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2619 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2620 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2621
2622 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2623 .cindex "envelope sender"
2624 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2625 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2626 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2627 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2628 users to set envelope senders.
2629
2630 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2631 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2632 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2633 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2634 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2635
2636 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2637 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2638 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2639 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2640 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2641 that are available to trusted users.
2642 .next
2643 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2644 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2645 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2646 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2647 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2648
2649 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2650 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2651 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2652 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2653
2654 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2655 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2656 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2657 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2658
2659 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2660 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2661 false.
2662 .endlist
2663
2664
2665 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2666 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2667 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2668 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2674 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2675 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2676 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2677 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2678 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2679 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2680 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2681
2682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2683 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2684 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2685 . creates a man page for the options.
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2687
2688 .literal xml
2689 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2690 .literal off
2691
2692
2693 .vlist
2694 .vitem &%--%&
2695 .oindex "--"
2696 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2697 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2698 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2699 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2700
2701 .vitem &%--help%&
2702 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2703 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2704 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2705 no arguments.
2706
2707 .vitem &%--version%&
2708 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2709 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2710 displayed.
2711
2712 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2713 &%-Am%&
2714 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2715 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2716 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2717 ignored by Exim.
2718
2719 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2720 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2721 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2722 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2723 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2724 clean; it ignores this option.
2725
2726 .vitem &%-bd%&
2727 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2728 .cindex "daemon"
2729 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2730 .cindex "queue runner"
2731 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2732 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2733 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2734
2735 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2736 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2737 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2738 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2739
2740 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2741 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2742 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2743 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2744
2745 When a listening daemon
2746 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2747 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2748 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2749 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2750 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2751 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2752 running as root.
2753
2754 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2755 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2756 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2757
2758 The SIGHUP signal
2759 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2760 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2761 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2762 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2763 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2764 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2765 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2766 because these are reread each time they are used.
2767
2768 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2769 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2770 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2771 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2772
2773 .vitem &%-be%&
2774 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2775 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2776 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2777 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2778 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2779 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2780 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2781
2782 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2783 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2784 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2785 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2786 test data. A line history is supported.
2787
2788 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2789 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2790 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2791 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2792 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2793 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2794 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2795
2796 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2797 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2798 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2799 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2800
2801 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2802 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2803 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2804 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2805 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2806 of a file. For example:
2807 .code
2808 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2809 .endd
2810 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2811 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2812 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2813 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2814 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2815 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2816 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2817 &%-be%&).
2818
2819 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2820 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2821 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2822 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2823 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2824 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2825 system filters are recognized.
2826
2827 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2828 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2829 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2831 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2832 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2833 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2834 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2835 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2836 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2837 supplied.
2838
2839 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2840 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2841 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2842 .code
2843 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2844 .endd
2845 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2846 variables that are used by the user filter.
2847
2848 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2849 .code
2850 # Exim filter
2851 # Sieve filter
2852 .endd
2853 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2854 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2855 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2856 redirection lists.
2857
2858 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2859 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2860 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2861 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2862
2863 When testing a filter file,
2864 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2865 .cindex "envelope sender"
2866 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2867 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2868 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2869 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2870 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2871 options).
2872
2873 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2874 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2875 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2876 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2877 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2878 &$qualify_domain$&.
2879
2880 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2881 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2882 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2883 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2884 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2885 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2886 actually being delivered.
2887
2888 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2889 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2890 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2891 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 prefix.
2893
2894 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2895 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2896 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2897 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2898 suffix.
2899
2900 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2901 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2902 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2903 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2904 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2905 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2906 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2907 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2908 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2909 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2910 after a full stop. For example:
2911 .code
2912 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2913 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2914 .endd
2915 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2916 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2917 conversion to the canonical form is
2918 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2919
2920 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2921 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2922 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2923 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2924 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2925
2926 &*Warning 1*&:
2927 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2928 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2929 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2930 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2931 connection.
2932
2933 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2934 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2935 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2936
2937 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2938 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2939 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2940 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2941 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2942 session were authenticated.
2943
2944 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2945 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2946 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2947
2948 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2949 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2950 specialized SMTP test program such as
2951 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2952
2953 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2954 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2955 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2956 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2957 updating the callout cache database.
2958
2959 .vitem &%-bi%&
2960 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2961 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2962 .cindex "building alias file"
2963 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2964 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2965 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2966 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2967 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2968 recognized.
2969
2970 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2971 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2972 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2973 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2974 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2975 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2976 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2977
2978 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2979 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2980 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2981 .cindex "querying exim information"
2982 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2983 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2984 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2985 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2986 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2987
2988 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2989 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2990 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2991 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2992 recognised DSCP names.
2993
2994 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2995 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2996 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2997 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2998 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2999 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3000 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3001 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3002 way to guarantee a correct response.
3003
3004 .vitem &%-bm%&
3005 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3006 .cindex "local message reception"
3007 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3008 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3009 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3010 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3011 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3012 if no other conflicting option is present.
3013
3014 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3015 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3016 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3017 suppressing this for special cases.
3018
3019 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3020 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3021
3022 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3023 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3024 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3025
3026 The format
3027 .cindex "message" "format"
3028 .cindex "format" "message"
3029 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3030 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3032 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3033 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3034 .code
3035 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3036 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3037 .endd
3038 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3039 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3040 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3041 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3042 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3043
3044 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3045 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3046 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3047 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3048 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3049
3050 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3051 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3052 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3053 .cindex "malware scan test"
3054 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3055 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3056 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3057 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3058 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3059 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3060
3061 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3062 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3063 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3064 This option requires admin privileges.
3065
3066 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3067 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3068 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3069
3070 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3071 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3072 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3073 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3074 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3075 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3076 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3077 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3078 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3079
3080 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3081 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3082 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3083 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3084 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3085
3086 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3087 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3088 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3089 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3090
3091
3092 .vitem &%-bP%&
3093 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3094 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3095 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3096 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3097 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3098 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3099 arguments, for example:
3100 .code
3101 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3102 .endd
3103 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3104 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3105 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3106 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3107 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3108 users, the output is as in this example:
3109 .code
3110 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3111 .endd
3112 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3113 configuration file is output.
3114 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3115 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3116
3117 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3118 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3119 name will not be output.
3120
3121 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3122 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3123 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3124 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3125 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3126 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3127 written directly into the spool directory.
3128
3129 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3130 .code
3131 exim -bP +local_domains
3132 .endd
3133 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3134 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3135
3136 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3137 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3139 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3140 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3141 that driver are output. For example:
3142 .code
3143 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3144 .endd
3145 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3146 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3147 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3148 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3149 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3150 &%authenticators%&.
3151
3152 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3153 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3154 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3155 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3156 The output format is one item per line.
3157
3158 .vitem &%-bp%&
3159 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3160 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3161 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3162 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3163 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3164 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3165 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3166 to allow any user to see the queue.
3167
3168 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3169 .code
3170 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3171 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3172 <other addresses>
3173 .endd
3174 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3175 .cindex "size" "of message"
3176 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3177 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3178 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3179 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3180 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3181 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3182 before the sender address.
3183
3184 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3185 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3186 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3187
3188 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3189 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3190 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3191 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3192 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3193 complete.
3194
3195
3196 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3197 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3198 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3199 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3200 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3201 of just &"D"&.
3202
3203
3204 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3205 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3206 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3207 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3208 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3209 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3210
3211
3212 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3213 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3214 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3215 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3216 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3217 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3218
3219 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3220 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3221 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3222
3223 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3224 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3225 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3226
3227
3228 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3229 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3230 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3231 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3232 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3233 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-brt%&
3237 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3238 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3239 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3240 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3241 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3242 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3243 .code
3244 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3245 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3246 .endd
3247 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3248 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3249 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3250 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3251 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3252 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3253 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3254 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3255 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3256 .code
3257 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3258 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3259 .endd
3260
3261 .vitem &%-brw%&
3262 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3263 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3264 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3265 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3266 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3267 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3268 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3269 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3270
3271 .vitem &%-bS%&
3272 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3273 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3274 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3275 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3276 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3277 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3278 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3279 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3280 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3281 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3282
3283 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3284 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3285 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3286
3287 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3288 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3289 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3290 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3291
3292 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3293 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3294 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3295
3296 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3297 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3298 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3299 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3300 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3301
3302 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3303 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3304
3305 .vitem &%-bs%&
3306 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3307 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3308 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3309 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3310 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3311 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3312 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3313 messages to the MTA.
3314
3315 In
3316 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3317 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3318 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3319 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3320 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3321 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3322 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3323
3324 .cindex "inetd"
3325 The
3326 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3327 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3328 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3329 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3330 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3331 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3332 the listening daemon.
3333
3334 .vitem &%-bt%&
3335 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3336 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3337 .cindex "address" "testing"
3338 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3339 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3340 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3341 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3342 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3343
3344 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3345 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3346
3347 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3348 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3349 security issues.
3350
3351 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3352 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3353 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3354 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3355 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3356 program.
3357
3358 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3359 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3360 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3361 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3362
3363 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3364 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3365 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3366 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3367 always shown.
3368
3369 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3370 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3371 message,
3372 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3373 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3374 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3375 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3376 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3377 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3378 doing such tests.
3379
3380 .vitem &%-bV%&
3381 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3382 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3383 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3384 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3385 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3386 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3387 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3388
3389 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3390 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3391 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3392 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3393 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3394 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3395 dynamic testing facilities.
3396
3397 .vitem &%-bv%&
3398 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3399 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "address" "verification"
3401 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3402 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3403 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3404 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3405 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3406 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3407
3408 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3409 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3410 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3411
3412 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3413 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3414
3415 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3416 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3417 security issues.
3418
3419 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3420 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3421 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3422 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3423 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3424
3425 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3426 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3427 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3428 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3429 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3430 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3431 to succeed.
3432
3433 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3434 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3435 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3436
3437 The
3438 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3439 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3440 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3441 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3442
3443 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3444 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3445 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3446 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3447
3448 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3449 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3450 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3451 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3452 might happen.
3453
3454 .vitem &%-bw%&
3455 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3456 .cindex "daemon"
3457 .cindex "inetd"
3458 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3459 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3460 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3461 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3462
3463 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3464 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3465 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3466 each port only when the first connection is received.
3467
3468 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3469 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3470
3471 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3472 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3473 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3474 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3475 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3476 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3477 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3478 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3479 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3480 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3481 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3482
3483 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3484 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3485 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3486 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3487 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3488 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3489 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3490 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3491 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3492
3493 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3494 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3495 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3496 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3497 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3498 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3499 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3500
3501 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3502 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3503 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3504 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3505 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3506 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3507 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3508
3509 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3510 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3511 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3512 configuration file.
3513
3514 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3515 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3516 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3517 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3518 specified by this option.
3519
3520
3521 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3522 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3523 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3524 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3525 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3526 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3527 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3528 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3529
3530 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3531 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3532 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3533 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3534 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3535 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3536 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3537
3538 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3539 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3540 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3541 synonymous:
3542 .code
3543 exim -DABC ...
3544 exim -DABC= ...
3545 .endd
3546 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3547 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3548 example:
3549 .code
3550 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3551 .endd
3552 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3553
3554
3555 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3556 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3557 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3559 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3560 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3561 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3562 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3563 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3564 return code.
3565
3566 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3567 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3568 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3569 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3570 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3571 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3572 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3573 are:
3574 .display
3575 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3576 &`auth `& authenticators
3577 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3578 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3579 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3580 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3581 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3582 &`filter `& filter handling
3583 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3584 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3585 &`ident `& ident lookup
3586 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3587 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3588 &`load `& system load checks
3589 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3590 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3591 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3592 &`memory `& memory handling
3593 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3594 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3595 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3596 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3597 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3598 &`retry `& retry handling
3599 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3600 &`route `& address routing
3601 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3602 &`tls `& TLS logic
3603 &`transport `& transports
3604 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3605 &`verify `& address verification logic
3606 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3607 .endd
3608 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3609 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3610 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3611 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3612 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3613 turn everything off.
3614
3615 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3616 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3617 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3618 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3619 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3620 rather than stderr.
3621
3622 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3623 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3624 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3625 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3626 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3627 run in parallel.
3628
3629 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3630 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3631 in processing.
3632
3633 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3634 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3635
3636 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3637 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3638 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3639 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3640 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3641 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3642
3643 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3644 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3645 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3646 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3647 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3648
3649 .vitem &%-E%&
3650 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3651 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3652 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3653 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3654 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3655 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3656 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3657 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3658 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3659
3660 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3661 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3662 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3663 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3664 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3665 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3666
3667 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3668 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3669 .cindex "sender" "name"
3670 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3671 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3672 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3673 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3674 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3675 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3676
3677 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3678 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3679 .cindex "sender" "address"
3680 .cindex "address" "sender"
3681 .cindex "trusted users"
3682 .cindex "envelope sender"
3683 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3684 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3685 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3686 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3687 users to use it.
3688
3689 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3690 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3691 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3692 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3693 domain.
3694
3695 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3696 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3697 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3698 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3699 examples of shell commands:
3700 .code
3701 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3702 exim -f "" user@domain
3703 .endd
3704 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3705 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3706 &%-bv%& options.
3707
3708 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3709 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3710 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3711 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3712
3713 White
3714 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3715 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3716 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3717 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3718 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3719 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3720
3721 .vitem &%-G%&
3722 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3723 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3724 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3725 .code
3726 control = suppress_local_fixups
3727 .endd
3728 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3729 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3730 in future.
3731
3732 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3733 this option.
3734
3735 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3736 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3738 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3739 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3740 headers.)
3741
3742 .vitem &%-i%&
3743 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3744 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3745 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3746 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3747 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3748 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3749 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3750
3751 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3752 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3753 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3754 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3755 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3756 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3757 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3758 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3759
3760 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3761
3762 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3763 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3764 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3765 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3766 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3767 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3768 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3769 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3770 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3771
3772 Retry
3773 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3774 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3775 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3776 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3777 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3778 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3779
3780 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3781 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3782 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3783 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3784
3785 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3786 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3787 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3788 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3789 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3790 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3791 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3792 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3793 can be used only by an admin user.
3794
3795 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3796 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3797 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3798 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3800 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3801 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3802 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3803 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3804 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3805 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3806
3807 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3808 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3809 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3810 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3811 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3812
3813 .new
3814 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3818 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3819 .wen
3820
3821 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3822 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3823 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3825 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3826
3827 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3828 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3829 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3830 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3831 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3832 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3833 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3834 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3837 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3841 connection.
3842
3843 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3844 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3845 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3847 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3848
3849 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3850 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3851 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3852 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3853 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3854 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3855 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3856 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3857 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3858 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3859 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3860 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3861 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3862 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3863 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3864
3865 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3866 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3867 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3868 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3869 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3870 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3871 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3872 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3873 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3874 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3875
3876 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3877 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3878 .cindex "freezing messages"
3879 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3880 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3881 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3882 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3883 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3884 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3885 user.
3886
3887 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3888 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3889 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3890 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3891 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3892 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3893 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3894 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3895 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3896 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3897 user.
3898
3899 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3900 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3901 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3902 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3903 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3904 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3905 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3906
3907 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3908 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3909 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3910 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3911 .cindex "removing recipients"
3912 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3913 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3914 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3915 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3916 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3917 can be used only by an admin user.
3918
3919 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3920 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3921 .cindex "removing messages"
3922 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3923 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3924 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3925 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3926 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3927 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3928 placed on the queue.
3929
3930 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3931 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3932 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3933 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3934 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3935 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3936 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3937 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3938 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3939 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3940 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3941
3942 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3943 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3944 .cindex "thawing messages"
3945 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3946 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3947 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3948 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3949 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3950 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3951 by an admin user.
3952
3953 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3955 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3956 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3957 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3958 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3959
3960 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3961 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3962 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3963 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3964 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3965 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3966 only by an admin user.
3967
3968 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3969 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3970 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3971 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3974 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3977 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3978 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3979 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3980 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3981 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3982
3983 .vitem &%-m%&
3984 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3985 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3986 treats it that way too.
3987
3988 .vitem &%-N%&
3989 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3990 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3991 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3992 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3993 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3994 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3995 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3996 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3997 than &"=>"&.
3998
3999 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4000 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4001 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4002 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4003 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4004 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4005 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4006 for that message.
4007
4008 .vitem &%-n%&
4009 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4010 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4011 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4012 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4013
4014 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4015 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4016 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4017 Exim.
4018
4019 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4020 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4021 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4022 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4023 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4024 description above.
4025
4026 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4027 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4028 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4029 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4030 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4031 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4032 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4033 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4034
4035 .vitem &%-odb%&
4036 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4037 .cindex "background delivery"
4038 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4039 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4040 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4041 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4042 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4043 processes to finish.
4044
4045 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4046 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4047 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4048 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4049
4050 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4051 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4052 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4053 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4054
4055 .vitem &%-odf%&
4056 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4057 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4058 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4059 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4060 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4061 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4062 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4063
4064 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4065 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4066 during deliveries.
4067
4068 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4069 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4070
4071 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4072 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4073 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4074 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4075
4076
4077 .vitem &%-odi%&
4078 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4079 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4080 Sendmail.
4081
4082 .vitem &%-odq%&
4083 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4084 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4085 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4086 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4087 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4088 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4089 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4090 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4091 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4092 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4093 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4094 forces queueing.
4095
4096 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4097 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4098 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4099 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4100 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4101 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4102 configuration file is in effect.
4103
4104 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4105 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4106 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4107 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4108 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4109 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4110 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4111 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4112 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4113 &%-qq%& option.
4114
4115 .vitem &%-oee%&
4116 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4117 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4118 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4119 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4120 message.
4121
4122 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4123 Provided
4124 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4125 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4126 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4127 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4128
4129 .vitem &%-oem%&
4130 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4131 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4132 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4133 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4134 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4135 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4136
4137 .vitem &%-oep%&
4138 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4139 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4140 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4141 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4142 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4143 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4144
4145 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4146 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4147 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4148 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4149 effect as &%-oep%&.
4150
4151 .vitem &%-oew%&
4152 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4153 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4154 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4155 effect as &%-oem%&.
4156
4157 .vitem &%-oi%&
4158 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4159 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4160 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4161 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4162 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4163 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4164 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4165
4166 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4167 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4168 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4169
4170 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4171 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4172 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4173 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4174 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4175 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4176 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4177 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4178
4179 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4180 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4181 .code
4182 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4183 .endd
4184 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4185 followed by a colon and the port number:
4186 .code
4187 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4188 .endd
4189 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4190 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4191 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4192 whichever one is last.
4193
4194 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4195 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4196 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4197 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4198 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4199 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4200 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4201 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4202
4203 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4204 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4205 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4207 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4208 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4209 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4210 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4211
4212 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4213 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4214 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4215 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4216 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4217 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4218 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4219 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4220 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4221 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4222
4223 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4224 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4225 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4226 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4227 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4228 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4229 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4230
4231 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4232 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4233 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4234 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4235 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4236 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4237 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4238 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4239 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4240
4241 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4242 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4243 is sending the bounce.
4244
4245 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4246 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4247 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4248 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4249 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4250 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4251 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4252 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4253 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4254 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4255 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4256 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4257
4258 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4259 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4260 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4261 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4262 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4263 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4264 uses the name it is given.
4265
4266 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4267 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4268 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4269 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4270 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4271 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4272 used, when there is no default.
4273
4274 .vitem &%-om%&
4275 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4276 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4277 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4278 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4279 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4280
4281 .vitem &%-oo%&
4282 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4283 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4284 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4285 whatever that means.
4286
4287 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4288 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4289 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4290 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4291 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4292 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4293 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4294 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4295 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4299 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4300 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4301 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4302 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4303 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4304
4305 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4306 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4307 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4308 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4309 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4310 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4311 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4312 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-ov%&
4315 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4316 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4320 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4321 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4322 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4323 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4324 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4325 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4326 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4327 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4328
4329 .vitem &%-pd%&
4330 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4331 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4332 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4333 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4334 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4335 needed.
4336
4337 .vitem &%-ps%&
4338 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4339 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4340 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4341 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4342 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4343 started.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4346 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4347 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4348 .display
4349 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4350 .endd
4351 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4352 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4353 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4354 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4355 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4356
4357 .vitem &%-q%&
4358 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4359 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4360 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4361 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4362 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4363 and &%-S%& options).
4364
4365 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4366 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4367 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4368 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4369 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4370 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4371
4372 If
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4374 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4375 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4376 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4377 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4378 proceeding.
4379
4380 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4381 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4382 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4383 this to be repeated periodically.
4384
4385 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4386 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4387 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4388 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4389
4390 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4391 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4392 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4393
4394 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4395 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4396 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4397 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4398
4399 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4400 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4401 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4402 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4403 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4404 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4405 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4406 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4407 transports are run.
4408
4409 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4410 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4411 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4412 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4413 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4414 delivered down a single SMTP
4415 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4419 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4420 intermittently.
4421
4422 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4423 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4424 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4425 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4426 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4427 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4428 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4429
4430 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4431 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4432 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4433 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4434 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4435 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4436 their retry times are tried.
4437
4438 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4439 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4440 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4441 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4442 frozen or not.
4443
4444 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4445 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4446 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4447 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4448 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4449 for later delivery.
4450
4451 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4452 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4453 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4454 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4455 starting message id. For example:
4456 .code
4457 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4458 .endd
4459 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4460 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4461 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4462 .code
4463 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4464 .endd
4465 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4466 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4467 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4468 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4469 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4470 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4471
4472 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4473 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4474 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4475 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4476 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4477 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4478 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4479 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4480 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4481 .code
4482 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4483 .endd
4484 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4485 process every 30 minutes.
4486
4487 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4488 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4489
4490 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4491 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4492 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4493 compatibility.
4494
4495 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4496 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4497 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4498
4499 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4500 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4501 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4502 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4503 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4504 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4505 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4506 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4507 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4508
4509 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4510 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4511 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4512 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4513 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4514 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4515
4516 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4517 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4518 .code
4519 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4520 .endd
4521 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4522 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4523 applied to each queue run.
4524
4525 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4526 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4527 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4528 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4529 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4530 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4531 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4532 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4533 address will be skipped.
4534
4535 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4536 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4537 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4538 &'ff'& is present.
4539
4540 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4541 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4542 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4543 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4544 an arbitrary command instead.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-r%&
4547 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4548 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4549
4550 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4551 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4552 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4554 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4555 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4556 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4557 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4558
4559 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4560 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4561 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4562 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4563 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4564
4565 .vitem &%-t%&
4566 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4567 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4568 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4569 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4570 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4571 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4572 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4573 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4574 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4575 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4576
4577 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4578 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4579 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4580 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4581 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4582 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4583 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4584 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4585 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4586 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4587 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4588
4589 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4590 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4591 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4592 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4593 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4594 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4595
4596 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4597 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4598 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4599 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4600 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4601 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4602 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4603 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4604 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4605
4606 .vitem &%-ti%&
4607 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4608 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4609 compatibility with Sendmail.
4610
4611 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4612 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4613 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4614 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4615 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4616 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4617 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4618 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4619
4620
4621 .vitem &%-U%&
4622 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4623 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4624 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4625 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4626 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4627 set. Exim ignores this option.
4628
4629 .vitem &%-v%&
4630 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4631 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4632 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4633 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4634 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4635 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4636 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4637 unconditional.
4638
4639 .vitem &%-x%&
4640 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4641 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4642 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4643 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4644 this option.
4645
4646 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4647 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4648 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4649 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4650
4651 .new
4652 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4653 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4654 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4655 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4656 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4657 under most shells.
4658 .wen
4659 .endlist
4660
4661 .ecindex IIDclo1
4662 .ecindex IIDclo2
4663
4664
4665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4666 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4667 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4668 . creates a man page for the options.
4669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4670
4671 .literal xml
4672 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4673 .literal off
4674
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4681
4682
4683 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4684 "The runtime configuration file"
4685
4686 .cindex "run time configuration"
4687 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4688 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4689 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4690 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4691 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4692 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4693 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4694 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4695 control.
4696
4697 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4698 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4699 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4700 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4701 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4702 actually alter the string.
4703
4704 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4705 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4706 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4707 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4708 existing file in the list.
4709
4710 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4711 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4712 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4713 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4714 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4715 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4716 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4717 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4718 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4719 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4720 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4721
4722 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4723 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4724 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4725 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4726 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4727
4728 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4729 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4730 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4731 compromise the Exim user account.
4732
4733 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4734 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4735 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4736 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4737 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4738 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4739 configuration.
4740
4741
4742
4743 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4744 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4745 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4746 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4747 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4748 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4749 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4750 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4751 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4752 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4753 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4754
4755 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4756 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4757 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4758 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4759 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4760 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4761 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4762 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4763 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4764 &%-M%&).
4765
4766 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4767 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4768 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4769 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4770 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4771
4772 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4773 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4774 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4775 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4776 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4777 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4778
4779 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4780 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4781 necessarily be discarded.
4782 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4783 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4784 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4785 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4786 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4787 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4788
4789 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4790 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4791 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4792 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4793 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4794 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4795 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4796
4797 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4798 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4799 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4800
4801
4802
4803 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4804 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4805 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4806 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4807 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4808 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4809 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4810 optional parts are:
4811
4812 .ilist
4813 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4814 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4815 .next
4816 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4817 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4818 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4819 .next
4820 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4821 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4822 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4823 .next
4824 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4825 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4826 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4827 .next
4828 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4829 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4830 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4831 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4832 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4833 .next
4834 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4835 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4836 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4837 .next
4838 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4839 want to use this feature, you must set
4840 .code
4841 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4842 .endd
4843 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4844 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4845 .endlist
4846
4847 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4849 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4850 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4851
4852 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4853 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4854 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4855 and does not introduce a comment.
4856
4857 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4858 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4859 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4860 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4861 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4862
4863 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4864 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4865 change settings as required.
4866
4867 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4868 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4869 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4870 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4871 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4872 described.
4873
4874
4875
4876 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4877 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4878 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4879 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4880 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4881 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4882 using this syntax:
4883 .display
4884 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4885 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4886 .endd
4887 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4888 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4889 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4890 name is required.
4891
4892 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4893 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4894 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4895 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4896
4897 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4898 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4899 for example:
4900 .code
4901 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4902 .include /some/file
4903 .endd
4904 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4905 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4906 inclusion appears.
4907
4908
4909
4910 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4911 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4912 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4913 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4914 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4915 definition, and must be of the form
4916 .display
4917 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4918 .endd
4919 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4920 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4921 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4922 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4923 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4924
4925 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4926 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4927 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4928
4929 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4930 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4931 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4932 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4933 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4934 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4935 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4936 define
4937 .display
4938 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4939 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4940 .endd
4941 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4942 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4943 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4944 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4945 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4946 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4947
4948
4949 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4950 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4951 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4952 &'='&. For example:
4953 .code
4954 MAC = initial value
4955 ...
4956 MAC == updated value
4957 .endd
4958 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4959 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4960 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4961 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4962 .code
4963 MAC = initial value
4964 ...
4965 MAC == MAC and something added
4966 .endd
4967 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4968 from a number of other files.
4969
4970 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4971 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4972 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4973 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4974 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4975 file to be ignored.
4976
4977
4978
4979 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4980 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4981 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4982 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4983 .code
4984 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4985 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4986 .endd
4987 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4988 .code
4989 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4990 .endd
4991 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4992 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4993 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4994
4995
4996 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4997 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4998 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4999 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5000 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5001 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5002 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5003
5004 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5005 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5006 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5007 line. Thus:
5008 .code
5009 .ifdef AAA
5010 message_size_limit = 50M
5011 .else
5012 message_size_limit = 100M
5013 .endif
5014 .endd
5015 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5016 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5017 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5018 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5019 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5020
5021 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5022 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5023 in this line"& will always be true.
5024
5025 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5026 to clarify complicated nestings.
5027
5028
5029
5030 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5031 .cindex "common option syntax"
5032 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5033 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5034 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5035 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5036 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5037 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5038 space) and then the value. For example:
5039 .code
5040 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5041 .endd
5042 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5043 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5044 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5045 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5046 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5047 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5048 word &"hide"&. For example:
5049 .code
5050 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5051 .endd
5052 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5053 .code
5054 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5055 .endd
5056 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5057 all instances of the same driver.
5058
5059 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5060 that are found in option settings.
5061
5062
5063 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5064 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5065 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5066 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5067 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5068 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5069 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5070 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5071 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5072 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5073 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5074 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5075 .code
5076 queue_only
5077 queue_only = true
5078 .endd
5079 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5080 .code
5081 no_queue_only
5082 queue_only = false
5083 .endd
5084 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5085
5086
5087
5088
5089 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5090 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5091 .cindex "format" "integer"
5092 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5093 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5094 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5095 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5096 hexadecimal number.
5097
5098 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5099 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5100 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5101 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5102 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5103 used.
5104
5105
5106 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5107 .cindex "integer format"
5108 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5109 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5110 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5111 Such options are always output in octal.
5112
5113
5114 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5115 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5116 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5117 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5118 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5119
5120
5121
5122 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5123 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5124 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5125 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5126 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5127
5128 .table2 30pt
5129 .irow &%s%& seconds
5130 .irow &%m%& minutes
5131 .irow &%h%& hours
5132 .irow &%d%& days
5133 .irow &%w%& weeks
5134 .endtable
5135
5136 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5137 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5138 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5139
5140
5141
5142 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5143 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5144 .cindex "format" "string"
5145 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5146 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5147 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5148 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5149 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5150 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5151 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5152 therefore equivalent:
5153 .code
5154 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5155 trusted_users = uucp:\
5156 # This comment line is ignored
5157 mail
5158 .endd
5159 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5160 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5161 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5162 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5163 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5164
5165 .table2 100pt
5166 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5167 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5168 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5169 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5170 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5171 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5172 character"
5173 .endtable
5174
5175 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5176 character, that character replaces the pair.
5177
5178 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5179 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5180 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5181 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5182 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5183 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5184
5185
5186 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5187 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5188 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5189 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5190 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5191 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5192 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5193 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5194 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5195 within a quoted configuration string.
5196
5197
5198 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5199 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5200 .cindex "format" "user name"
5201 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5202 .cindex "format" "group name"
5203 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5204 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5205 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5206 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5207
5208
5209 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5210 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5211 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5212 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5213 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5214 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5215 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5216 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5217 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5218 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5219 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5220
5221 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5222 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5223 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5224 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5225 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5226 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5227 example, the list
5228 .code
5229 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5230 .endd
5231 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5232
5233 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5234 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5235 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5236 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5237
5238 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5239 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5240 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5241 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5242 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5243 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5244 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5245 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5246 .code
5247 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5248 .endd
5249 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5250 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5251 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5252
5253 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5254 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5255 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5256 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5257 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5258 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5259 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5260 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5261 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5262 .code
5263 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5264 .endd
5265 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5266 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5267 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5268 the value in quotes. For example:
5269 .code
5270 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5271 .endd
5272 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5273 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5274 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5275 enclosing an empty list item.
5276
5277
5278
5279 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5280 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5281 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5282 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5283 .code
5284 senders = user@domain :
5285 .endd
5286 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5287 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5288 items, the second of which is empty:
5289 .code
5290 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5291 .endd
5292 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5293 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5294 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5295 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5296 .code
5297 senders = :
5298 .endd
5299 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5300 is at the end of the list.
5301
5302
5303
5304
5305 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5306 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5307 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5308 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5309 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5310 a sequence of lines like this:
5311 .display
5312 <&'instance name'&>:
5313 <&'option'&>
5314 ...
5315 <&'option'&>
5316 .endd
5317 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5318 followed by three options settings:
5319 .code
5320 localuser:
5321 driver = accept
5322 check_local_user
5323 transport = local_delivery
5324 .endd
5325 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5326 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5327 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5328 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5329 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5330 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5331
5332 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5333 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5334
5335 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5336 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5337 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5338 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5339 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5340 server.
5341
5342 .cindex "generic options"
5343 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5344 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5345 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5346 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5347 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5348 .cindex "private options"
5349 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5350 they all have default values.
5351
5352 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5353 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5354 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5355
5356 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5357 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5358 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5359 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5360 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5361 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5362 configuration lines:
5363 .code
5364 remote_smtp:
5365 driver = smtp
5366 .endd
5367 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5368 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5369 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5370 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5371 thus:
5372 .code
5373 special_smtp:
5374 driver = smtp
5375 port = 1234
5376 command_timeout = 10s
5377 .endd
5378 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5379 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5380 lines.
5381
5382 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5383 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5384 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5385 option.
5386
5387
5388
5389
5390
5391
5392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5394
5395 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5396 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5397 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5398 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5399 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5400 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5401 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5402 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5403 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5404 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5405 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5406
5407
5408
5409 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5410 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5411 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5412 the line
5413 .code
5414 # primary_hostname =
5415 .endd
5416 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5417 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5418 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5419 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5420
5421 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5422 .code
5423 domainlist local_domains = @
5424 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5425 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5426 .endd
5427 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5428 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5429 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5430 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5431
5432 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5433 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5434 on the local host.
5435
5436 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5437 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5438 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5439 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5440 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5441 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5442
5443 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5444 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5445 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5446 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5447 domain is permitted.
5448
5449 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5450 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5451 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5452 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5453 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5454 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5455
5456 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5457 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5458 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5459
5460 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5461 .code
5462 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5463 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5464 .endd
5465 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5466 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5467 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5468 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5469 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5470 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5471 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5472 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5473 contents of a message to be checked.
5474
5475 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5476 .code
5477 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5478 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5479 .endd
5480 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5481 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5482 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5483 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5484
5485 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5486 .code
5487 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5488 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5489 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5490 .endd
5491 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5492 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5493 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5494 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5495 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5496 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5497 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5498
5499 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5500 .code
5501 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5502 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5503 .endd
5504 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5505 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5506 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5507 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5508 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5509 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5510 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5511 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5512 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5513 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5514 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5515 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5516 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5517 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5518 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5519 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5520
5521 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5522 .code
5523 # qualify_domain =
5524 # qualify_recipient =
5525 .endd
5526 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5527 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5528 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5529 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5530 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5531 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5532
5533 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5534 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5535 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5536 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5537 .code
5538 # allow_domain_literals
5539 .endd
5540 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5541 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5542 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5543 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5544 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5545 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5546
5547 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5548 .code
5549 never_users = root
5550 .endd
5551 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5552 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5553 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5554 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5555 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5556 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5557 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5558 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5559
5560 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5561 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5562 line,
5563 .code
5564 host_lookup = *
5565 .endd
5566 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5567 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5568 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5569 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5570 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5571 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5572 unreachable.
5573
5574 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5575 1413 (hence their names):
5576 .code
5577 rfc1413_hosts = *
5578 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5579 .endd
5580 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5581 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5582 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5583 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5584 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5585 information, you can change this.
5586
5587 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5588 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5589 .code
5590 prdr_enable = true
5591 .endd
5592
5593 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5594 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5595 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5596 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5597 .code
5598 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5599 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5600 .endd
5601 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5602 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5603
5604 .new
5605 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5606 over the default:
5607 .code
5608 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5609 +tls_certificate_verified
5610 .endd
5611 .wen
5612
5613 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5614 .code
5615 # percent_hack_domains =
5616 .endd
5617 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5618 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5619 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5620
5621 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5622 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5623 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5624 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5625 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5626 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5627 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5628 always bounce messages.
5629 .code
5630 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5631 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5632 .endd
5633 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5634 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5635 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5636 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5637 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5638
5639
5640
5641 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5642 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5643 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5644 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5645 It starts with the line
5646 .code
5647 begin acl
5648 .endd
5649 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5650 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5651 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5652
5653 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5654 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5655 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5656 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5657 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5658 result of the ACL processing.
5659 .code
5660 acl_check_rcpt:
5661 .endd
5662 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5663 ACL, and names it.
5664 .code
5665 accept hosts = :
5666 .endd
5667 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5668 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5669 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5670 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5671 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5672 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5673
5674 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5675 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5676 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5677 manner.
5678 .code
5679 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5680 domains = +local_domains
5681 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5682
5683 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5684 domains = !+local_domains
5685 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5686 .endd
5687 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5688 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5689 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5690 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5691 in Internet mail addresses.
5692
5693 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5694 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5695 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5696 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5697 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5698 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5699 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5700 policy of being as safe as possible.
5701
5702 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5703 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5704 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5705 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5706 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5707 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5708
5709 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5710 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5711 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5712 have to modify this rule.
5713
5714 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5715 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5716 common convention of local parts constructed as
5717 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5718 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5719 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5720 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5721 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5722 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5723
5724 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5725 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5726 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5727 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5728 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5729 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5730 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5731 .code
5732 accept local_parts = postmaster
5733 domains = +local_domains
5734 .endd
5735 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5736 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5737 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5738 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5739 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5740
5741 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5742 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5743 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5744 .code
5745 require verify = sender
5746 .endd
5747 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5748 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5749 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5750 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5751 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5752 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5753 discusses the details of address verification.
5754 .code
5755 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5756 control = submission
5757 .endd
5758 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5759 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5760 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5761 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5762 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5763 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5764 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5765 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5766 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5767 .code
5768 accept authenticated = *
5769 control = submission
5770 .endd
5771 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5772 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5773 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5774 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5775 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5776 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5777 .code
5778 require message = relay not permitted
5779 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5780 .endd
5781 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5782 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5783 .code
5784 require verify = recipient
5785 .endd
5786 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5787 fails, the address is rejected.
5788 .code
5789 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5790 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5791 # $dnslist_text
5792 # dnslists = black.list.example
5793 #
5794 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5795 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5796 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5797 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5798 .endd
5799 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5800 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5801 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5802 line.
5803 .code
5804 # require verify = csa
5805 .endd
5806 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5807 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5808 records.
5809 .code
5810 accept
5811 .endd
5812 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5813 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5814 .code
5815 acl_check_data:
5816 .endd
5817 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5818 of this ACL are commented out:
5819 .code
5820 # deny malware = *
5821 # message = This message contains a virus \
5822 # ($malware_name).
5823 .endd
5824 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5825 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5826 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5827 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5828 .code
5829 # warn spam = nobody
5830 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5831 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5832 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5833 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5834 .endd
5835 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5836 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5837 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5838 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5839 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5840 whatever the spam score.
5841 .code
5842 accept
5843 .endd
5844 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5845
5846
5847 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5848 .cindex "default" "routers"
5849 .cindex "routers" "default"
5850 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5851 by the line
5852 .code
5853 begin routers
5854 .endd
5855 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5856 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5857 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5858 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5859 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5860 .code
5861 # domain_literal:
5862 # driver = ipliteral
5863 # domains = !+local_domains
5864 # transport = remote_smtp
5865 .endd
5866 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5867 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5868 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5869 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5870 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5871 .code
5872 dnslookup:
5873 driver = dnslookup
5874 domains = ! +local_domains
5875 transport = remote_smtp
5876 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5877 no_more
5878 .endd
5879 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5880 domains. This is specified by the line
5881 .code
5882 domains = ! +local_domains
5883 .endd
5884 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5885 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5886 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5887 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5888 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5889 passed on to the following routers.
5890
5891 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5892 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5893 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5894 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5895 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5896
5897 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5898 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5899 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5900 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5901 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5902 the address fails and is bounced.
5903
5904 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5905 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5906 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5907 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5908 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5909 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5910 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5911 out.
5912 .code
5913 system_aliases:
5914 driver = redirect
5915 allow_fail
5916 allow_defer
5917 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5918 # user = exim
5919 file_transport = address_file
5920 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5921 .endd
5922 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5923 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5924 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5925 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5926 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5927 the next router.
5928
5929 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5930 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5931 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5932 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5933 .code
5934 userforward:
5935 driver = redirect
5936 check_local_user
5937 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5938 # local_part_suffix_optional
5939 file = $home/.forward
5940 # allow_filter
5941 no_verify
5942 no_expn
5943 check_ancestor
5944 file_transport = address_file
5945 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5946 reply_transport = address_reply
5947 .endd
5948 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5949 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5950 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5951 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5952 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5953 namely:
5954 .code
5955 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5956 # local_part_suffix_optional
5957 .endd
5958 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5959 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5960 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5961 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5962 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5963 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5964 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5965
5966 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5967 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5968 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5969 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5970
5971 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5972 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5973 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5974 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5975 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5976 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5977 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5978
5979 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5980 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5981 There are two reasons for doing this:
5982
5983 .olist
5984 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5985 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5986 unnecessary work.
5987 .next
5988 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5989 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5990 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5991 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5992 this time.
5993 .endlist
5994
5995 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5996 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5997 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5998 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5999
6000 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6001 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6002 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6003 .code
6004 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6005 .endd
6006 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6007 transport.
6008 .code
6009 localuser:
6010 driver = accept
6011 check_local_user
6012 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6013 # local_part_suffix_optional
6014 transport = local_delivery
6015 .endd
6016 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6017 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6018 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6019 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6020 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6021
6022
6023 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6024 .cindex "default" "transports"
6025 .cindex "transports" "default"
6026 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6027 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6028 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6029 .code
6030 begin transports
6031 .endd
6032 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6033 .code
6034 remote_smtp:
6035 driver = smtp
6036 hosts_try_prdr = *
6037 .endd
6038 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6039 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6040 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6041 It is negotiated between client and server
6042 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6043 All other options are defaulted.
6044 .code
6045 local_delivery:
6046 driver = appendfile
6047 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6048 delivery_date_add
6049 envelope_to_add
6050 return_path_add
6051 # group = mail
6052 # mode = 0660
6053 .endd
6054 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6055 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6056 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6057 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6058 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6059 show how this can be done.
6060
6061 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6062 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6063 similarly-named options above.
6064 .code
6065 address_pipe:
6066 driver = pipe
6067 return_output
6068 .endd
6069 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6070 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6071 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6072 sender.
6073 .code
6074 address_file:
6075 driver = appendfile
6076 delivery_date_add
6077 envelope_to_add
6078 return_path_add
6079 .endd
6080 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6081 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6082 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6083 .code
6084 address_reply:
6085 driver = autoreply
6086 .endd
6087 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6088 filter files.
6089
6090
6091
6092 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6093 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6094 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6095 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6096 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6097 introduced by the line
6098 .code
6099 begin retry
6100 .endd
6101 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6102 errors:
6103 .code
6104 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6105 .endd
6106 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6107 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6108 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6109 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6110
6111 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6112 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6113 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6114
6115
6116 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6117 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6118 .code
6119 begin rewrite
6120 .endd
6121 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6122 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6123
6124
6125
6126 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6127 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6128 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6129 .code
6130 begin authenticators
6131 .endd
6132 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6133 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6134 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6135 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6136 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6137 to support most MUA software.
6138
6139 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6140 .code
6141 #PLAIN:
6142 # driver = plaintext
6143 # server_set_id = $auth2
6144 # server_prompts = :
6145 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6146 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6147 .endd
6148 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6149 .code
6150 #LOGIN:
6151 # driver = plaintext
6152 # server_set_id = $auth1
6153 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6154 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6155 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6156 .endd
6157
6158 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6159 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6160 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6161 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6162 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6163 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6164 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6165 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6166
6167 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6168 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6169 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6170 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6171
6172 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6173 usercode and password are in different positions.
6174 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6175
6176 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6177
6178
6179
6180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6182
6183 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6184
6185 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6186 .cindex "PCRE"
6187 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6188 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6189 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6190 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6191 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6192 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6193
6194 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6195 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6196 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6197 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6198 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6199 case-insensitive.
6200
6201 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6202 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6203 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6204 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6205 .code
6206 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6207 .endd
6208 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6209 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6210 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6211 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6212 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6213 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6214 matched.
6215
6216 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6217 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6218 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6219 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6220 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6221 match anywhere in the subject string.
6222
6223 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6224 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6225 .code
6226 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6227 .endd
6228 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6229 You need to use:
6230 .code
6231 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6232 .endd
6233 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6234 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6235
6236
6237
6238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6240
6241 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6242 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6243 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6244 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6245 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6246 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6247
6248 .olist
6249 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6250 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6251 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6252 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6253 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6254 .next
6255 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6256 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6257 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6258 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6259 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6260 .endlist
6261
6262 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6263 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6264 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6265 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6266 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6267 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6268
6269 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6270 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6271 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6272 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6273 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6274 .code
6275 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6276 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6277 .endd
6278 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6279 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6280 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6281 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6282 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6283 .code
6284 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6285 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6286 .endd
6287 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6288 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6289
6290 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6291 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6292 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6293 .code
6294 domain1:
6295 domain2:
6296 .endd
6297 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6298 matches the list item.
6299
6300 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6301 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6302 .code
6303 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6304 .endd
6305 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6306 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6307 causes a second lookup to occur.
6308
6309 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6310 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6311 lookup is permitted.
6312
6313
6314 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6315 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6316 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6317 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6318
6319 .ilist
6320 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6321 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6322 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6323 .next
6324 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6325 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6326 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6327 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6328 .endlist
6329
6330 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6331 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6332 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6333 .code
6334 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6335 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6336 .endd
6337 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6338 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6339 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6340
6341
6342
6343
6344 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6345 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6346 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6347 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6348
6349 .ilist
6350 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6351 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6352 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6353 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6354 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6355 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6356 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6357 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6358 be found in several places:
6359 .display
6360 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6361 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6362 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6363 .endd
6364 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6365 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6366 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6367 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6368 .next
6369 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6371 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6372 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6373 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6374 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6375 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6376
6377 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6378 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6379 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6380 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6381 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6382 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6383 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6384 .next
6385 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6386 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6387 .cindex "sasldb2"
6388 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6389 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6390 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6391 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6392 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6393 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6394 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6395 .next
6396 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6397 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6398 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6399 .cindex "Courier"
6400 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6401 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6402 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6403 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6404 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6405 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6406 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6407 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6408 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6409 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6410 .next
6411 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6412 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6413 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6414 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6415 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6416 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6417 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6418 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6419 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6420 .next
6421 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6422 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6423 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6424 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6425 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6426 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6427 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6428 .code
6429 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6430 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6431 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6432 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6433 .endd
6434 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6435 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6436 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6437 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6438 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6439
6440 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6441 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6442 lookup types support only literal keys.
6443
6444 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6445 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6446 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6447 .next
6448 .cindex "linear search"
6449 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6450 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6451 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6452 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6453 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6454 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6455 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6456 in the file is used.
6457
6458 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6459 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6460 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6461 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6462 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6463 colon, for example:
6464 .code
6465 baduser: :fail:
6466 .endd
6467 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6468 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6469 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6470 wildcarding of any kind.
6471
6472 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6473 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6474 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6475 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6476 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6477 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6478 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6479 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6480 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6481
6482 .next
6483 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6484 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6485 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6486 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6487 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6488 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6489 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6490 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6491
6492 .next
6493 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6494 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6495 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6496 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6497 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6498 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6499 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6500 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6501 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6502
6503 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6504 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6505 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6506 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6507
6508 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6509 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6510
6511 .olist
6512 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6513 .code
6514 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6515 *fish data for anythingfish
6516 .endd
6517 .next
6518 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6519 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6520 .code
6521 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6522 .endd
6523 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6524 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6525 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6526 .code
6527 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6528 .endd
6529 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6530 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6531 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6532 .code
6533 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6534 .endd
6535
6536 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6537 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6538 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6539 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6540 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6541
6542 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6543 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6544 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6545 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6546 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6547
6548 .next
6549 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6550 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6551 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6552 example:
6553 .code
6554 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6555 .endd
6556 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6557 .endlist olist
6558
6559 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6560 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6561 be followed by optional colons.
6562
6563 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6564 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6565 lookup types support only literal keys.
6566 .endlist ilist
6567
6568
6569 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6570 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6571 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6572 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6573 many of them are given in later sections.
6574
6575 .ilist
6576 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6578 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6579 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6580 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6581 .next
6582 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6583 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6584 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6585 .next
6586 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6587 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6588 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6589 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6590 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6591 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6592 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6593 .next
6594 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6595 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6596 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6597 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6598 .next
6599 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6600 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6601 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6602 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6603 .next
6604 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6605 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6606 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6607 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6608 .next
6609 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6610 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6611 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6612 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6613 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6614 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6615 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6616 password value. For example:
6617 .code
6618 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6619 .endd
6620 .next
6621 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6623 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6624 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6625
6626 .next
6627 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6628 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6629 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6630 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6631
6632 .next
6633 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6634 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6635 .next
6636 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6637 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6638 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6639 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6640 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6641 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6642 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6643 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6644 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6645 .code
6646 require condition = \
6647 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6648 .endd
6649 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6650 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6651 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6652 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6653 .endlist
6654
6655
6656
6657 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6658 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6659 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6660 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6661 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6662 options such as a list of local domains.
6663
6664 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6665 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6666 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6667 or may give up altogether.
6668
6669
6670
6671 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6672 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6673 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6674 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6675 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6676 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6677 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6678 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6679
6680 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6681 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6682 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6683
6684 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6685 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6686 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6687
6688 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6689 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6690 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6691 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6692 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6693 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6694 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6695 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6696 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6697 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6698 .code
6699 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6700 .endd
6701 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6702 looks up these keys, in this order:
6703 .code
6704 jane@eyre.example
6705 *@eyre.example
6706 *
6707 .endd
6708 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6709 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6710 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6711 Exim move on to try the next key.
6712
6713
6714
6715 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6716 .cindex "partial matching"
6717 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6718 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6719 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6720 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6721 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6722 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6723 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6724 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6725 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6726 a key in a DBM file is
6727 .code
6728 *.dates.fict.example
6729 .endd
6730 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6731 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6732 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6733 file.
6734
6735 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6736 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6737 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6738
6739 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6740 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6741 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6742 partial matching keys
6743 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6744 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6745 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6746
6747 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6748 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6749 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6750 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6751 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6752 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6753 remains.
6754
6755 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6756 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6757 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6758 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6759 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6760 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6761 .code
6762 2250.dates.fict.example
6763 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6764 *.dates.fict.example
6765 *.fict.example
6766 .endd
6767 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6768 finishes.
6769
6770 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6771 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6772 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6773 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6774 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6775 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6776 .code
6777 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6778 .endd
6779 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6780 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6781 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6782 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6783 .code
6784 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6785 .endd
6786 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6787 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6788
6789 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6790 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6791 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6792
6793 .ilist
6794 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6795 .next
6796 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6797 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6798 .next
6799 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6800 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6801 for &"*"& on its own.
6802 .next
6803 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6804 .endlist
6805
6806
6807 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6808 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6809 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6810 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6811 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6812 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6813 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6814
6815 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6816 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6817 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6818 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6819 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6820
6821
6822
6823
6824 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6825 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6826 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6827 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6828 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6829 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6830 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6831
6832 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6833 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6834 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6835 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6836 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6837 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6838
6839 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6840 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6841 complete.
6842
6843
6844
6845
6846 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6847 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6848 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6849 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6850 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6851 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6852 .code
6853 [name=$local_part]
6854 .endd
6855 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6856 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6857 .code
6858 [name="$local_part"]
6859 .endd
6860 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6861 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6862 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6863 of the following form is provided:
6864 .code
6865 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6866 .endd
6867 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6868 .code
6869 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6870 .endd
6871 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6872 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6873 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6874
6875
6876
6877
6878 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6879 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6880 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6881 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6882 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6883 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6884 an expansion string could contain:
6885 .code
6886 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6887 .endd
6888 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6889 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6890 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6891 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6892
6893 .new
6894 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6895 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6896 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6897 .wen
6898
6899 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6900 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6901 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6902 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6903 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6904 .code
6905 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6906 .endd
6907 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6908 white space is ignored.
6909 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6910 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6911 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6912
6913 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6914 When the type is PTR,
6915 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6916 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6917 .code
6918 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6919 .endd
6920 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6921 altered and nothing is added.
6922
6923 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6925 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6926 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6927 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6928 The field separator can be modified as above.
6929
6930 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6931 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6932 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6933 unless a field separator is specified.
6934 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6935 For SPF records the
6936 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6937 .code
6938 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6939 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6940 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6941 .endd
6942 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6943 white space is ignored.
6944
6945 .new
6946 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6947 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6948 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6949 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6950 specified.
6951 .code
6952 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6953 .endd
6954 .wen
6955
6956 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6957 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6958 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6959 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6960 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6961 each followed by a comma,
6962 that may appear before the record type.
6963
6964 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6965 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6966 a defer-option modifier.
6967 The possible keywords are
6968 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6969 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6970 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6971 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6972 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6973 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6974 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6975 .code
6976 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6977 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6978 .endd
6979 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6980 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6981
6982 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6983 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6984 The possible keywords are
6985 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6986 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6987 with the lookup.
6988 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6989 is not labelled as authenticated data
6990 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6991 The default is &"never"&.
6992
6993 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6994
6995 .new
6996 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6997 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6998 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6999 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7000 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7001 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7002
7003 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7004 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7005 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7006 .wen
7007
7008
7009 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7010 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7011 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7012 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7013 the pseudo-type MXH:
7014 .code
7015 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7016 .endd
7017 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7018 returned.
7019
7020 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7021 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7022 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7023 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7024 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7025 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7026 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7027 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7028 .code
7029 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7030 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7031 .endd
7032 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7033 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7034 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7035
7036 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7037 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7038 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7039 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7040 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7041 such a list.
7042
7043 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7044 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7045 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7046 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7047 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7048 result of a successful lookup such as:
7049 .code
7050 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7051 .endd
7052 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7053 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7054 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7055
7056 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7058 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7059 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7060 .code
7061 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7062 .endd
7063
7064
7065 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7066 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7067 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7068 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7069 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7070 .code
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7073 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7074 .endd
7075 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7076 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7077 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7078 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7079
7080 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7081 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7082 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7083
7084
7085
7086
7087 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7088 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7089 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7090 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7091 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7092 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7093 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7094 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7095 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7096 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7097 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7098 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7099 .code
7100 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7101 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7102 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7103 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7104 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7105 .endd
7106 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7107 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7108
7109 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7110 the way they handle the results of a query:
7111
7112 .ilist
7113 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7114 gives an error.
7115 .next
7116 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7117 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7118 .next
7119 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7120 from all of them are returned.
7121 .endlist
7122
7123
7124 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7125 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7126 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7127 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7128
7129
7130 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7131 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7132 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7133 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7134 .code
7135 data = ${lookup ldap \
7136 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7137 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7138 .endd
7139 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7140 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7141 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7142 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7143
7144 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7145 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7146 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7147
7148 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7149 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7150 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7151 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7152 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7153 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7154 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7155 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7156 &_exim.conf_&.
7157
7158
7159 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7160 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7161 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7162 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7163 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7164 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7165
7166 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7167 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7168 the string:
7169 .code
7170 * => \2A
7171 ( => \28
7172 ) => \29
7173 \ => \5C
7174 .endd
7175 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7176 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7177 .code
7178 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7179 .endd
7180 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7181 .code
7182 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7183 .endd
7184 yields
7185 .code
7186 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7187 .endd
7188 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7189 .code
7190 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7191 .endd
7192 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7193 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7194 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7195 .code
7196 , + " \ < > ;
7197 .endd
7198 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7199 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7200 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7201 .code
7202 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7203 .endd
7204 yields
7205 .code
7206 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7207 .endd
7208 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7209 .code
7210 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7211 .endd
7212 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7213 authentication below.
7214
7215
7216 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7217 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7218 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7219 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7220 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7221 by starting it with
7222 .code
7223 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7224 .endd
7225 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7226 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7227 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7228 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7229 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7230 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7231 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7232 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7233 failures, and timeouts.
7234
7235 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7236 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7237 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7238 doubled. For example
7239 .code
7240 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7241 .endd
7242 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7243 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7244 the local host) is used.
7245
7246 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7247 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7248 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7249 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7250 not available.
7251
7252 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7253 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7254 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7255 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7256 .code
7257 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7258 .endd
7259 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7260 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7261 .code
7262 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7263 .endd
7264 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7265 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7266 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7267 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7268 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7269 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7270 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7271 backup host.
7272
7273 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7274 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7275 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7276
7277 .ilist
7278 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7279 interface.
7280 .next
7281 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7282 .endlist
7283
7284
7285 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7286 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7287
7288
7289
7290 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7291 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7292 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7293 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7294 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7295 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7296 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7297 them. The following names are recognized:
7298 .display
7299 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7300 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7301 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7302 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7303 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7304 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7305 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7306 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7307 .endd
7308 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7309 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7310 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7311 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7312
7313 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7314 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7315 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7316 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7317 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7318 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7319 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7320 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7321 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7322
7323 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7324 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7325
7326 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7327 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7328 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7329 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7330 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7331 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7332 alternate list (colon-separated).
7333
7334 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7335 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7336 .code
7337 ${lookup ldap
7338 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7339 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7340 {$value}fail}
7341 .endd
7342 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7343 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7344 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7345 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7346
7347 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7348 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7349 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7350
7351 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7352 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7353 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7354 quoting has two advantages:
7355
7356 .ilist
7357 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7358 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7359 .next
7360 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7361 .endlist
7362
7363 For example, a setting such as
7364 .code
7365 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7366 .endd
7367 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7368
7369 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7370 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7371 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7372 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7373 .code
7374 PASS=${quote:$3}
7375 .endd
7376 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7377 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7378 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7379
7380
7381
7382 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7383 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7384 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7385 as a sequence of values, for example
7386 .code
7387 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7388 .endd
7389 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7390 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7391 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7392 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7393 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7394 directory.
7395
7396 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7397 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7398 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7399
7400 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7401 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7402 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7403 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7404 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7405 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7406 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7407 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7408 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7409
7410 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7411 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7412 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7413 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7414 .code
7415 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7416 value1.1,value1,,2
7417
7418 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7419 value two
7420
7421 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7422 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7423
7424 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7425 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7426 .endd
7427 You can
7428 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7429 results of LDAP lookups.
7430 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7431 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7432 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7433 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7434 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7435 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7436
7437
7438
7439
7440 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7441 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7442 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7443 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7444 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7445 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7446 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7447 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7448 .code
7449 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7450 .endd
7451 might return the string
7452 .code
7453 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7454 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7455 .endd
7456 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7457 .code
7458 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7459 .endd
7460 would just return
7461 .code
7462 Martin Guerre
7463 .endd
7464 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7465 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7466 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7467
7468
7469
7470 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7471 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7472 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7473 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7475 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7476 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7477 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7478 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7479 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7480 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7481 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7482 might be
7483 .code
7484 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7485 {$value}fail}
7486 .endd
7487 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7488 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7489 .code
7490 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7491 {$value}}
7492 .endd
7493 might be
7494 .code
7495 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7496 .endd
7497 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7498 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7499 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7500 .code
7501 Mister X
7502 .endd
7503 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7504 with a newline between the data for each row.
7505
7506
7507 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7508 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7509 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7510 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7511 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7512 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7513 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7514 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7515 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7516 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7517 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7518 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7519 information.
7520 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7521 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7522 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7523 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7524 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7525 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7526 .code
7527 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7528 .endd
7529 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7530 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7531 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7532 .code
7533 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7534 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7535 .endd
7536 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7537 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7538 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7539 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7540 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7541 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7542
7543 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7544 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7545 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7546 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7547 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7548 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7549 characters are not special.
7550
7551 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7552 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7553 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7554 done by starting the query with
7555 .display
7556 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7557 .endd
7558 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7559 .olist
7560 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7561 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7562 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7563 taken from there.
7564 .next
7565 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7566 .endlist
7567 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7568 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7569 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7570
7571 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7572 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7573 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7574 like this:
7575 .code
7576 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7577 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7578 master/db/name/pw
7579 .endd
7580 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7581 .code
7582 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7583 .endd
7584 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7585 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7586 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7587 .code
7588 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7589 .endd
7590
7591
7592 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7593 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7594 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7595 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7596 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7597 .display
7598 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7599 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7600 .endd
7601 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7602 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7603
7604 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7605 the queries.
7606
7607 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7608 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7609
7610 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7611 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7612 is zero because no rows are affected.
7613
7614
7615 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7616 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7617 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7618 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7619 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7620 looks like this:
7621 .code
7622 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7623 .endd
7624 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7625 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7626 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7627
7628 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7629 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7630 affected.
7631
7632 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7633 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7634 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7635 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7636 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7637 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7638 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7639 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7640 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7641 .code
7642 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7643 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7644 .endd
7645 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7646 .code
7647 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7648 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7649 .endd
7650 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7651 quote, which it doubles.
7652
7653 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7654 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7655 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7656 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7657 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7658 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7659 option.
7660 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7661 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7662
7663
7664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7666
7667 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7668 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7669 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7670 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7671 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7672 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7673 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7674 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7675 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7676
7677 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7678 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7679 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7680 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7681
7682 .new
7683 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7684 support all the complexity available in
7685 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7686 .wen
7687
7688
7689
7690 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7691 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7692 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7693 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7694 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7695 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7696 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7697 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7698
7699
7700 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7701 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7702 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7703
7704 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7705 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7706 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7707 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7708 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7709 .code
7710 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7711 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7712 .endd
7713 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7714 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7715 senders based on the receiving domain.
7716
7717
7718
7719
7720 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7721 .cindex "list" "negation"
7722 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7723 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7724 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7725 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7726 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7727 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7728
7729 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7730 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7731 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7732 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7733 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7734 .code
7735 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7736 .endd
7737 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7738 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7739 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7740 .code
7741 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7742 .endd
7743 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7744 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7745 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7746
7747 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7748 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7749 item.
7750
7751
7752
7753 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7754 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7755 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7756 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7757 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7758 file names are not allowed,
7759 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7760 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7761 lines:
7762
7763 .ilist
7764 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7765 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7766 .next
7767 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7768 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7769 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7770 .code
7771 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7772 .endd
7773 .endlist
7774
7775 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7776 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7777 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7778 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7779
7780 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7781 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7782 .code
7783 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7784 .endd
7785 and the file contains the lines
7786 .code
7787 !a.b.c
7788 *.b.c
7789 .endd
7790 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7791 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7792
7793
7794
7795 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7796 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7797 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7798 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7799 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7800 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7801 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7802 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7803
7804 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7805 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7806 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7807 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7808
7809
7810
7811
7812 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7813 .cindex "named lists"
7814 .cindex "list" "named"
7815 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7816 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7817 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7818 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7819 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7820 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7821 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7822 .code
7823 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7824 .endd
7825 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7826 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7827 configured with the line
7828 .code
7829 domains = +local_domains
7830 .endd
7831 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7832 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7833 .code
7834 dnslookup:
7835 driver = dnslookup
7836 domains = ! +local_domains
7837 transport = remote_smtp
7838 no_more
7839 .endd
7840 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7841 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7842 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7843 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7844 .code
7845 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7846 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7847 .endd
7848 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7849 .code
7850 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7851 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7852 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7853 .endd
7854 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7855 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7856 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7857 .code
7858 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7859 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7860 .endd
7861 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7862 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7863 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7864 .code
7865 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7866 .endd
7867 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7868 referenced lists if you can.
7869
7870 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7871 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7872 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7873 .code
7874 domains = +local_domains
7875 .endd
7876 on several of your routers
7877 or in several ACL statements,
7878 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7879 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7880 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7881 the same each time they are referenced.
7882
7883 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7884 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7885 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7886 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7887
7888
7889
7890 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7891 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7892 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7893 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7894 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7895 write
7896 .code
7897 ALIST = host1 : host2
7898 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7899 .endd
7900 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7901 .code
7902 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7903 .endd
7904 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7905 list, and write
7906 .code
7907 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7908 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7909 .endd
7910 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7911 .code
7912 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7913 .endd
7914
7915
7916 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7917 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7918 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7919 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7920 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7921 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7922 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7923 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7924 message. For example:
7925 .code
7926 domainlist special_domains = \
7927 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7928 .endd
7929 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7930 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7931 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7932 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7933 same list each time.
7934
7935 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7936 cache the result anyway. For example:
7937 .code
7938 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7939 .endd
7940 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7941 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7942
7943
7944
7945 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7946 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7947 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7948 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7949 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7950
7951 .ilist
7952 .cindex "primary host name"
7953 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7954 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7955 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7956 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7957 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7958 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7959 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7960 differ only in their names.
7961 .next
7962 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7963 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7964 .cindex "domain literal"
7965 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7966 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7967 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7968 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7969 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7970 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7971 .next
7972 .cindex "@mx_any"
7973 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7974 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7975 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7976 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7977 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7978 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7979 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7980 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7981 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7982 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7983 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7984
7985 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7986 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7987 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7988 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7989 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7990
7991 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7992 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7993 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7994 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7995 on a router). For example:
7996 .code
7997 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7998 .endd
7999 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8000 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8001
8002 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8003 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8004 contain negative items.
8005
8006 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8007 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8008 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8009 .code
8010 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8011 an.other.domain : ...
8012 .endd
8013 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8014 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8015 .code
8016 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8017 an.other.domain ? ...
8018 .endd
8019 .next
8020 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8021 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8022 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8023 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8024 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8025 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8026 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8027 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8028 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8029 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8030
8031 .next
8032 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8033 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8034 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8035 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8036 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8037 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8038 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8039 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8040 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8041
8042 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8043 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8044 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8045 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8046 expression by expansion, of course).
8047 .next
8048 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8049 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8050 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8051 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8052 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8053 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8054 .code
8055 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8056 .endd
8057 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8058 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8059 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8060 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8061 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8062 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8063 other statements in the same ACL.
8064
8065 .next
8066 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8067 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8068 .code
8069 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8070 .endd
8071 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8072 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8073
8074 .next
8075 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8076 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8077 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8078 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8079 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8080 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8081 expansion variable.
8082 .next
8083 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8084 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8085 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8086 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8087 .code
8088 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8089 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8090 .endd
8091 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8092 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8093 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8094 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8095 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8096 .next
8097 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8098 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8099 between the pattern and the domain.
8100 .endlist
8101
8102 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8103 .code
8104 domainlist funny_domains = \
8105 @ : \
8106 lib.unseen.edu : \
8107 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8108 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8109 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8110 nis;domains.byname : \
8111 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8112 .endd
8113 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8114 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8115 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8116 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8117 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8118 patterns earlier.
8119
8120
8121
8122 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8123 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8124 .cindex "list" "host list"
8125 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8126 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8127 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8128 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8129 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8130 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8131 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8132
8133
8134 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8135 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8136 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8137 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8138 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8139 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8140 not used.
8141
8142 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8143 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8144 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8145
8146
8147
8148 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8149 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8150 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8151 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8152 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8153 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8154 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8155 concerns.)
8156
8157 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8158 inspecting its IP address:
8159
8160 .ilist
8161 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8162 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8163 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8164 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8165 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8166 with the IP address of the subject host.
8167
8168 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8169 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8170 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8171 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8172 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8173
8174 .next
8175 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8176 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8177 domain name, as just described.
8178
8179 .next
8180 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8181 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8182 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8183 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8184 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8185 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8186 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8187 that can never match a client host.
8188
8189 .next
8190 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8191 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8192 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8193 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8194 .code
8195 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8196 accept hosts = @[]
8197 .endd
8198 .next
8199 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8200 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8201 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8202 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8203 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8204 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8205 significant end of the address.
8206
8207 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8208 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8209 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8210 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8211 .code
8212 192.168.23.236/31
8213 .endd
8214 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8215 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8216 matches.
8217
8218 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8219 .code
8220 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8221 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8222 .endd
8223 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8224 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8225 For example:
8226 .code
8227 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8228 .endd
8229 could make use of a file containing
8230 .code
8231 172.16.0.0/12
8232 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8233 .endd
8234 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8235 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8236 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8237 .code
8238 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8239 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8240 .endd
8241 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8242 list.
8243 .endlist
8244
8245
8246
8247 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8248 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8249 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8250 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8251 address, the pattern takes this form:
8252 .display
8253 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8254 .endd
8255 For example:
8256 .code
8257 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8258 .endd
8259 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8260 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8261 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8262 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8263 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8264 returned by the lookup is not used.
8265
8266 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8267 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8268 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8269 patterns of this form:
8270 .display
8271 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8272 .endd
8273 For example:
8274 .code
8275 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8276 .endd
8277 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8278 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8279 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8280 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8281 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8282
8283 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8284 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8285 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8286 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8287 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8288 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8289 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8290 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8291 addresses are always used.
8292
8293 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8294 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8295 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8296 configurations.
8297
8298 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8299 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8300 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8301 case the IP address is used on its own.
8302
8303
8304
8305 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8306 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8307 .cindex "unknown host name"
8308 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8309 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8310 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8311 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8312 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8313 above.)
8314
8315 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8316 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8317 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8318 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8319 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8320 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8321 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8322
8323 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8324 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8325
8326 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8327 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8328 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8329 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8330 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8331 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8332 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8333 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8334 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8335
8336 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8337 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8338
8339 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8340 .cindex "alias for host"
8341 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8342 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8343
8344 .ilist
8345 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8346 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8347 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8348 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8349 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8350 expression.
8351 .next
8352 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8353 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8354 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8355 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8356 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8357 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8358 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8359 example,
8360 .code
8361 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8362 .endd
8363 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8364 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8365 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8366 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8367 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8368 .code
8369 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8370 .endd
8371 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8372 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8373 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8374 required.
8375 .endlist
8376
8377
8378
8379
8380 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8381 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8382 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8383 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8384 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8385 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8386
8387 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8388 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8389
8390 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8391 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8392 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8393 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8394 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8395 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8396 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8397 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8398 not recognized in an indirected file).
8399
8400 .ilist
8401 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8402 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8403 .code
8404 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8405 .endd
8406 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8407 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8408
8409 .next
8410 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8411 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8412 example:
8413 .code
8414 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8415 192.168.4.5
8416 .endd
8417 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8418 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8419 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8420 .endlist
8421
8422 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8423 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8424 list.
8425
8426 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8427 "SECTmixwilhos"
8428 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8429
8430 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8431 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8432 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8433
8434 .ilist
8435 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8436 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8437 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8438 .code
8439 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8440 .endd
8441 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8442 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8443 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8444 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8445 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8446 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8447 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8448
8449 .next
8450 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8451 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8452 .code
8453 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8454 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8455 .endd
8456 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8457 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8458 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8459 this section.
8460 .endlist
8461
8462
8463 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8464 "SECTtemdnserr"
8465 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8466 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8467 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8468 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8469 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8470 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8471 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8472 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8473 host lists such as whitelists.
8474
8475
8476
8477 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8478 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8479 .cindex "unknown host name"
8480 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8481 If a pattern is of the form
8482 .display
8483 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8484 .endd
8485 for example
8486 .code
8487 dbm;/host/accept/list
8488 .endd
8489 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8490 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8491 is not used.
8492
8493 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8494 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8495 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8496 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8497 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8498 lookup, both using the same file.
8499
8500
8501
8502 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8503 If a pattern is of the form
8504 .display
8505 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8506 .endd
8507 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8508 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8509 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8510 .code
8511 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8512 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8513 .endd
8514 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8515 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8516 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8517 operator.
8518
8519 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8520 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8521 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8522
8523 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8524 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8525 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8526 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8527 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8528 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8529
8530
8531
8532
8533
8534 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8535 .cindex "list" "address list"
8536 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8537 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8538 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8539 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8540 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8541 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8542 using this option setting:
8543 .code
8544 senders = :
8545 .endd
8546 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8547 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8548 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8549 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8550
8551 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8552 example:
8553 .code
8554 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8555 .endd
8556 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8557 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8558 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8559 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8560 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8561 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8562 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8563 .code
8564 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8565 *@+hostile_domains:\
8566 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8567 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8568 .endd
8569 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8570 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8571 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8572 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8573 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8574
8575 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8576 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8577 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8578 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8579 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8580 .code
8581 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8582 .endd
8583
8584 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8585 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8586 senders:
8587
8588 .ilist
8589 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8590 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8591 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8592 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8593 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8594 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8595 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8596 .code
8597 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8598 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8599 .endd
8600 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8601 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8602
8603 .next
8604 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8605 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8606 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8607 example:
8608 .code
8609 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8610 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8611 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8612 .endd
8613 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8614 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8615 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8616 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8617
8618 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8619 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8620 panic log.
8621 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8622 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8623 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8624 default. For example, with this lookup:
8625 .code
8626 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8627 .endd
8628 the file could contains lines like this:
8629 .code
8630 user1@domain1.example
8631 *@domain2.example
8632 .endd
8633 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8634 that are tried is:
8635 .code
8636 nimrod@jaeger.example
8637 *@jaeger.example
8638 *
8639 .endd
8640 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8641 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8642
8643 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8644 .code
8645 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8646 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8647 .endd
8648 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8649 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8650 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8651 .endlist
8652
8653
8654 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8655 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8656 always fails.
8657
8658
8659 .ilist
8660 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8661 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8662 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8663 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8664 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8665 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8666 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8667 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8668 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8669
8670 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8671 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8672 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8673 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8674 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8675 with
8676 .code
8677 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8678 .endd
8679 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8680 .code
8681 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8682 .endd
8683 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8684
8685 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8686 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8687 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8688 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8689 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8690 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8691 .code
8692 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8693 spammer3 : spammer4
8694 .endd
8695 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8696 doubling.
8697
8698 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8699 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8700 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8701 might have entries like
8702 .code
8703 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8704 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8705 *: ^\d{8}$
8706 .endd
8707 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8708 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8709 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8710 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8711
8712 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8713 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8714 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8715
8716 .next
8717 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8718 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8719 can only return a single list of local parts.
8720 .endlist
8721
8722 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8723 in these two examples:
8724 .code
8725 senders = +my_list
8726 senders = *@+my_list
8727 .endd
8728 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8729 example it is a named domain list.
8730
8731
8732
8733
8734 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8735 .cindex "case of local parts"
8736 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8737 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8738 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8739 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8740 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8741 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8742 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8743 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8744 default.
8745
8746 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8747 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8748 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8749 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8750 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8751 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8752 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8753 case-independent.
8754
8755 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8756 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8757 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8758 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8759 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8760 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8761 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8762 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8763
8764
8765
8766 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8767 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8768 .cindex "local part" "list"
8769 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8770 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8771 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8772 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8773 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8774 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8775 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8776 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8777
8778 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8779 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8780 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8781 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8782 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8783 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8784 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8785 types.
8786 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8787
8788
8789
8790
8791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8793
8794 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8795 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8796 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8797 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8798
8799 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8800 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8801 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8802 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8803 escape character, as described in the following section.
8804
8805 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8806 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8807 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8808 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8809 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8810 reasons.
8811
8812
8813
8814 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8815 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8816 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8817 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8818 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8819 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8820 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8821 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8822
8823 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8824 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8825 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8826 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8827 .code
8828 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8829 .endd
8830 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8831 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8832 string.
8833
8834
8835
8836 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8837 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8838 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8839 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8840 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8841 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8842 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8843 encoding.
8844
8845 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8846 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8847 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8848
8849
8850 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8851 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8852 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8853 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8854 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8855 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8856 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8857 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8858 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8859 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8860 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8861 and &%nhash%&.
8862
8863 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8864 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8865 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8866
8867 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8868 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8869 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8870 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8871 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8872 .code
8873 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8874 .endd
8875 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8876 Exim message identifier. For example:
8877 .code
8878 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8879 .endd
8880 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8881 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8882
8883
8884 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8885 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8886 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8887 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8888 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8889 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8890 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8891 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8892 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8893 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8894 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8895 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8896 being expanded.
8897
8898
8899
8900
8901 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8902 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8903 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8904 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8905 white space is significant.
8906
8907 .vlist
8908 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8909 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8910 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8911 .code
8912 $local_part
8913 ${domain}
8914 .endd
8915 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8916 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8917 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8918 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8919 given, the expansion fails.
8920
8921 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8922 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8923 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8924 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8925 .code
8926 ${lc:$local_part}
8927 .endd
8928 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8929 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8930 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8931 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8932 string easier to understand.
8933
8934 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8935 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8936 expansion item below.
8937
8938
8939 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8940 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8941 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8942 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8943 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8944 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8945 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8946 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8947 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8948 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8949 the result of the expansion.
8950 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8951 the expansion result is an empty string.
8952 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8953
8954
8955 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8956 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8957 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8958 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8959 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8960 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8961 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8962 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8963 .display
8964 &`version `&
8965 &`serial_number `&
8966 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8967 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8968 &`notbefore `& time
8969 &`notafter `& time
8970 &`sig_algorithm `&
8971 &`signature `&
8972 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8973 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8974 &`crl_uri `& list
8975 .endd
8976 If the field is found,
8977 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8978 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8979 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8980 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8981
8982 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8983 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8984 extracted is used.
8985
8986 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8987
8988 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8989 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8990 not quite
8991 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8992 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8993 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8994 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8995 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8996 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
8997 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8998 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8999
9000 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9001 take an optional modifier of "int"
9002 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9003 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9004 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9005
9006 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9007 newline-separated by default,
9008 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9009 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9010 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9011
9012 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9013 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9014 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9015 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9016 if so the element tags are omitted.
9017
9018 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9019
9020 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9021 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9022 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9023 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9024 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9025 .code
9026 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9027 .endd
9028 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9029 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9030 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9031
9032 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9033 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9034 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9035 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9036 must have the following type:
9037 .code
9038 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9039 .endd
9040 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9041 function should return one of the following values:
9042
9043 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9044 into the expanded string that is being built.
9045
9046 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9047 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9048
9049 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9050 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9051
9052 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9053
9054 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9055 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9056 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9057
9058
9059 .new
9060 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9061 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9062 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9063 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9064 removed.
9065 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9066 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9067 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9068
9069 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9070 appear, for example:
9071 .code
9072 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9073 .endd
9074 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9075 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9076
9077 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9078 search failure.
9079 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9080 search success.
9081 .wen
9082
9083
9084 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9085 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9086 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9087 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9088 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9089 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9090 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9091 form:
9092 .display
9093 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9094 .endd
9095 .vindex "&$value$&"
9096 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9097 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9098 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9099 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9100 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9101 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9102 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9103 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9104 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9105
9106 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9107 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9108 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9109 yield &"2001"&:
9110 .code
9111 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9112 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9113 .endd
9114 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9115 appear, for example:
9116 .code
9117 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9118 .endd
9119 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9120 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9121
9122
9123 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9124 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9125 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9126 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9127 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9128 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9129 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9130 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9131 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9132 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9133 <&'string3'&> as before.
9134
9135 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9136 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9137 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9138 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9139 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9140 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9141 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9142 provided. For example:
9143 .code
9144 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9145 .endd
9146 yields &"42"&, and
9147 .code
9148 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9149 .endd
9150 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9151 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9152
9153
9154 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9155 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9156 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9157 .vindex "&$item$&"
9158 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9159 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9160 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9161 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9162 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9163 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9164 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9165 .code
9166 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9167 .endd
9168 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9169 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9170
9171
9172 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9173 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9174 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9175 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9176 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9177 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9178
9179 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9180 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9181 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9182 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9183 .code
9184 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9185 .endd
9186 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9187 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9188 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9189 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9190 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9191 .code
9192 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9193 .endd
9194 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9195 letters appear. For example:
9196 .display
9197 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9198 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9199 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9200 .endd
9201
9202 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9203 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9204 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9205 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9206 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9207 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9208 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9209 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9210 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9211 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9212 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9213 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9214 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9215 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9216 .code
9217 $header_reply-to:
9218 .endd
9219 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9220 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9221 lines) may be present.
9222
9223 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9224 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9225
9226 .ilist
9227 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9228 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9229 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9230
9231 .next
9232 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9233 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9234 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9235 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9236 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9237 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9238 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9239 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9240
9241 .next
9242 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9243 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9244 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9245 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9246 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9247 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9248 .endlist ilist
9249
9250 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9251 command of the following form:
9252 .code
9253 headers charset "UTF-8"
9254 .endd
9255 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9256 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9257 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9258 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9259 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9260 ISO-8859-1.
9261
9262 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9263 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9264 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9265 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9266
9267 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9268 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9269 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9270 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9271 router or transport are not accessible.
9272
9273 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9274 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9275 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9276 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9277 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9278 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9279
9280 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9281 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9282 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9283 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9284 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9285 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9286 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9287
9288 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9289 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9290 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9291 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9292 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9293 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9294 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9295 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9296
9297
9298 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9299 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9300 .cindex &%hmac%&
9301 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9302 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9303 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9304 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9305 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9306 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9307 present. For example:
9308 .code
9309 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9310 .endd
9311 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9312 produces:
9313 .code
9314 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9315 .endd
9316 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9317 an Exim configuration:
9318 .code
9319 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9320 .endd
9321 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9322 .code
9323 headers_add = \
9324 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9325 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9326 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9327 .endd
9328 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9329 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9330 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9331 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9332 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9333 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9334
9335
9336 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9337 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9338 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9339 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9340 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9341 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9342 .code
9343 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9344 .endd
9345 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9346 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9347 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9348 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9349 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9350
9351 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9352 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9353 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9354 .code
9355 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9356 .endd
9357 you can use
9358 .code
9359 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9360 .endd
9361
9362 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9363 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9364 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9365 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9366 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9367 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9368 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9369 some of the braces:
9370 .code
9371 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9372 .endd
9373 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9374 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9375 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9376
9377
9378 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9379 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9380 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9381 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9382 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9383 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9384 apart from an optional leading minus,
9385 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9386
9387 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9388 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9389
9390 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9391 If the number is negative, the fields are
9392 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9393 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9394 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9395
9396 If the modulus of the
9397 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9398 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9399
9400 For example:
9401 .code
9402 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9403 .endd
9404 yields &"42"&, and
9405 .code
9406 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9407 .endd
9408 yields &"result: 99"&.
9409
9410 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9411 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9412 extracted is used.
9413 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9414
9415
9416 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9417 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9418 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9419 described in the next item.
9420
9421 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9422 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9423 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9424 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9425 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9426 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9427 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9428 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9429 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9430
9431 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9432 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9433 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9434 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9435 out by the system administrator.
9436
9437 .vindex "&$value$&"
9438 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9439 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9440 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9441 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9442 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9443 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9444 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9445 original lookup fails.
9446
9447 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9448 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9449 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9450 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9451 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9452 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9453 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9454 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9455
9456 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9457 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9458 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9459 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9460
9461 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9462 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9463 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9464 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9465
9466 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9467 .code
9468 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9469 .endd
9470 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9471 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9472 .code
9473 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9474 {$value}fail}
9475 .endd
9476
9477
9478 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9479 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9480 .vindex "&$item$&"
9481 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9482 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9483 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9484 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9485 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9486 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9487 .code
9488 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9489 .endd
9490 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9491 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9492 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9493
9494 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9495 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9496 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9497 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9498 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9499 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9500 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9501 .code
9502 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9503 .endd
9504 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9505 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9506 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9507 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9508 example,
9509 .code
9510 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9511 .endd
9512 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9513
9514
9515
9516 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9517 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9518 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9519 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9520 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9521 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9522 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9523 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9524
9525 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9526 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9527 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9528 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9529 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9530 not its contents.
9531
9532 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9533 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9534 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9535
9536 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9537 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9538
9539
9540 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9541 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9542 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9543 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9544 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9545 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9546 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9547 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9548
9549 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9550 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9551 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9552 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9553 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9554 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9555 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9556 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9557 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9558 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9559
9560 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9561 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9562 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9563 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9564
9565 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9566 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9567 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9568 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9569 is the expansion of the third argument.
9570
9571 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9572 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9573 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9574
9575 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9576 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9577 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9578 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9579 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9580 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9581 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9582 newlines are left in the string.
9583 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9584 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9585 the string expansion fails.
9586
9587 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9588 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9589
9590
9591
9592 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9593 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9594 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9595 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9596 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9597 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9598 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9599 examples:
9600 .code
9601 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9602 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9603 .endd
9604 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9605 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9606 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9607 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9608 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9609 example:
9610 .code
9611 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9612 .endd
9613 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9614 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9615 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9616 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9617 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9618 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9619 .code
9620 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9621 .endd
9622 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9623 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9624 turns them into spaces:
9625 .code
9626 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9627 .endd
9628 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9629 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9630 addition, the following errors can occur:
9631
9632 .ilist
9633 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9634 .next
9635 Failure to connect the socket;
9636 .next
9637 Failure to write the request string;
9638 .next
9639 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9640 .endlist
9641
9642 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9643 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9644 errors occurs. For example:
9645 .code
9646 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9647 {socket failure}}
9648 .endd
9649 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9650 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9651 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9652 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9653 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9654
9655 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9656 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9657
9658
9659 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9660 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9661 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9662 .vindex "&$value$&"
9663 .vindex "&$item$&"
9664 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9665 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9666 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9667 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9668 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9669 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9670 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9671 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9672 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9673 .code
9674 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9675 .endd
9676 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9677 can be found:
9678 .code
9679 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9680 .endd
9681 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9682 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9683 expansion items.
9684
9685 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9686 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9687 expansion item above.
9688
9689 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9690 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9691 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9692 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9693 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9694 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9695 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9696 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9697 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9698
9699 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9700 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9701 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9702 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9703 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9704 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9705 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9706 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9707 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9708 character.
9709
9710 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9711 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9712 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9713 .vindex "&$value$&"
9714 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9715 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9716 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9717 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9718 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9719 &$value$&.
9720
9721 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9722 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9723 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9724 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9725
9726 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9727 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9728 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9729 troubleshoot:
9730 .code
9731 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9732 log_message = Output of id: $value
9733 .endd
9734 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9735 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9736 .code
9737 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9738 .endd
9739
9740 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9741 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9742 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9743 .code
9744 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9745 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9746 ...
9747 endif
9748 .endd
9749 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9750 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9751 commands.
9752
9753 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9754 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9755 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9756 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9757
9758 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9759 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9760
9761
9762 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9763 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9764 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9765 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9766 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9767 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9768 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9769 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9770 .code
9771 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9772 .endd
9773 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9774 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9775 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9776 .code
9777 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9778 .endd
9779 yields &"defabc"&, and
9780 .code
9781 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9782 .endd
9783 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9784 the regular expression from string expansion.
9785
9786
9787
9788 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9789 .cindex sorting "a list"
9790 .cindex list sorting
9791 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9792 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9793 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9794 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9795 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9796 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9797 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9798 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9799 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9800 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9801 to give values for comparison.
9802
9803 The item result is a sorted list,
9804 with the original list separator,
9805 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9806
9807 Examples:
9808 .code
9809 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9810 .endd
9811 sorts a list of numbers, and
9812 .code
9813 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9814 .endd
9815 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9816
9817
9818 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9819 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9820 .cindex "substring extraction"
9821 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9822 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9823 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9824 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9825 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9826 .code
9827 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9828 .endd
9829 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9830 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9831 omitted.
9832
9833 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9834 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9835 length required. For example
9836 .code
9837 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9838 .endd
9839 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9840 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9841 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9842 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9843
9844 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9845 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9846 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9847 .code
9848 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9849 .endd
9850 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9851 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9852 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9853 .code
9854 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9855 .endd
9856 yields an empty string, but
9857 .code
9858 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9859 .endd
9860 yields &"1"&.
9861
9862 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9863 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9864 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9865 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9866 .code
9867 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9868 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9869 .endd
9870 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9871
9872
9873
9874 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9875 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9876 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9877 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9878 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9879 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9880 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9881 replacement list. For example
9882 .code
9883 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9884 .endd
9885 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9886 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9887 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9888 place.
9889 .endlist
9890
9891
9892
9893 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9894 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9895 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9896 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9897 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9898 following operations can be performed:
9899
9900 .vlist
9901 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9902 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9903 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9904 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9905 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9906 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9907
9908
9909 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9910 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9911 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9912 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9913 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9914 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9915 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9916 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9917 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9918
9919 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9920 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9921 character. For example:
9922 .code
9923 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9924 .endd
9925 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9926 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9927 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9928 processing lists.
9929
9930 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9931 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9932 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9933 email address separator. For the example header line:
9934 .code
9935 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9936 .endd
9937 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9938 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9939 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9940 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9941 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9942 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9943 quoted.
9944 .code
9945 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9946 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9947 user@example.com
9948 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9949 Last:user@example.com
9950 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9951 user@example.com
9952 .endd
9953
9954 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9955 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9956 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9957 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9958 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9959 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9960 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9961 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9962 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9963
9964 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9965 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9966 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9967 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9968 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9969 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9970 string.
9971
9972
9973 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9975 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9976 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9977 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9978
9979
9980 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9981 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9982 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9983 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9984 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9985 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9986 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9987
9988
9989 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9990 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9991 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9992 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9993 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9994 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9995 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9996 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9997 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9998 C programming language):
9999 .table2 70pt 300pt
10000 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10001 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10002 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10003 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10004 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10005 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10006 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10007 .endtable
10008 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10009 space is permitted before or after operators.
10010
10011 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10012 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10013 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10014 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10015 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10016
10017 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10018 or 1024*1024*1024,
10019 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10020 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10021
10022 .display
10023 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10024 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10025 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10026 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10027 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10028 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10029 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10030 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10031 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10032 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10033 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10034 .endd
10035
10036 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10037 .code
10038 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10039 condition = \
10040 ${if and { \
10041 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10042 { \
10043 < \
10044 {$recipients_count} \
10045 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10046 } \
10047 }{yes}{no}}
10048 .endd
10049 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10050 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10051
10052
10053 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10054 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10055 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10056 example,
10057 .code
10058 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10059 .endd
10060 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10061 and then re-expands what it has found.
10062
10063
10064 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10065 .cindex "Unicode"
10066 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10067 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10068 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10069 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10070 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10071 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10072 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10073 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10074 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10075
10076 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10077 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10078 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10079 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10080 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10081 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10082 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10083
10084
10085 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10086 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10087 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10088 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10089 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10090 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10091 .code
10092 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10093 .endd
10094 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10095 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10096
10097
10098
10099 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10100 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10101 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10102 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10103 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10104 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10105
10106
10107
10108 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10109 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10110 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10111 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10112 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10113 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10114 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10115
10116
10117 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10118 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10119 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10120 .cindex "lower casing"
10121 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10122 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10123 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10124 .code
10125 ${lc:$local_part}
10126 .endd
10127
10128 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10129 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10130 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10131 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10132 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10133 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10134 .code
10135 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10136 .endd
10137 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10138 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10139 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10140
10141
10142 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10143 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10144 .cindex "list" "item count"
10145 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10146 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10147 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10148
10149
10150 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10151 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10152 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10153 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10154 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10155 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10156 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10157 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10158 matching list is returned.
10159
10160
10161 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10162 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10163 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10164 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10165 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10166 empty.
10167
10168
10169 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10170 .cindex "masked IP address"
10171 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10172 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10173 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10174 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10175 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10176 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10177 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10178 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10179 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10180 .code
10181 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10182 .endd
10183 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10184 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10185 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10186 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10187 .code
10188 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10189 .endd
10190 returns the string
10191 .code
10192 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10193 .endd
10194 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10195
10196
10197 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10198 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10199 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10200 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10201 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10202 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10203 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10204
10205
10206 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10207 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10208 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10209 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10210 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10211 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10212 .code
10213 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10214 .endd
10215 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10216
10217
10218 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10220 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10221 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10222 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10223 is an empty string or
10224 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10225 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10226 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10227 respectively For example,
10228 .code
10229 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10230 .endd
10231 becomes
10232 .code
10233 "ab\"*\"cd"
10234 .endd
10235 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10236 variable or a message header.
10237
10238 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10239 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10240 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10241 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10242 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10243 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10244 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10245
10246
10247 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10248 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10249 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10250 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10251 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10252 .code
10253 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10254 .endd
10255 returns
10256 .code
10257 two%20%5C2A%20two
10258 .endd
10259 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10260 yields an unchanged string.
10261
10262
10263 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10264 .cindex "random number"
10265 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10266 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10267 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10268 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10269 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10270 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10271 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10272 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10273 random().
10274
10275
10276 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10277 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10278 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10279 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10280 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10281 for DNS. For example,
10282 .code
10283 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10284 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10285 .endd
10286 returns
10287 .code
10288 4.2.0.192
10289 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10290 .endd
10291
10292
10293 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10294 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10295 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10296 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10297 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10298 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10299 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10300 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10301 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10302 characters
10303 .code
10304 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10305 .endd
10306 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10307 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10308 characters.
10309
10310
10311 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10312 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10313 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10314 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10315 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10316 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10317 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10318 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10319
10320 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10321 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10322 to use this operator as well.
10323
10324
10325
10326 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10327 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10328 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10329 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10330 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10331 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10332 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10333
10334
10335 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10336 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10337 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10338 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10339 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10340 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10341 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10342
10343
10344 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10345 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10346 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10347 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10348 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10349 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10350 certificate,
10351 and returns
10352 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10353 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10354
10355
10356 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10357 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10358 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10359 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10360 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10361 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10362 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10363 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10364 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10365 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10366 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10367 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10368 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10369
10370 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10371 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10372 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10373
10374 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10375 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10376 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10377 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10378 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10379
10380
10381
10382 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10383 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10384 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10385 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10386 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10387 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10388
10389
10390 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10391 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10392 .cindex "substring extraction"
10393 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10394 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10395 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10396 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10397 .code
10398 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10399 .endd
10400 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10401 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10402
10403 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10404 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10405 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10406 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10407 seconds.
10408
10409 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10410 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10411 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10412 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10413 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10414 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10415 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10416
10417 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10418 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10419 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10420 .cindex "upper casing"
10421 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10422 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10423 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10424
10425 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10426 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10427 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10428 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10429 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10430 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10431 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10432 .endlist
10433
10434
10435
10436
10437
10438
10439 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10440 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10441 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10442 while expanding strings:
10443
10444 .vlist
10445 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10446 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10447 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10448 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10449 condition.
10450
10451 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10452 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10453 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10454 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10455 are:
10456 .display
10457 &`= `& equal
10458 &`== `& equal
10459 &`> `& greater
10460 &`>= `& greater or equal
10461 &`< `& less
10462 &`<= `& less or equal
10463 .endd
10464 For example:
10465 .code
10466 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10467 .endd
10468 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10469 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10470 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10471 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10472 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10473 zero.
10474
10475 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10476 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10477 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10478
10479
10480 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10481 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10482 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10483 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10484 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10485 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10486 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10487 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10488 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10489 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10490 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10491 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10492 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10493 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10494
10495 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10496 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10497 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10498 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10499 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10500 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10501 false if zero.
10502 An empty string is treated as false.
10503 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10504 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10505 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10506
10507 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10508 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10509 For example:
10510 .code
10511 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10512 .endd
10513
10514
10515 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10516 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10517 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10518 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10519 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10520 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10521 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10522 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10523
10524 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10525
10526 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10527 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10528 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10529 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10530 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10531 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10532 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10533 included in the binary.
10534
10535 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10536 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10537 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10538 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10539 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10540 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10541 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10542 string in LDAP form is:
10543 .code
10544 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10545 .endd
10546 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10547 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10548 .code
10549 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10550 .endd
10551 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10552 supported:
10553
10554 .ilist
10555 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10556 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10557 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10558 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10559 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10560 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10561 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10562 comparison fails.
10563
10564 .next
10565 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10566 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10567 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10568 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10569 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10570 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10571
10572 .next
10573 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10574 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10575 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10576 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10577 whatever its length.
10578
10579 .next
10580 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10581 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10582 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10583 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10584 .endlist
10585 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10586 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10587 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10588 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10589 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10590 support &[crypt16()]&.
10591
10592 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10593 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10594 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10595 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10596 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10597
10598 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10599 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10600 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10601
10602 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10603 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10604 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10605 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10606 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10607
10608 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10609 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10610 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10611 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10612 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10613 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10614 .code
10615 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10616 .endd
10617 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10618 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10619
10620 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10621 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10622 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10623 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10624 exists in the message. For example,
10625 .code
10626 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10627 .endd
10628 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10629 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10630
10631 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10632 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10633 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10634 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10635 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10636 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10637 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10638 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10639 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10640
10641 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10642 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10643 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10644 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10645 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10646 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10647 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10648 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10649
10650 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10651 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10652 .cindex "first delivery"
10653 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10654 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10655 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10656 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10657
10658
10659 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10660 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10661 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10662 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10663 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10664 .vindex "&$item$&"
10665 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10666 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10667 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10668 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10669 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10670 .ilist
10671 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10672 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10673 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10674 .next
10675 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10676 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10677 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10678 .endlist
10679 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10680 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10681 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10682 list separator is changed to a comma:
10683 .code
10684 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10685 .endd
10686 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10687 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10688
10689 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10690
10691
10692 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10693 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10694 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10695 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10696 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10697 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10698 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10699 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10700 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10701 case-independent.
10702
10703 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10704 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10705 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10706 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10707 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10708 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10709 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10710 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10711 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10712 case-independent.
10713
10714 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10715 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10716 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10717 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10718 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10719 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10720 is true.
10721
10722 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10723 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10724 .code
10725 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10726 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10727 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10728 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10729 .endd
10730
10731 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10732 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10733 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10734 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10735 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10736 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10737 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10738 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10739 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10740 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10741 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10742
10743 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10744 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10745 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10746 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10747 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10748
10749 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10750 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10751 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10752 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10753 .code
10754 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10755 .endd
10756 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10757
10758 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10759 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10760 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10761 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10762 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10763 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10764 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10765 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10766 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10767 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10768 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10769 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10770 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10771 this can be used.
10772
10773
10774 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10775 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10776 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10777 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10778 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10779 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10780 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10781 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10782 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10783 case-independent.
10784
10785 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10786 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10787 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10788 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10789 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10790 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10791 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10792 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10793 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10794 case-independent.
10795
10796
10797 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10798 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10799 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10800 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10801 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10802 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10803 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10804 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10805 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10806 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10807 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10808 For example,
10809 .code
10810 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10811 .endd
10812 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10813 backslashes is also required.
10814
10815 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10816 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10817 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10818 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10819 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10820 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10821
10822 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10823 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10824 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10825 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10826 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10827 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10828 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10829 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10830
10831 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10832 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10833 See &*match_local_part*&.
10834
10835 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10836 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10837 See &*match_local_part*&.
10838
10839 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10840 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10841 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10842 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10843 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10844 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10845 .code
10846 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10847 .endd
10848 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10849
10850 .ilist
10851 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10852 .next
10853 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10854 .next
10855 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10856 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10857 in a single test such as
10858 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10859 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10860 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10861 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10862 .code
10863 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10864 .endd
10865 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10866 .next
10867 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10868 .next
10869 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10870 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10871 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10872 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10873 masks. For example:
10874 .code
10875 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10876 .endd
10877 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10878 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10879 address mask, for example:
10880 .code
10881 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10882 .endd
10883 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10884 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10885 .code
10886 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10887 .endd
10888 .endlist ilist
10889
10890 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10891 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10892
10893 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10894
10895 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10896 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10897 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10898 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10899 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10900 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10901 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10902 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10903 example is:
10904 .code
10905 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10906 .endd
10907 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10908 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10909 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10910 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10911 .code
10912 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10913 .endd
10914 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10915 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10916 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10917 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10918 caselessly.
10919
10920 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10921 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10922
10923 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10924 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10925 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10926 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10927
10928 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10929 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10930 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10931 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10932 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10933 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10934 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10935 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10936 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10937 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10938 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10939 .code
10940 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10941 .endd
10942 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10943 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10944
10945 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10946 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10947 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10948 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10949 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10950 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10951 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10952
10953 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10954 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10955 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10956 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10957 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10958 .code
10959 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10960 .endd
10961 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10962 .code
10963 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10964 .endd
10965 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10966 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10967 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10968 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10969 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10970 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10971 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10972 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10973
10974
10975 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10976 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10977 .cindex "Cyrus"
10978 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10979 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10980 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10981 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10982 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10983 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10984
10985 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10986 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10987 building Exim. For example:
10988 .code
10989 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10990 .endd
10991 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10992 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10993 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10994 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10995
10996 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10997 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10998 configuration, you might have this:
10999 .code
11000 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11001 .endd
11002 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11003 .code
11004 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11005 .endd
11006 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11007 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11008 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11009 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11010 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11011 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11012
11013
11014 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11015 .cindex "Radius"
11016 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11017 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11018 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11019 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11020 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11021 support.
11022
11023 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11024 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11025 this library, you need to set
11026 .code
11027 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11028 .endd
11029 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11030 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11031 .code
11032 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11033 .endd
11034 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11035 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11036 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11037
11038 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11039 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11040 the authentication is successful. For example:
11041 .code
11042 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11043 .endd
11044
11045
11046 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11047 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11048 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11049 .cindex "Cyrus"
11050 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11051 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11052 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11053 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11054 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11055 by a process that is not running as root.
11056
11057 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11058 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11059 building Exim. For example:
11060 .code
11061 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11062 .endd
11063 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11064 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11065 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11066
11067 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11068 two are mandatory. For example:
11069 .code
11070 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11071 .endd
11072 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11073 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11074 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11075 .endlist vlist
11076
11077
11078
11079 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11080 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11081 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11082 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11083 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11084 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11085 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11086
11087
11088 .vlist
11089 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11090 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11091 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11092 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11093 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11094 For example,
11095 .code
11096 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11097 .endd
11098 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11099 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11100 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11101
11102 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11103 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11104 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11105 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11106 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11107 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11108 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11109 parsed but not evaluated.
11110 .endlist
11111 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11112
11113
11114
11115
11116 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11117 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11118 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11119 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11120 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11121
11122 .vlist
11123 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11124 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11125 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11126 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11127 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11128 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11129 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11130 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11131 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11132 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11133 matching condition.
11134
11135 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11136 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11137 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11138 any unused variables being made empty.
11139
11140 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11141 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11142 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11143 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11144 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11145 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11146 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11147 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11148 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11149 during subsequent delivery.
11150
11151 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11152 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11153 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11154 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11155 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11156 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11157 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11158 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11159 delivery.
11160
11161 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11162 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11163 this variable has the number of arguments.
11164
11165 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11166 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11167 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11168 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11169 be preserved by coding like this:
11170 .code
11171 warn !verify = sender
11172 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11173 .endd
11174 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11175 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11176 failure.
11177
11178 .vitem &$address_data$&
11179 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11180 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11181 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11182 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11183 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11184 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11185 user filter files.
11186
11187 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11188 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11189 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11190 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11191 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11192 from the child's routing.
11193
11194 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11195 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11196 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11197 address.
11198
11199 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11200 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11201 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11202
11203 .vitem &$address_file$&
11204 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11205 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11206 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11207 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11208 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11209 .code
11210 /home/r2d2/savemail
11211 .endd
11212 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11213 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11214 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11215 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11216 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11217 to the relevant file.
11218
11219 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11220 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11221 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11222 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11223
11224 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11225 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11226 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11227 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11228
11229 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11230 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11231 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11232 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11233 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11234 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11235 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11236 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11237 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11238 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11239 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11240 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11241 command line option.
11242
11243 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11244 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11245 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11246 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11247 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11248 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11249 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11250 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11251 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11252 the ACL's as well.
11253
11254
11255 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11256 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11257 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11258 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11259 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11260 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11261 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11262 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11263 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11264 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11265 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11266
11267 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11268 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11269 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11270 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11271 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11272
11273
11274 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11275 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11276 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11277 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11278 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11279 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11280 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11281 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11282 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11283 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11284 an undefined mechanism.
11285
11286 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11287 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11288 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11289 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11290 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11291 the ACL malware condition.
11292
11293 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11294 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11295 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11296 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11297 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11298 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11299
11300 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11301 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11302 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11303 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11304 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11305 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11306 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11307
11308 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11309 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11310 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11311 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11312 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11313
11314 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11315 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11316 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11317 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11318 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11319
11320 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11321 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11322 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11323 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11324 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11325 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11326 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11327
11328 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11329 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11330 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11331 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11332 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11333 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11334 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11335
11336 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11337 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11338 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11339
11340 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11341 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11342 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11343 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11344 compilations of the same version of the program.
11345
11346 .new
11347 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11348 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11349 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11350 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11351 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11352 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11353
11354 .vitem &$config_file$&
11355 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11356 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11357 .wen
11358
11359 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11360 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11361 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11362 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11363 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11364
11365 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11366 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11367 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11368 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11369 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11370
11371 .new
11372 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11373 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11374 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11375 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11376 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11377 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11378 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11379 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11380 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11381 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11382 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11383 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11384 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11385 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11386 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11387 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11388 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11389 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11390 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11391 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11392 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11393
11394 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11395 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11396 When a message has been received this variable contains
11397 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11398 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11399 .wen
11400
11401 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11402 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11403 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11404 &$dnslist_value$&
11405 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11406 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11407 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11408 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11409 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11410 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11411 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11412 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11413 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11414
11415 .vitem &$domain$&
11416 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11417 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11418 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11419 case for &$domain$&.
11420
11421 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11422 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11423 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11424 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11425
11426 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11427 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11428 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11429 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11430 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11431 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11432
11433 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11434 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11435 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11436
11437 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11438
11439 .ilist
11440 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11441 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11442 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11443 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11444 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11445 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11446 the &(smtp)& transport.
11447
11448 .next
11449 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11450 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11451 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11452 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11453
11454 .next
11455 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11456 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11457 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11458 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11459 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11460 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11461
11462 .next
11463 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11464 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11465 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11466 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11467 .endlist
11468
11469
11470 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11471 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11472 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11473 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11474 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11475 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11476 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11477 used.
11478
11479 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11480 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11481 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11482 to nothing.
11483
11484 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11485 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11486 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11487
11488 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11489 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11490 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11491
11492 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11493 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11494 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11495
11496 .new
11497 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11498 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11499 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11500 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11501 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11502 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11503 .wen
11504
11505 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11506 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11507 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11508 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11509 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11510
11511 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11512 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11513 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11514 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11515 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11516
11517 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11518 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11519 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11520 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11521 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11522
11523 .vitem &$home$&
11524 .vindex "&$home$&"
11525 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11526 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11527 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11528 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11529 by a setting on the transport itself.
11530
11531 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11532 of the environment variable HOME.
11533
11534 .vitem &$host$&
11535 .vindex "&$host$&"
11536 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11537 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11538 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11539 to local and remote transports.
11540
11541 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11542 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11543 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11544 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11545 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11546 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11547 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11548 is connected.
11549
11550 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11551 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11552 client is connected.
11553
11554
11555 .vitem &$host_address$&
11556 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11557 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11558 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11559 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11560
11561 .vitem &$host_data$&
11562 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11563 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11564 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11565 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11566 .code
11567 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11568 message = $host_data
11569 .endd
11570 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11571 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11572 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11573 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11574 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11575 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11576 variables is set to &"1"&.
11577
11578 .ilist
11579 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11580 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11581
11582 .next
11583 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11584 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11585 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11586 .endlist ilist
11587
11588 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11589 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11590 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11591 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11592 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11593 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11594 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11595 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11596 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11597 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11598
11599 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11600 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11601 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11602
11603 .vitem &$host_port$&
11604 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11605 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11606 for an outbound connection.
11607
11608
11609 .vitem &$inode$&
11610 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11611 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11612 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11613 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11614 a unique name for the file.
11615
11616 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11617 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11618 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11619
11620 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11621 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11622 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11623
11624 .vitem &$item$&
11625 .vindex "&$item$&"
11626 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11627 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11628 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11629 empty.
11630
11631 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11632 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11633 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11634 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11635 lookup.
11636
11637 .vitem &$load_average$&
11638 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11639 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11640 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11641 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11642
11643 .vitem &$local_part$&
11644 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11645 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11646 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11647 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11648 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11649
11650 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11651 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11652 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11653 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11654 once.
11655
11656 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11657 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11658 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11659 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11660 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11661 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11662
11663 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11664 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11665 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11666 &$address_pipe$&).
11667
11668 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11669 local part of the recipient address.
11670
11671 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11672 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11673 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11674
11675 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11676 the addresses
11677 .code
11678 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11679 abc\:xyz@test.example
11680 .endd
11681 the value of &$local_part$& is
11682 .code
11683 abc:xyz
11684 .endd
11685 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11686 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11687 have:
11688 .code
11689 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11690 .endd
11691 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11692 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11693 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11694
11695 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11696 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11697 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11698 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11699 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11700 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11701 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11702
11703 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11704 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11705 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11706 variable expands to nothing.
11707
11708 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11709 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11710 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11711 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11712 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11713
11714 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11715 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11716 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11717 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11718 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11719
11720 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11721 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11722 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11723 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11724
11725 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11726 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11727 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11728
11729 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11730 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11731 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11732 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11733 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11734 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11735 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11736 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11737
11738 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11739 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11740 This contains the expanded value of the
11741 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11742 been read.
11743
11744 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11745 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11746 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11747 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11748 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11749 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11750
11751 .vitem &$log_space$&
11752 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11753 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11754 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11755 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11756 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11757 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11758
11759
11760 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11761 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11762 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11763 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11764 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11765 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11766 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11767 and &"yes"& if it was.
11768 .new
11769 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11770 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11771 as authenticated data.
11772 .wen
11773
11774 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11775 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11776 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11777 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11778 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11779 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11780 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11781 variable is empty.
11782
11783 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11784 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11785 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11786 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11787 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11788
11789 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11790 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11791 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11792 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11793 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11794 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11795 character(s).
11796
11797 .vitem &$message_age$&
11798 .cindex "message" "age of"
11799 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11800 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11801 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11802 delivery attempt.
11803
11804 .vitem &$message_body$&
11805 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11806 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11807 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11808 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11809 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11810 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11811 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11812 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11813 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11814
11815 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11816 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11817 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11818 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11819 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11820
11821 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11822 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11823 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11824 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11825 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11826 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11827 &$message_body$&.
11828
11829 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11830 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11831 .cindex "message body" "size"
11832 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11833 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11834 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11835 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11836 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11837
11838 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11839 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11840 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11841 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11842 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11843 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11844 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11845 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11846
11847 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11848 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11849 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11850 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11851 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11852 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11853
11854 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11855 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11856 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11857 contents of header lines is done.
11858
11859 .vitem &$message_id$&
11860 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11861
11862 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11863 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11864 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11865 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11866 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11867 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11868 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11869 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11870 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11871 from the body is not counted.
11872
11873 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11874 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11875 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11876 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11877 header and the body).
11878
11879 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11880 .code
11881 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11882 condition = \
11883 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11884 .endd
11885 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11886 message has not yet been received.
11887
11888 .vitem &$message_size$&
11889 .cindex "size" "of message"
11890 .cindex "message" "size"
11891 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11892 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11893 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11894 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11895 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11896 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11897 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11898 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11899 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11900
11901 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11902 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11903 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11904 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11905
11906 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11907 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11908 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11909 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11910
11911 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11912 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11913 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11914
11915 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11916 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11917 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11918 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11919 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11920 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11921 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11922 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11923 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11924 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11925
11926 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11927 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11928 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11929
11930 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11931 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11932 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11933 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11934 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11935 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11936 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11937 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11938 the original address.
11939
11940 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11941 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11942 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11943 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11944 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11945
11946 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11947 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11948 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11949
11950 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11951 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11952 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11953 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11954 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11955 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11956 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11957 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11958 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11959
11960 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11961 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11962 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11963 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11964 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11965 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11966 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11967 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11968 user.
11969
11970 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11971 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11972 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11973 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11974
11975 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11976 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11977 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11978 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11979
11980 .vitem &$pid$&
11981 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11982 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11983 This variable contains the current process id.
11984
11985 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11986 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11987 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11988 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11989 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11990 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11991 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11992 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11993 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11994 variable"& error if encountered.
11995
11996 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11997 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11998 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11999 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12000 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12001 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12002 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12003
12004
12005 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12006 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12007 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12008 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12009
12010 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12011 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12012 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12013 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12014
12015 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12016 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12017 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12018 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12019
12020 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12021 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12022 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12023
12024 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12025 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12026 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12027 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12028
12029 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12030 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12031 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12032 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12033 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12034
12035 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12036 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12037 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12038 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12039 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12040 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12041
12042 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12043 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12044 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12045 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12046 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12047
12048 .vitem &$received_count$&
12049 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12050 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12051 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12052 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12053 delivering.
12054
12055 .vitem &$received_for$&
12056 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12057 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12058 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12059 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12060 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12061
12062 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12063 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12064 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12065 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12066 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12067 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12068 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12069 option.
12070
12071 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12072 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12073 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12074 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12075 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12076 time.
12077 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12078
12079 .vitem &$received_port$&
12080 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12081 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12082
12083 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12084 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12085 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12086 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12087 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12088 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12089 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12090 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12091 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12092
12093 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12094 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12095 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12096 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12097 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12098 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12099
12100 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12101 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12102 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12103
12104 .vitem &$received_time$&
12105 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12106 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12107 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12108
12109 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12110 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12111 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12112 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12113 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12114 .display
12115 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12116 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12117 .endd
12118 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12119 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12120 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12121 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12122
12123 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12124 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12125 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12126 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12127
12128 .ilist
12129 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12130 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12131
12132 .next
12133 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12134
12135 .next
12136 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12137 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12138 MAIL).
12139
12140 .next
12141 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12142 .next
12143
12144 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12145 .endlist
12146
12147 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12148 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12149
12150 .vitem &$recipients$&
12151 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12152 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12153 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12154 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12155 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12156 cases:
12157
12158 .olist
12159 In a system filter file.
12160 .next
12161 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12162 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12163 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12164 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12165 .next
12166 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12167 .endlist
12168
12169
12170 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12171 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12172 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12173 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12174 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12175 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12176
12177
12178 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12179 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12180 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12181 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12182
12183
12184 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12185 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12186 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12187 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12188 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12189 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12190 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12191
12192 .vitem &$return_path$&
12193 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12194 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12195 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12196 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12197 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12198 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12199 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12200 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12201 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12202 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12203 envelope sender.
12204
12205 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12206 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12207 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12208
12209 .vitem &$router_name$&
12210 .cindex "router" "name"
12211 .cindex "name" "of router"
12212 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12213 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12214
12215 .vitem &$runrc$&
12216 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12217 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12218 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12219 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12220 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12221 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12222 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12223 another.
12224
12225 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12226 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12227 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12228 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12229 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12230 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12231 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12232 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12233
12234 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12235 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12236 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12237 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12238 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12239 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12240
12241 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12242 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12243 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12244 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12245 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12246 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12247 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12248 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12249
12250 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12251 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12252 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12253
12254 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12255 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12256 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12257
12258 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12259 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12260 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12261 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12262 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12263 this:
12264 .display
12265 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12266 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12267 .endd
12268 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12269 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12270 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12271 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12272
12273 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12274 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12275 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12276 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12277 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12278 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12279 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12280 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12281 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12282 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12283 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12284 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12285 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12286
12287 .new
12288 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12289 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12290 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12291 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12292 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12293 .wen
12294
12295 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12296 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12297 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12298 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12299 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12300 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12301
12302 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12303 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12304 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12305 this variable contains that
12306 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12307
12308 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12309 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12310 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12311 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12312 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12313 &$authenticated_id$&.
12314
12315 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12316 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12317 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12318 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12319 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12320 resolver library states that both
12321 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12322 other times, this variable is false.
12323
12324 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12325 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12326 library, by setting:
12327 .code
12328 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12329 .endd
12330
12331 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12332 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12333
12334 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12335 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12336
12337
12338 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12339 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12340 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12341 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12342 other means, this variable is empty.
12343
12344 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12345 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12346 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12347 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12348 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12349 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12350 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12351
12352 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12353 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12354 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12355 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12356
12357 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12358 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12359 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12360 is set to &"1"&.
12361
12362 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12363 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12364 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12365 following are true:
12366
12367 .ilist
12368 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12369 .next
12370 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12371 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12372 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12373 .next
12374 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12375 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12376 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12377 .next
12378 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12379 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12380 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12381 .next
12382 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12383 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12384 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12385 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12386 .code
12387 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12388 .endd
12389 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12390 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12391 .endlist
12392
12393
12394 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12395 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12396 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12397 number that was used on the remote host.
12398
12399 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12400 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12401 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12402 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12403 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12404 called Exim.
12405
12406 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12407 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12408 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12409 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12410
12411 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12412 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12413 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12414 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12415 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12416 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12417 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12418 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12419 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12420 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12421 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12422 the parentheses.
12423
12424 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12425 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12426 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12427 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12428 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12429
12430 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12431 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12432 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12433 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12434 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12435
12436 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12437 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12438 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12439 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12440 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12441 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12442 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12443
12444 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12445 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12446 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12447 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12448 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12449
12450 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12451 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12452 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12453 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12454 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12455 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12456
12457 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12458 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12459 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12460 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12461 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12462 .code
12463 MAIL FROM:<>
12464 MAIL FROM: <>
12465 .endd
12466 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12467 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12468 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12469 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12470
12471 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12472 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12473 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12474 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12475 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12476 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12477 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12478
12479 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12480 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12481 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12482 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12483 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12484 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12485 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12486 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12487 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12488 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12489 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12490
12491 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12492 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12493 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12494 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12495 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12496 message is junk mail.
12497
12498 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12499 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12500 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12501 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12502
12503
12504 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12505 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12506 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12507
12508 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12509 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12510 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12511 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12512 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12513 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12514
12515 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12516 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12517 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12518 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12519 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12520 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12521 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12522 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12523 .code
12524 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12525 .endd
12526 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12527
12528
12529 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12530 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12531 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12532 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12533 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12534 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12535
12536 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12537 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12538 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12539 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12540 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12541 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12542 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12543 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12544
12545 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12546 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12547 the outbound.
12548
12549 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12550 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12551 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12552 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12553 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12554 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12555
12556 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12557 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12558 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12559 inbound connection when the message was received.
12560 It is only useful as the argument of a
12561 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12562 or a &%def%& condition.
12563
12564 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12565 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12566 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12567 inbound connection when the message was received.
12568 It is only useful as the argument of a
12569 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12570 or a &%def%& condition.
12571 .new
12572 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12573 which is not the leaf.
12574 .wen
12575
12576 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12577 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12578 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12579 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12580 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12581 or a &%def%& condition.
12582
12583 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12584 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12585 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12586 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12587 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12588 or a &%def%& condition.
12589 .new
12590 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12591 which is not the leaf.
12592 .wen
12593
12594 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12595 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12596 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12597 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12598
12599 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12600 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12601 the outbound.
12602
12603 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12604 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12605 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12606 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12607 and &"0"& otherwise.
12608
12609 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12610 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12611 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12612 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12613 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12614 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12615 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12616 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12617 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12618
12619 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12620 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12621 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12622
12623 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12624 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12625 This variable is
12626 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12627 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12628 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12629 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12630
12631 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12632 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12633 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12634 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12635 .code
12636 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12637 1 No response to request
12638 2 Response not verified
12639 3 Verification failed
12640 4 Verification succeeded
12641 .endd
12642
12643 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12644 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12645 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12646 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12647 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12648
12649 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12650 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12651 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12652 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12653 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12654 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12655 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12656 .new
12657 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12658 which is not the leaf.
12659 .wen
12660
12661 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12662 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12663 the outbound.
12664
12665 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12666 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12667 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12668 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12669 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12670 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12671 .new
12672 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12673 which is not the leaf.
12674 .wen
12675
12676 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12677 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12678 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12679 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12680 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12681 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12682 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12683 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12684 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12685 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12686 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12687
12688 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12689 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12690 the outbound.
12691
12692 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12693 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12694 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12695 During outbound
12696 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12697 the transport.
12698
12699 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12700 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12701 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12702 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12703
12704 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12705 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12706 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12707
12708 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12709 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12710 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12711
12712 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12713 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12714 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12715 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12716 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12717 values for those that are behind (west).
12718
12719 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12720 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12721 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12722 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12723
12724 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12725 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12726 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12727 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12728 flag.
12729
12730 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12731 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12732 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12733 -0500.
12734
12735 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12736 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12737 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12738 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12739
12740 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12741 .cindex "transport" "name"
12742 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12743 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12744 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12745
12746 .vitem &$value$&
12747 .vindex "&$value$&"
12748 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12749 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12750 &*reduce*& expansion.
12751
12752 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12753 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12754 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12755 or for cutthrough delivery,
12756 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12757 Otherwise, empty.
12758
12759 .vitem &$version_number$&
12760 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12761 The version number of Exim.
12762
12763 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12764 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12765 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12766 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12767
12768 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12769 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12770 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12771 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12772 .endlist
12773 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12774
12775
12776
12777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12779
12780 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12781 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12782 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12783 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12784 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12785 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12786 the line
12787 .code
12788 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12789 .endd
12790 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12791
12792
12793 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12794 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12795 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12796 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12797 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12798 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12799 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12800 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12801 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12802
12803 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12804 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12805 should usually be something like
12806 .code
12807 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12808 .endd
12809 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12810 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12811 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12812 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12813 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12814 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12815 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12816 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12817 two ways:
12818
12819 .ilist
12820 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12821 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12822 a startup when Exim is entered.
12823 .next
12824 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12825 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12826 .endlist
12827
12828 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12829 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12830
12831
12832 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12833 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12834 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12835 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12836 forms:
12837 .code
12838 ${perl{foo}}
12839 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12840 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12841 .endd
12842 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12843 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12844 with an error message of the form
12845 .code
12846 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12847 .endd
12848 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12849 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12850 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12851 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12852 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12853 that was passed to &%die%&.
12854
12855
12856 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12857 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12858 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12859 the Perl code
12860 .code
12861 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12862 .endd
12863 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12864 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12865 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12866
12867 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12868 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12869 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12870 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12871
12872 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12873 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12874 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12875 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12876 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12877 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12878 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12879
12880
12881 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12882 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12883 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12884 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12885 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12886 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12887 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12888 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12889 avoided, but the output is lost.
12890
12891 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12892 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12893 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12894 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12895 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12896 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12897 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12898 .code
12899 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12900 .endd
12901 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12902 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12903 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12904 as the first subroutine argument.
12905 .ecindex IIDperl
12906
12907
12908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12909 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12910
12911 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12912 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12913 "Starting the daemon"
12914 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12915 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12916 .cindex "network interface"
12917 .cindex "interface" "network"
12918 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12919 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12920 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12921 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12922 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12923 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12924 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12925 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12926 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12927 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12928 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12929
12930 .olist
12931 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12932 and ports to listen on.
12933 .next
12934 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12935 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12936 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12937 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12938 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12939 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12940 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12941 as an error situation.
12942 .next
12943 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12944 for the outgoing connection.
12945 .endlist
12946
12947
12948 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12949 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12950 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12951 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12952 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12953
12954 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12955 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12956 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12957 chapter describes how they operate.
12958
12959 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12960 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12961
12962
12963
12964 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12965 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12966 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12967 following options:
12968
12969 .ilist
12970 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12971 or service names.
12972 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12973 .next
12974 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12975 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12976 .endlist
12977
12978 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12979 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12980 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12981 colons. For example:
12982 .code
12983 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12984 192.168.23.65 ; \
12985 ::1 ; \
12986 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12987 .endd
12988 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12989 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12990
12991 .olist
12992 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12993 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12994 .code
12995 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12996 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12997 .endd
12998 .next
12999 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13000 with a colon separator, for example:
13001 .code
13002 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13003 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13004 .endd
13005 .endlist
13006
13007 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13008 default setting contains just one port:
13009 .code
13010 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13011 .endd
13012 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13013 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13014 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13015 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13016 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13017
13018
13019
13020 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13021 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13022 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13023 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13024 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13025 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13026 .code
13027 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13028 .endd
13029 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13030 .code
13031 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13032 .endd
13033 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13034
13035
13036
13037 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13038 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13039 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13040 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13041 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13042 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13043 exim.
13044
13045 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13046 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13047 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13048 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13049 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13050 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13051 .code
13052 -oX 1225
13053 .endd
13054 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13055 whereas
13056 .code
13057 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13058 .endd
13059 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13060 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13061 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13062
13063
13064
13065 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13066 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13067 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13068 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13069 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13070 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13071 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13072 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13073 list of port numbers or service names,
13074 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13075 common use of this option is expected to be
13076 .code
13077 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13078 .endd
13079 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13080 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13081 this way when a daemon is started.
13082
13083 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13084 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13085 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13086 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13087 connections via the daemon.)
13088
13089
13090
13091
13092 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13093 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13094 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13095 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13096 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13097 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13098 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13099 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13100 .code
13101 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13102 .endd
13103 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13104 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13105 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13106 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13107 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13108 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13109 .code
13110 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13111 .endd
13112 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13113 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13114 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13115 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13116 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13117
13118 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13119 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13120 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13121 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13122 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13123 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13124 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13125 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13126 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13127 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13128 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13129 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13130
13131 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13132 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13133 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13134 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13135 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13136
13137
13138
13139 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13140 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13141 .code
13142 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13143 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13144 .endd
13145 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13146 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13147 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13148 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13149
13150 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13151 .code
13152 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13153 .endd
13154 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13155 .code
13156 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13157 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13158 .endd
13159 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13160 IPv4 loopback address only:
13161 .code
13162 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13163 .endd
13164 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13165 .code
13166 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13167 .endd
13168 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13169
13170
13171
13172 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13173 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13174 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13175 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13176 treated as local.
13177
13178 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13179 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13180 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13181 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13182
13183 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13184 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13185 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13186 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13187 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13188 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13189 used for listening. Consider this example:
13190 .code
13191 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13192 192.168.53.235 ; \
13193 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13194
13195 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13196 .endd
13197 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13198 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13199 Exim is routing.
13200
13201 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13202 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13203 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13204 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13205 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13206 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13207 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13208 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13209
13210
13211
13212 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13213 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13214 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13215 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13216 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13217 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13218 details.
13219
13220
13221
13222
13223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13225
13226 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13227 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13228 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13229 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13230
13231 .ilist
13232 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13233 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13234 .next
13235 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13236 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13237 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13238 .next
13239 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13240 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13241 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13242 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13243 settings.
13244 .endlist
13245
13246 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13247 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13248 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13249 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13250 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13251 listed in more than one group.
13252
13253 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13254 .table2
13255 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13256 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13257 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13258 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13259 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13260 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13261 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13262 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13263 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13264 .endtable
13265
13266
13267 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13268 .table2
13269 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13270 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13271 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13272 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13273 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13274 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13275 .endtable
13276
13277
13278
13279 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13280 .table2
13281 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13282 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13283 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13284 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13285 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13286 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13287 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13288 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13289 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13290 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13291 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13292 .endtable
13293
13294
13295
13296 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13297 .table2
13298 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13299 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13300 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13301 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13302 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13303 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13304 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13305 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13306 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13307 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13308 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13309 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13310 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13311 .endtable
13312
13313
13314
13315 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13316 .table2
13317 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13318 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13319 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13320 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13321 .endtable
13322
13323
13324
13325 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13326 .table2
13327 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13328 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13329 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13330 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13331 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13332 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13333 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13334 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13335 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13336 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13337 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13338 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13339 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13340 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13341 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13342 .endtable
13343
13344
13345
13346 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13347 .table2
13348 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13349 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13350 .endtable
13351
13352
13353
13354 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13355 .table2
13356 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13357 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13358 .endtable
13359
13360
13361
13362 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13363 .table2
13364 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13365 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13366 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13367 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13368 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13369 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13370 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13371 .endtable
13372
13373
13374
13375 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13376 .table2
13377 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13378 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13379 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13380 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13381 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13382 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13383 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13384 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13385 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13386 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13387 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13388 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13389 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13390 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13391 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13392 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13393 connection"
13394 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13395 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13396 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13397 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13398 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13399 .endtable
13400
13401
13402
13403 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13404 .table2
13405 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13406 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13407 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13408 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13409 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13410 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13411 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13412 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13413 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13414 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13415 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13416 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13417 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13418 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13419 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13420 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13421 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13422 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13423 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13424 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13425 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13426 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13427 words""&"
13428 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13429 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13430 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13431 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13432 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13433 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13434 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13435 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13436 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13437 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13438 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13439 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13440 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13441 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13442 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13443 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13444 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13445 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13446 .endtable
13447
13448
13449
13450 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13451 .table2
13452 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13453 item"
13454 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13455 item"
13456 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13457 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13458 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13459 .endtable
13460
13461
13462
13463 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13464 .table2
13465 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13466 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13467 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13468 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13469 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13470 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13471 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13472 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13473 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13474 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13475 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13476 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13477 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13478 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13479 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13480 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13481 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13482 .endtable
13483
13484
13485
13486 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13487 .table2
13488 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13489 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13490 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13491 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13492 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13493 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13494 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13495 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13496 .endtable
13497
13498
13499
13500 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13501 .table2
13502 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13503 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13504 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13505 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13506 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13507 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13508 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13509 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13510 .endtable
13511
13512
13513
13514
13515 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13516 .table2
13517 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13518 .endtable
13519
13520
13521
13522
13523
13524 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13525 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13526
13527 .table2
13528 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13529 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13530 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13531 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13532 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13533 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13534 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13535 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13536 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13537 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13538 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13539 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13540 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13541 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13542 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13543 connection"
13544 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13545 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13546 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13547 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13548 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13549 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13550 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13551 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13552 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13553 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13554 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13555 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13556 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13557 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13558 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13559 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13560 .endtable
13561
13562
13563
13564 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13565 .table2
13566 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13567 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13568 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13569 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13570 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13571 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13572 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13573 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13574 .endtable
13575
13576
13577
13578 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13579 .table2
13580 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13581 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13582 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13583 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13584 words""&"
13585 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13586 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13587 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13588 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13589 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13590 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13591 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13592 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13593 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13594 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13595 .endtable
13596
13597
13598
13599 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13600 .table2
13601 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13602 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13603 directory"
13604 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13605 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13606 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13607 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13608 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13609 .endtable
13610
13611
13612
13613 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13614 .table2
13615 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13616 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13617 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13618 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13619 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13620 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13621 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13622 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13623 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13624 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13625 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13626 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13627 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13628 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13629 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13630 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13631 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13632 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13633 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13634 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13635 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13636 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13637 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13638 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13639 .endtable
13640
13641
13642
13643 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13644 .table2
13645 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13646 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13647 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13648 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13649 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13650 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13651 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13652 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13653 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13654 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13655 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13656 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13657 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13658 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13659 .endtable
13660
13661
13662
13663 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13664 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13665 &dagger;.
13666
13667 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13668 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13669 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13670 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13671 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13672 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13673 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13674 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13675 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13676
13677 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13678 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13679 It now defaults to true.
13680 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13681 .display
13682 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13683 .endd
13684
13685 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13686 .code
13687 log_selector = +8bitmime
13688 .endd
13689
13690 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13691 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13692 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13693 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13694 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13695 further details.
13696
13697 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13698 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13699 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13700 SMTP messages.
13701
13702 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13703 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13704 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13705 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13706 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13707
13708 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13709 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13710 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13711 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13712 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13713
13714 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13715 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13716 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13717 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13718
13719 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13720 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13721 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13722 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13723 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13724
13725 .new
13726 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13727 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13728 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13729 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13730 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13731 .wen
13732 This option defines the ACL that,
13733 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13734 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13735 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13736 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13737
13738 .new
13739 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13740 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13741 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13742 of a received message.
13743 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13744 .wen
13745
13746 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13747 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13748 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13749 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13750
13751 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13752 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13753 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13754 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13755
13756 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13757 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13758 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13759 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13760 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13761
13762
13763 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13764 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13765 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13766 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13767
13768 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13769 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13770 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13771 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13772 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13773
13774 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13775 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13776 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13777 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13778 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13779
13780 .new
13781 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13782 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13783 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13784 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13785 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13786 .wen
13787
13788 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13789 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13790 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13791 further details.
13792
13793 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13794 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13795 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13796 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13797
13798 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13799 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13800 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13801 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13802
13803 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13804 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13805 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13806 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13807
13808 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13809 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13810 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13811 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13812
13813 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13814 .cindex "admin user"
13815 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13816 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13817 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13818 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13819 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13820 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13821 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13822
13823 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13824 .cindex "domain literal"
13825 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13826 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13827 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13828 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13829
13830 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13831 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13832 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13833 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13834 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13835 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13836 the local host's IP addresses.
13837
13838
13839 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13840 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13841 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13842 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13843 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13844 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13845 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13846 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13847 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13848
13849 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13850 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13851 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13852 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13853 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13854 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13855 experiment if they wish.
13856
13857 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13858 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13859 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13860 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13861 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13862 suitable setting is:
13863 .code
13864 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13865 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13866 .endd
13867 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13868 .code
13869 dns_check_names_pattern =
13870 .endd
13871 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13872
13873
13874 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13875 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13876 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13877 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13878 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13879 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13880 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13881 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13882 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13883 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13884 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13885
13886 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13887 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13888 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13889 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13890 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13891 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13892
13893 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13894 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13895 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13896 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13897 .code
13898 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13899 .endd
13900 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13901 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13902 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13903 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13904
13905
13906 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13907 .cindex "thawing messages"
13908 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13909 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13910 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13911 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13912 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13913 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13914
13915 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13916 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13917 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13918
13919
13920 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13921 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13922 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13923 .code
13924 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13925 .endd
13926 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13927 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13928
13929
13930 .option bi_command main string unset
13931 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13932 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13933 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13934 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13935 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13936
13937
13938 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13939 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13940 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13941 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13942 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13943 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13944
13945
13946 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13947 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13948 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13949 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13950
13951 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13952 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13953 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13954 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13955 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13956 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13957 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13958 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13959 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13960 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13961
13962 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13963 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13964 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13965 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13966
13967
13968 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13969 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13970 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13971 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13972 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13973 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13974 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13975 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13976 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13977
13978 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13979 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13980 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13981 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13982 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13983 messages.
13984
13985 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13986 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13987 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13988 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13989 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13990 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13991 connection. A typical setting might be:
13992 .code
13993 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13994 .endd
13995 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13996 .code
13997 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13998 .endd
13999 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14000 address.
14001
14002 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14003 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14004 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14005 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14006 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14007 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14008
14009
14010 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14011 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14012 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14013 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14014
14015
14016 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14017 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14018 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14019 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14020
14021
14022 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14023 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14024 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14025 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14026
14027
14028 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14029 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14030 callout verification. The default value is
14031 .code
14032 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14033 .endd
14034 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14035
14036
14037 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14038 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14039
14040
14041 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14042 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14043
14044 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14045 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14046 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14047 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14048 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14049 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14050 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14051 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14052 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14053 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14054
14055
14056 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14057 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14058
14059
14060 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14061 .cindex "checking disk space"
14062 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14063 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14064 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14065 message is accepted.
14066
14067 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14068 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14069 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14070 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14071 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14072 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14073 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14074 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14075
14076
14077 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14078 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14079 .code
14080 check_spool_space = 10M
14081 check_spool_inodes = 100
14082 .endd
14083 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14084 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14085 transit.
14086
14087 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14088 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14089 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14090
14091 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14092 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14093 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14094 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14095 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14096 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14097
14098 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14099 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14100
14101 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14102 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14103 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14104
14105 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14106 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14107 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14108 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14109 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14110 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14111
14112 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14113 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14114 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14115 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14116 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14117 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14118 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14119
14120 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14121 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14122
14123 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14124 .cindex "warning of delay"
14125 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14126 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14127 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14128 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14129 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14130 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14131 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14132 with
14133 .code
14134 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14135 .endd
14136 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14137 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14138 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14139 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14140 .code
14141 delay_warning = 6h
14142 .endd
14143 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14144 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14145 .code
14146 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14147 .endd
14148 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14149 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14150 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14151
14152 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14153 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14154 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14155 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14156 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14157 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14158 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14159 not sent. The default is:
14160 .code
14161 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14162 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14163 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14164 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14165 } {no}{yes}}
14166 .endd
14167 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14168 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14169 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14170 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14171
14172 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14173 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14174 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14175 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14176 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14177 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14178 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14179 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14180
14181 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14182 .cindex "load average"
14183 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14184 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14185 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14186 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14187 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14188
14189
14190 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14191 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14192 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14193 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14194 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14195 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14196 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14197 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14198
14199 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14200 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14201 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14202 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14203 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14204 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14205 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14206 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14207
14208 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14209 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14210 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14211 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14212
14213
14214 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14215 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14216 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14217 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14218 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14219 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14220 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14221
14222
14223 .new
14224 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14225 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14226 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14227 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14228 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14229 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14230 .wen
14231
14232
14233 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14234 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14235 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14236 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14237 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14238 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14239 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14240 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14241 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14242 by a setting such as this:
14243 .code
14244 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14245 .endd
14246 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14247 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14248 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14249 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14250 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14251 options are applied after this global option.
14252
14253 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14254 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14255 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14256 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14257 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14258 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14259 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14260 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14261 value of this option. The default pattern is
14262 .code
14263 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14264 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14265 .endd
14266 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14267 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14268 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14269 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14270 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14271 empty string.
14272
14273 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14274 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14275 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14276
14277 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14278 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14279 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14280 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14281
14282
14283 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14284 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14285 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14286 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14287 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14288 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14289
14290 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14291
14292
14293 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14294 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14295 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14296 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14297 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14298 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14299 domain matches this list.
14300
14301 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14302 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14303 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14304
14305
14306 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14307 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14308 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14309 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14310 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14311 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14312 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14313 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14314 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14315 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14316 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14317 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14318 to set in them.
14319 .new
14320 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14321 .wen
14322
14323
14324 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14325 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14326
14327
14328 .new
14329 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14330 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14331 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14332 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14333 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14334 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14335 match with this expanded domain list.
14336
14337 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14338 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14339 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14340 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14341 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14342 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14343
14344 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14345 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14346 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14347
14348 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14349 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14350 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14351 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14352 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14353 .wen
14354
14355 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14356 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14357 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14358 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14359 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14360 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14361 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14362 on.
14363
14364 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14365
14366
14367 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14368 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14369 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14370 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14371
14372 .new
14373 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14374 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14375 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14376 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14377 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14378 and accepted from, these hosts.
14379 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14380 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14381 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14382 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14383 are sent.
14384 .wen
14385
14386 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14387 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14388 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14389 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14390 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14391 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14392 .code
14393 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14394 .endd
14395 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14396 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14397
14398 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14399 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14400 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14401 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14402 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14403 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14404 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14405 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14406 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14407
14408
14409 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14410 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14411 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14412 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14413 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14414 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14415 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14416 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14417 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14418
14419 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14420 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14421 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14422 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14423 are examined. For example:
14424 .code
14425 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14426 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14427 postmaster@mydomain.example
14428 .endd
14429 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14430 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14431 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14432 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14433 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14434 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14435 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14436
14437
14438 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14439 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14440 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14441 .display
14442 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14443 .endd
14444 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14445 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14446 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14447 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14448 overrides the default.
14449
14450 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14451 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14452 and warning messages. For example:
14453 .code
14454 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14455 .endd
14456 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14457 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14458 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14459 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14460 not used.
14461
14462
14463 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14464 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14465 .cindex "Exim group"
14466 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14467 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14468 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14469 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14470 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14471 security issues.
14472
14473
14474 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14475 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14476 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14477 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14478 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14479 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14480 other place.
14481 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14482 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14483 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14484 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14485
14486
14487 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14488 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14489 .cindex "Exim user"
14490 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14491 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14492 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14493 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14494
14495 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14496 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14497 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14498 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14499
14500
14501 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14502 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14503 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14504 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14505
14506
14507 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14508 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14509
14510 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14511 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14512 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14513 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14514 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14515 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14516 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14517 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14518 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14519 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14520 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14521 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14522 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14523 addresses.
14524
14525
14526 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14527 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14528 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14529 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14530 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14531 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14532 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14533 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14534 retries.
14535
14536 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14537 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14538 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14539 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14540
14541
14542
14543 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14544 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14545 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14546 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14547 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14548 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14549 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14550 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14551 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14552 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14553 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14554 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14555 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14556 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14557 logging that you require.
14558
14559
14560 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14561 .cindex "HP-UX"
14562 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14563 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14564 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14565 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14566 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14567 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14568 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14569 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14570
14571 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14572 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14573 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14574 user's name.
14575
14576 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14577 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14578 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14579 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14580 .code
14581 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14582 gecos_name = $1
14583 .endd
14584
14585 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14586 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14587
14588
14589 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14590 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14591 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14592 implementations of TLS.
14593
14594
14595 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14596 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14597 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14598
14599 See
14600 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14601 for documentation.
14602
14603
14604
14605 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14606 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14607 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14608 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14609 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14610 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14611
14612
14613
14614 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14615 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14616 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14617 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14618 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14619 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14620 sections are rejected.
14621
14622
14623 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14624 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14625 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14626 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14627 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14628 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14629 zero means &"no limit"&.
14630
14631
14632
14633
14634 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14635 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14636 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14637 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14638 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14639 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14640 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14641 if you want to do semantic checking.
14642 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14643 set.
14644
14645
14646 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14647 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14648 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14649 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14650 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14651 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14652 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14653 .code
14654 helo_allow_chars = _
14655 .endd
14656 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14657
14658
14659 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14660 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14661 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14662 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14663 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14664 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14665 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14666 do.
14667
14668
14669 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14670 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14671 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14672 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14673 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14674 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14675 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14676 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14677 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14678 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14679 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14680 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14681
14682 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14683 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14684 EHLO command either:
14685
14686 .ilist
14687 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14688 .next
14689 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14690 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14691 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14692 calling host address, or
14693 .next
14694 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14695 .endlist
14696
14697 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14698 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14699 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14700
14701 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14702 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14703 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14704
14705 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14706 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14707 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14708 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14709 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14710 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14711 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14712 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14713 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14714 error.
14715
14716 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14717 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14718 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14719 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14720 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14721 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14722 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14723 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14724 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14725
14726 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14727 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14728 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14729 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14730 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14731
14732 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14733 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14734 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14735 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14736
14737
14738 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14739 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14740 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14741 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14742 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14743 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14744 default configuration file contains
14745 .code
14746 host_lookup = *
14747 .endd
14748 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14749 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14750
14751 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14752 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14753 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14754
14755 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14756 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14757 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14758 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14759 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14760 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14761
14762
14763 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14764 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14765 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14766 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14767 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14768 if you want.
14769
14770 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14771 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14772 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14773 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14774
14775
14776
14777 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14778 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14779 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14780 as soon as the connection is made.
14781 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14782 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14783 connections immediately.
14784
14785 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14786 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14787 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14788 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14789 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14790
14791
14792 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14793 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14794 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14795 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14796 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14797 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14798 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14799 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14800 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14801 .code
14802 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14803 .endd
14804 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14805
14806
14807
14808 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14809 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14810 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14811 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14812 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14813 records
14814 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14815 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14816
14817 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14818 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14819 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14820 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14821 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14822 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14823 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14824
14825
14826 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14827 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14828 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14829 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14830 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14831
14832
14833
14834 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14835 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14836 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14837 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14838 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14839 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14840
14841 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14842 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14843 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14844 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14845 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14846 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14847 for frozen messages. For example,
14848 .code
14849 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14850 .endd
14851 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14852 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14853 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14854 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14855 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14856 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14857
14858
14859 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14860 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14861 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14862 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14863 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14864 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14865 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14866 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14867 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14868 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14869
14870
14871 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14872 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14873
14874
14875 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14876 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14877 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14878 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14879 logged.
14880
14881
14882 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14883 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14884 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14885 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14886 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14887 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14888 and constrained to be a directory.
14889
14890
14891 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14892 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14893 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14894 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14895 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14896 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14897 and constrained to be a file.
14898
14899
14900 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14901 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14902 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14903 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14904 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14905
14906
14907 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14908 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14909 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14910 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14911 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14912 identity to be proven.
14913
14914
14915 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14916 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14917 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14918 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14919 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14920
14921
14922 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14923 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14924 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14925 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14926 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14927 with LDAP support.
14928
14929
14930 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14931 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14932 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14933 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14934 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14935 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14936 to hard/demand.
14937
14938
14939 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14940 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14941 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14942 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14943 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14944 of SSL-on-connect.
14945 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14946 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14947
14948
14949 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14950 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14951 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14952 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14953 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14954 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14955 has been built with LDAP support.
14956
14957
14958
14959 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14960 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14961 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14962 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14963 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14964 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14965 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14966
14967 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14968 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14969 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14970
14971 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14972 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14973 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14974 and the default qualify domain.
14975
14976 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14977 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14978 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14979 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14980
14981 .cindex "envelope sender"
14982 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14983 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14984 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14985
14986 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14987 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14988 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14989
14990
14991
14992
14993 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14994 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14995 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14996 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14997 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14998 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14999 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15000 example, if
15001 .code
15002 local_from_prefix = *-
15003 .endd
15004 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15005 .code
15006 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15007 .endd
15008 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15009 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15010 qualify domain.
15011
15012
15013 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15014 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15015
15016
15017 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15018 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15019 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15020 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15021 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15022 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15023 &%local_interfaces%& is
15024 .code
15025 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15026 .endd
15027 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15028 .code
15029 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15030 .endd
15031
15032 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15033 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15034 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15035 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15036 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15037 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15038 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15039 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15040
15041
15042
15043 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15044 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15045 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15046 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15047 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15048 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15049 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15050 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15051
15052
15053
15054
15055 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15056 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15057 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15058 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15059 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15060 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15061 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15062 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15063 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15064 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15065 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15066 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15067 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15068 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15069 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15070
15071
15072
15073 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15074 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15075 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15076 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15077 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15078 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15079 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15080 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15081 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15082 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15083 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15084 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15085 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15086 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15087 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15088
15089
15090 .option log_selector main string unset
15091 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15092 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15093 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15094 minus characters. For example:
15095 .code
15096 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15097 .endd
15098 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15099 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15100
15101
15102 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15103 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15104 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15105 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15106 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15107 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15108 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15109 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15110 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15111 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15112 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15113 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15114 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15115
15116
15117 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15118 .cindex "too many open files"
15119 .cindex "open files, too many"
15120 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15121 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15122 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15123 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15124 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15125 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15126 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15127 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15128 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15129 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15130 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15131 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15132
15133
15134 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15135 .cindex "length of login name"
15136 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15137 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15138 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15139 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15140 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15141 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15142
15143
15144 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15145 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15146 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15147 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15148 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15149 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15150 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15151 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15152
15153
15154 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15155 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15156 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15157 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15158 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15159 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15160 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15161
15162
15163 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15164 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15165 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15166 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15167 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15168 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15169 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15170 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15171 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15172 empty string, the option is ignored.
15173
15174
15175 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15176 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15177 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15178 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15179 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15180 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15181 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15182 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15183 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15184 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15185 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15186 colons will become hyphens.
15187
15188
15189 .option message_logs main boolean true
15190 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15191 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15192 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15193 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15194 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15195 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15196 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15197 which is not affected by this option.
15198
15199
15200 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15201 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15202 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15203 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15204 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15205 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15206 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15207 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15208 optionally followed by K or M.
15209
15210 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15211 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15212 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15213 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15214 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15215
15216 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15217 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15218 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15219 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15220 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15221 message that an individual transport can process.
15222
15223 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15224 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15225 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15226 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15227 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15228 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15229 some problems may result.
15230
15231 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15232 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15233 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15234
15235
15236 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15237 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15238 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15239 .code
15240 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15241 .endd
15242 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15243 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15244 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15245 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15246 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15247
15248
15249 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15250 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15251 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15252 contains a full description of this facility.
15253
15254
15255
15256 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15257 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15258 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15259 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15260 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15261
15262
15263 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15264 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15265 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15266 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15267 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15268 safety precaution.
15269
15270 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15271 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15272 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15273 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15274 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15275
15276 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15277 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15278 example is
15279 .code
15280 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15281 .endd
15282 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15283 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15284 transport driver.
15285
15286
15287 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15288 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15289 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15290 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15291 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15292
15293 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15294 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15295 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15296 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15297 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15298 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15299 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15300
15301 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15302 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15303 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15304 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15305 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15306
15307 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15308
15309 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15310 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15311 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15312 some now infamous attacks.
15313
15314 Examples:
15315 .code
15316 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15317 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15318 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15319
15320 # Disable older protocol versions:
15321 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15322 .endd
15323
15324 Possible options may include:
15325 .ilist
15326 &`all`&
15327 .next
15328 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15329 .next
15330 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15331 .next
15332 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15333 .next
15334 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15335 .next
15336 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15337 .next
15338 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15339 .next
15340 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15341 .next
15342 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15343 .next
15344 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15345 .next
15346 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15347 .next
15348 &`no_compression`&
15349 .next
15350 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15351 .next
15352 &`no_sslv2`&
15353 .next
15354 &`no_sslv3`&
15355 .next
15356 &`no_ticket`&
15357 .next
15358 &`no_tlsv1`&
15359 .next
15360 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15361 .next
15362 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15363 .next
15364 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15365 .next
15366 &`single_dh_use`&
15367 .next
15368 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15369 .next
15370 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15371 .next
15372 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15373 .next
15374 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15375 .next
15376 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15377 .next
15378 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15379 .endlist
15380
15381 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15382 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15383 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15384 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15385 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15386 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15387
15388
15389 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15390 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15391 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15392 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15393 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15394
15395
15396 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15397 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15398 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15399 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15400 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15401 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15402 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15403 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15404 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15405 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15406 an ACL.
15407
15408 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15409 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15410 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15411 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15412 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15413 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15414 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15415
15416
15417 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15418 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15419 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15420
15421
15422 .option perl_startup main string unset
15423 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15424 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15425
15426
15427 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15428 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15429 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15430 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15431 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15432 PostgreSQL support.
15433
15434
15435 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15436 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15437 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15438 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15439 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15440 to the host name:
15441 .code
15442 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15443 .endd
15444 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15445 spool directory.
15446 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15447 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15448 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15449
15450
15451 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15452 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15453 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15454 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15455 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15456 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15457 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15458 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15459 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15460
15461
15462 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15463 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15464 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15465 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15466 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15467 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15468 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15469 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15470
15471 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15472 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15473 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15474 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15475 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15476 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15477 volume of mail. Use with care!
15478
15479
15480 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15481 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15482 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15483 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15484 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15485 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15486 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15487 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15488 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15489 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15490
15491 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15492 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15493 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15494 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15495 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15496 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15497
15498
15499 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15500 .cindex "printing characters"
15501 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15502 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15503 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15504 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15505 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15506 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15507 characters.
15508
15509 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15510 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15511 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15512 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15513 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15514 standards.
15515
15516
15517 .option process_log_path main string unset
15518 .cindex "process log path"
15519 .cindex "log" "process log"
15520 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15521 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15522 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15523 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15524 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15525 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15526 different spool directories.
15527
15528
15529 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15530 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15531 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15532 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15533 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15534 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15535 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15536
15537
15538 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15539 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15540 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15541 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15542 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15543 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15544 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15545 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15546 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15547
15548 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15549 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15550 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15551 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15552 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15553 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15554 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15555
15556
15557 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15558 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15559 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15560
15561
15562
15563 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15564 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15565 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15566 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15567 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15568 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15569 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15570 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15571
15572
15573 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15574 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15575 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15576 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15577 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15578
15579
15580 .option queue_only main boolean false
15581 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15582 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15583 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15584 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15585 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15586 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15587
15588 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15589 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15590 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15591 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15592
15593
15594 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15595 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15596 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15597 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15598 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15599 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15600 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15601 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15602 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15603 .code
15604 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15605 .endd
15606 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15607 &_/some/file_& exists.
15608
15609
15610 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15611 .cindex "load average"
15612 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15613 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15614 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15615 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15616 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15617 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15618 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15619 false.
15620
15621 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15622 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15623 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15624 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15625
15626
15627 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15628 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15629 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15630 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15631 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15632 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15633 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15634 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15635 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15636 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15637 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15638 re-evaluated for each message.
15639
15640
15641 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15642 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15643 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15644 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15645 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15646 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15647
15648
15649 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15650 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15651 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15652 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15653 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15654 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15655 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15656 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15657 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15658 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15659 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15660 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15661 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15662
15663
15664
15665 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15666 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15667 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15668 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15669 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15670 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15671 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15672 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15673 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15674
15675 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15676 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15677 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15678 the daemon's command line.
15679
15680 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15681 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15682 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15683 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15684 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15685 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15686 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15687 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15688 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15689 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15690 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15691 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15692 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15693 &%queue_domains%&.
15694
15695
15696 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15697 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15698 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15699 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15700 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15701 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15702 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15703
15704 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15705 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15706 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15707 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15708 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15709 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15710 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15711 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15712 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15713 header lines. The default setting is:
15714
15715 .code
15716 received_header_text = Received: \
15717 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15718 {${if def:sender_ident \
15719 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15720 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15721 by $primary_hostname \
15722 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15723 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15724 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15725 ${if def:sender_address \
15726 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15727 id $message_exim_id\
15728 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15729 .endd
15730
15731 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15732 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15733 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15734 header lines such as the following:
15735 .code
15736 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15737 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15738 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15739 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15740 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15741 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15742 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15743 .endd
15744 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15745 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15746 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15747 message was accepted.
15748
15749
15750 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15751 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15752 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15753 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15754 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15755 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15756 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15757 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15758
15759
15760 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15761 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15762 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15763 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15764 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15765 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15766 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15767 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15768 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15769 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15770 option was not set.
15771
15772
15773 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15774 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15775 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15776 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15777 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15778 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15779 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15780 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15781 done.
15782
15783 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15784 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15785 RCPT commands in a single message.
15786
15787
15788 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15789 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15790 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15791 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15792 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15793 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15794 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15795
15796
15797 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15798 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15799 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15800 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15801 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15802 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15803 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15804 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15805 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15806 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15807 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15808 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15809 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15810 tagged with its process id.
15811
15812 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15813 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15814 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15815 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15816 is received.
15817
15818 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15819 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15820 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15821 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15822 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15823 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15824 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15825 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15826 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15827 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15828 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15829
15830 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15831 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15832 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15833 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15834
15835
15836 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15837 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15838 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15839 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15840 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15841 .code
15842 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15843 .endd
15844 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15845 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15846
15847
15848 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15849 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15850 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15851 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15852 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15853 past failures.
15854
15855
15856 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15857 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15858 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15859 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15860 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15861 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15862 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15863 the default value.
15864
15865
15866 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15867 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15868 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15869 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15870 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15871 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15872 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15873 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15874 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15875 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15876
15877
15878 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15879 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15880
15881
15882 .new
15883 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15884 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15885 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15886 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15887 an item in the list.
15888 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15889 for the system.
15890 .wen
15891
15892 .new
15893 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15894 .wen
15895 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15896 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15897 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15898 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15899
15900
15901 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15902 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15903 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15904 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15905 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15906 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15907 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15908 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15909 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15910 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15911
15912
15913 .new
15914 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15915 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15916 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15917 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15918 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15919 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15920 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15921 .wen
15922
15923
15924
15925 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15926 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15927 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15928 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15929 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15930 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15931 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15932 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15933 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15934 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15935 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15936
15937
15938
15939 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15940 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15941 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15942 .cindex "inetd"
15943 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15944 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15945 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15946 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15947 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15948 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15949
15950 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15951 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15952 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15953 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15954
15955
15956 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15957 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15958 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15959 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15960 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15961 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15962 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15963 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15964
15965 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15966 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15967 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15968 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15969 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15970 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15971 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15972 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15973
15974
15975 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15976 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15977 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15978 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15979 live with.
15980
15981
15982 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15983 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15984 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15985 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15986 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15987 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15988 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15989 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15990 . the option name to split.
15991
15992 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15993 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15994 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15995 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15996 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15997 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15998 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15999 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16000 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16001 seen).
16002
16003
16004 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16005 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16006 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16007 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16008 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16009 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16010 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16011 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16012 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16013 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16014 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16015
16016 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16017 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16018 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16019 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16020 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16021 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16022
16023
16024
16025 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16026 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16027 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16028 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16029 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16030 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16031 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16032 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16033 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16034 to all messages received in the same connection.
16035
16036 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16037 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16038 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16039 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16040
16041
16042 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16043
16044 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16045 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16046 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16047 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16048 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16049 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16050 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16051 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16052 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16053 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16054 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16055 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16056 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16057
16058
16059 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16060 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16061 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16062 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16063 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16064 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16065 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16066 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16067 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16068 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16069 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16070 individual host.
16071
16072 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16073 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16074 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16075 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16076
16077
16078 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16079 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16080 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16081 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16082 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16083 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16084 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16085 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16086 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16087
16088 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16089 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16090 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16091 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16092
16093 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16094 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16095 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16096 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16097 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16098 For example:
16099 .code
16100 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16101 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16102 .endd
16103
16104 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16105 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16106 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16107 &%helo_data%& value.
16108
16109 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16110 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16111 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16112 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16113 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16114 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16115 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16116 .code
16117 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16118 $version_number $tod_full
16119 .endd
16120 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16121 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16122 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16123 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16124 multiline response).
16125
16126
16127 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16128 .cindex "checking disk space"
16129 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16130 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16131 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16132 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16133 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16134 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16135 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16136
16137
16138 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16139 .cindex "connection backlog"
16140 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16141 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16142 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16143 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16144 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16145 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16146 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16147 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16148 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16149 attacks by SYN flooding.
16150
16151
16152 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16153 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16154 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16155 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16156 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16157 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16158 fewer, but they still exist.
16159
16160 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16161 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16162 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16163 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16164 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16165 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16166 does detect many instances.
16167
16168 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16169 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16170 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16171 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16172
16173
16174
16175 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16176 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16177 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16178 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16179 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16180 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16181 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16182 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16183 example:
16184 .code
16185 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16186 $sender_host_address
16187 .endd
16188 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16189 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16190 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16191 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16192 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16193 the command.
16194
16195
16196 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16197 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16198 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16199 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16200 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16201
16202
16203 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16204 .cindex "load average"
16205 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16206 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16207 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16208 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16209 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16210 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16211
16212
16213
16214 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16215 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16216 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16217 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16218 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16219 .code
16220 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16221 .endd
16222 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16223 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16224 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16225 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16226 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16227
16228 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16229 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16230 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16231 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16232 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16233 not count towards the limit.
16234
16235
16236
16237 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16238 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16239 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16240 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16241 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16242 that subvert web
16243 clients
16244 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16245 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16246
16247
16248
16249 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16250 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16251 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16252 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16253 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16254 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16255 recipients.
16256
16257 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16258 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16259 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16260 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16261
16262 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16263 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16264 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16265 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16266 values:
16267
16268 .ilist
16269 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16270 .next
16271 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16272 fractional parts are allowed here.
16273 .next
16274 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16275 .next
16276 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16277 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16278 .endlist
16279
16280 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16281 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16282 .code
16283 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16284 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16285 .endd
16286 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16287 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16288 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16289 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16290
16291
16292 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16293 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16294
16295
16296 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16297 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16298
16299
16300 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16301 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16302 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16303 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16304 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16305 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16306 the message is abandoned.
16307 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16308 .code
16309 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16310 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16311 .endd
16312 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16313 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16314
16315 .new
16316 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16317 expanded before use and may depend on
16318 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16319 .wen
16320
16321
16322 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16323 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16324 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16325 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16326 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16327 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16328
16329
16330 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16331 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16332 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16333
16334
16335 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16336 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16337 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16338 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16339 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16340 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16341 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16342 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16343 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16344 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16345 .code
16346 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16347 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16348 .endd
16349
16350 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16351 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16352 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16353 The default value is
16354 .code
16355 127.0.0.1 783
16356 .endd
16357 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16358
16359
16360
16361 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16362 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16363 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16364 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16365 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16366 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16367 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16368 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16369 arrival of the message.
16370
16371 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16372 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16373 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16374 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16375 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16376
16377 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16378 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16379 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16380 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16381 automatically deleted.
16382
16383 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16384 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16385 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16386 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16387 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16388 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16389 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16390 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16391 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16392
16393
16394 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16395 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16396 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16397 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16398 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16399 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16400 &$primary_hostname$&.
16401
16402 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16403 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16404 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16405 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16406 as failures in the configuration file.
16407
16408 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16409 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16410
16411 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16412 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16413 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16414 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16415
16416 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16417 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16418 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16419 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16420 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16421 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16422
16423 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16424 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16425 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16426 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16427 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16428 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16429 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16430
16431
16432 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16433 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16434 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16435 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16436 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16437 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16438 domain causes a syntax error.
16439 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16440 syntax checking.
16441
16442
16443 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16444 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16445 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16446 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16447 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16448 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16449 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16450 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16451 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16452 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16453 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16454 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16455
16456
16457 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16458 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16459 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16460 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16461 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16462 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16463 details of Exim's logging.
16464
16465
16466
16467 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16468 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16469 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16470 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16471 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16472
16473
16474
16475 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16476 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16477 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16478 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16479 details of Exim's logging.
16480
16481
16482 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16483 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16484 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16485 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16486 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16487 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16488 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16489 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16490 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16491 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16492 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16493
16494
16495 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16496 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16497 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16498 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16499 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16500 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16501
16502
16503 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16504 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16505 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16506 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16507 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16508
16509 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16510 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16511 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16512 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16513 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16514
16515 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16516 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16517 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16518 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16519 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16520 contains the pipe command.
16521
16522
16523 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16524 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16525 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16526 is used in a system filter.
16527
16528
16529 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16530 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16531 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16532 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16533 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16534 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16535 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16536 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16537 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16538 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16539
16540 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16541 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16542 transport option overrides.
16543
16544
16545 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16546 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16547 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16548 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16549 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16550 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16551 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16552 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16553 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16554 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16555 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16556 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16557 TCP_NODELAY.
16558
16559
16560 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16561 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16562 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16563 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16564 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16565 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16566 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16567 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16568 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16569 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16570
16571 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16572 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16573 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16574
16575
16576 .option timezone main string unset
16577 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16578 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16579 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16580 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16581 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16582 .code
16583 timezone = UTC
16584 .endd
16585 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16586 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16587 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16588 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16589 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16590 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16591
16592
16593 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16594 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16595 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16596 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16597 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16598 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16599 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16600 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16601
16602
16603 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16604 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16605 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16606 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16607 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16608 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16609 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16610
16611 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16612 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16613 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16614 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16615
16616 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16617 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16618 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16619 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16620
16621 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16622 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16623 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16624 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16625 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16626
16627 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16628
16629
16630 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16631 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16632 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16633 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16634 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16635 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16636
16637 The value must be at least 1024.
16638
16639 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16640 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16641 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16642
16643 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16644 number.
16645
16646 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16647 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16648 larger prime than requested.
16649
16650
16651 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16652 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16653 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16654 to be used by Exim.
16655
16656 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16657 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16658 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16659 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16660 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16661 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16662 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16663
16664 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16665 loaded by Exim.
16666
16667 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16668 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16669 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16670 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16671
16672 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16673 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16674 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16675 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16676
16677 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16678 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16679 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16680 "ike23".
16681
16682 The available primes are:
16683 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16684 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16685 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16686
16687 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16688 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16689
16690 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16691 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16692 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16693 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16694 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16695 userbase.
16696
16697 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16698 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16699 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16700 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16701 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16702 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16703 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16704
16705
16706 .new
16707 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16708 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16709 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16710 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16711
16712 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16713 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16714 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16715 which tell the library to choose.
16716
16717 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16718 .wen
16719
16720
16721 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16722 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16723 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16724 This option
16725 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16726 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16727 Certificate Authority.
16728
16729
16730 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16731 .cindex SSMTP
16732 .cindex SMTPS
16733 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16734 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16735 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16736 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16737
16738
16739
16740 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16741 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16742 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16743 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16744 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16745 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16746 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16747
16748 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16749
16750
16751 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16752 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16753 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16754 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16755 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16756 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16757 TLS session.
16758
16759
16760 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16761 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16762 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16763 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16764 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16765 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16766 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16767 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16768 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16769 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16770 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16771
16772
16773 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16774 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16775 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16776 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16777
16778
16779 .new
16780 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16781 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16782 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16783 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16784 word "system"
16785 or the absolute path to
16786 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16787 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16788
16789 The "system" value for the option will use a
16790 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16791 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16792 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16793 must be specified.
16794
16795 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16796 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16797
16798 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16799 explicitly
16800 either by file or directory
16801 are added to those given by the system default location.
16802 .wen
16803
16804 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16805 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16806 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16807 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16808 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16809 use the explicit directory version.
16810
16811 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16812
16813 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16814 being unset.
16815
16816
16817 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16818 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16819 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16820 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16821 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16822 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16823 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16824 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16825
16826 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16827 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16828 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16829 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16830 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16831 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16832 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16833
16834 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16835 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16836 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16837 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16838 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16839 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16840 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16841 certificate"&.
16842
16843 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16844 certificates.
16845
16846
16847 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16848 .cindex "trusted groups"
16849 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16850 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16851 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16852 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16853 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16854 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16855 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16856 are trusted.
16857
16858 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16859 .cindex "trusted users"
16860 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16861 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16862 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16863 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16864 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16865 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16866 Exim user are trusted.
16867
16868 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16869 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16870 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16871 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16872 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16873 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16874 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16875 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16876 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16877 &%-F%& option.
16878
16879 .option unknown_username main string unset
16880 See &%unknown_login%&.
16881
16882 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16883 .cindex "trusted users"
16884 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16885 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16886 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16887 .cindex "envelope sender"
16888 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16889 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16890 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16891 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16892 is used) is ignored.
16893
16894 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16895 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16896 .code
16897 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16898 .endd
16899 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16900 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16901 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16902 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16903 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16904 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16905 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16906 followed by a hyphen
16907 by a setting like this:
16908 .code
16909 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16910 .endd
16911 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16912 restriction, you can use
16913 .code
16914 untrusted_set_sender = *
16915 .endd
16916 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16917 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16918 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16919 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16920 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16921 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16922 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16923 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16924
16925 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16926 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16927 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16928 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16929 sender address.
16930
16931
16932 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16933 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16934 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16935 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16936 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16937 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16938 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16939 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16940 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16941 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16942 .code
16943 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16944 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16945 .endd
16946 The pattern can be seen by running
16947 .code
16948 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16949 .endd
16950 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16951 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16952 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16953 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16954 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16955 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16956
16957
16958 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16959 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16960
16961
16962 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16963 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16964 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16965 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16966 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16967 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16968 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16969 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16970
16971
16972 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16973 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16974 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16975 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16976 .ecindex IIDconfima
16977 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16978
16979
16980
16981
16982 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16984
16985 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16986 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16987 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16988 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16989 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16990
16991 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16992 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16993 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16994 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16995 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16996
16997
16998
16999 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17000 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17001 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17002 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17003 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17004 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17005 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17006
17007 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17008 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17009 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17010 routers, and the eventual transport.
17011
17012 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17013 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17014 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17015 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17016 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17017
17018 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17019 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17020 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17021 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17022 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17023
17024 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17025 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17026 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17027 .code
17028 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17029 .endd
17030 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17031 .code
17032 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17033 .endd
17034 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17035 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17036
17037 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17038 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17039 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17040 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17041 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17042 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17043 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17044
17045
17046
17047 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17048 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17049 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17050 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17051 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17052 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17053 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17054 routing.
17055
17056
17057
17058 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17059 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17060 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17061 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17062 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17063 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17064 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17065 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17066 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17067 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17068 you could put:
17069 .code
17070 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17071 .endd
17072 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17073 and
17074 .code
17075 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17076 .endd
17077 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17078 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17079 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17080 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17081
17082
17083 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17084 .cindex "case of local parts"
17085 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17086 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17087 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17088 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17089 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17090 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17091 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17092 more details.
17093
17094 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17095 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17096 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17097 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17098 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17099 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17100 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17101 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17102 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17103
17104 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17105 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17106 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17107 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17108
17109
17110
17111 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17112 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17113 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17114 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17115 .vindex "&$home$&"
17116 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17117 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17118 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17119 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17120 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17121 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17122 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17123 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17124 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17125 the router is skipped.
17126
17127 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17128 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17129 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17130 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17131 setting to achieve this. For example:
17132 .code
17133 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17134 .endd
17135 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17136 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17137 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17138
17139
17140
17141 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17142 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17143 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17144 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17145 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17146 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17147 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17148 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17149
17150 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17151 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17152
17153 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17154 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17155
17156 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17157 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17158 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17159 .code
17160 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17161 .endd
17162 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17163 .code
17164 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17165 .endd
17166
17167 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17168 .code
17169 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17170 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17171 condition = foobar
17172 .endd
17173
17174 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17175 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17176 be specified using &%condition%&.
17177
17178 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17179 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17180 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17181 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17182 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17183 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17184 Router rules processing behavior.
17185
17186 This is best illustrated in an example:
17187 .code
17188 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17189 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17190
17191 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17192 true {yes} {no}}
17193
17194 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17195 {yes} {no}}
17196 .endd
17197 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17198 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17199 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17200 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17201 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17202 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17203 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17204 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17205
17206 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17207 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17208 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17209 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17210 string characters.
17211
17212 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17213 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17214 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17215 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17216 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17217
17218
17219 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17220 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17221 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17222 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17223 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17224 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17225 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17226 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17227 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17228 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17229 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17230 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17231 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17232 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17233
17234
17235
17236 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17237 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17238 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17239 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17240 transport option of the same name.
17241
17242 .new
17243 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17244 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17245 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17246 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17247 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17248 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17249 the dnssec request bit set.
17250 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17251
17252 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17253 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17254 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17255 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17256 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17257 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17258 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17259 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17260 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17261 .wen
17262
17263
17264 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17265 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17266 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17267 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17268 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17269 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17270 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17271 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17272
17273
17274
17275 .option driver routers string unset
17276 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17277 to be used.
17278
17279
17280 .new
17281 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17282 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17283 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17284 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17285 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17286 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17287 Not effective on redirect routers.
17288 .wen
17289
17290
17291
17292 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17293 .cindex "envelope sender"
17294 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17295 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17296 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17297 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17298 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17299 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17300 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17301
17302 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17303 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17304 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17305 setting.
17306
17307 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17308 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17309 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17310 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17311
17312 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17313 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17314 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17315 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17316 settings:
17317 .code
17318 errors_to =
17319 errors_to = ""
17320 .endd
17321 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17322 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17323 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17324 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17325 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17326
17327 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17328 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17329 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17330 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17331 setting &%return_path%&.
17332
17333 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17334 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17335 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17336
17337
17338
17339 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17340 .cindex "address" "testing"
17341 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17342 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17343 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17344 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17345 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17346 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17347 on for the system alias file.
17348 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17349 are evaluated.
17350
17351 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17352 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17353 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17354
17355
17356
17357 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17358 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17359 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17360 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17361
17362
17363
17364 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17365 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17366 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17367
17368
17369
17370 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17371 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17372 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17373
17374
17375
17376 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17377 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17378 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17379 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17380 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17381 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17382 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17383 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17384 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17385
17386 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17387 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17388 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17389 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17390 transport for further details.
17391
17392
17393 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17394 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17395 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17396 .cindex "transport" "local"
17397 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17398 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17399 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17400 process.
17401 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17402 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17403 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17404 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17405 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17406
17407
17408
17409 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17410 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17411 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17412 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17413 .new
17414 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17415 .wen
17416 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17417 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17418 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17419 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17420 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17421 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17422 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17423 &"see"& the added header lines.
17424
17425 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17426 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17427 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17428 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17429
17430 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17431 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17432
17433 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17434 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17435
17436 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17437 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17438 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17439 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17440 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17441 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17442 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17443 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17444 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17445 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17446
17447
17448
17449 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17450 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17451 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17452 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17453 .new
17454 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17455 .wen
17456 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17457 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17458 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17459 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17460 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17461 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17462 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17463 &"see"& the original header lines.
17464
17465 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17466 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17467 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17468 errors.
17469
17470 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17471 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17472
17473 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17474 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17475
17476 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17477 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17478 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17479 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17480
17481 .new
17482 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17483 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17484 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17485 .wen
17486
17487
17488
17489 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17490 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17491 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17492 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17493 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17494 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17495 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17496 like
17497 .code
17498 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17499 .endd
17500 by setting
17501 .code
17502 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17503 .endd
17504 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17505 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17506 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17507 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17508 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17509 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17510
17511 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17512 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17513 .code
17514 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17515 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17516 .endd
17517 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17518 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17519
17520 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17521 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17522 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17523 domain that is being routed.
17524
17525 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17526 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17527 checked.
17528
17529 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17530 .cindex "additional groups"
17531 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17532 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17533 .cindex "transport" "local"
17534 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17535 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17536 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17537 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17538 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17539
17540
17541
17542 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17543 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17544 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17545 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17546 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17547 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17548 evaluated.
17549
17550 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17551 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17552 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17553 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17554 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17555 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17556 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17557 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17558 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17559
17560 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17561 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17562 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17563 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17564 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17565 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17566 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17567 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17568 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17569 the relevant transport.
17570
17571 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17572 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17573 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17574 callout.
17575
17576 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17577 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17578 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17579 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17580 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17581 .code
17582 real_localuser:
17583 driver = accept
17584 local_part_prefix = real-
17585 check_local_user
17586 transport = local_delivery
17587 .endd
17588 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17589 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17590 .code
17591 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17592 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17593 .endd
17594
17595 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17596 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17597 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17598 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17599
17600
17601 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17602 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17603
17604
17605
17606 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17607 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17608 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17609 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17610 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17611 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17612 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17613 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17614 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17615 &%username-foo%&.
17616
17617
17618 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17619 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17620
17621
17622
17623 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17624 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17625 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17626 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17627 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17628 are evaluated, and
17629 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17630 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17631 example:
17632 .code
17633 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17634 .endd
17635 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17636 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17637 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17638 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17639 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17640 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17641 each virtual domain:
17642 .code
17643 postmaster:
17644 driver = redirect
17645 local_parts = postmaster
17646 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17647 .endd
17648
17649
17650 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17651 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17652 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17653 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17654 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17655 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17656 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17657 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17658 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17659 redirect addresses.
17660
17661
17662
17663 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17664 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17665 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17666 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17667 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17668 delivery to be deferred.
17669
17670 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17671 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17672 .oindex "&%self%&"
17673 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17674 means of the setting
17675 .code
17676 self = pass
17677 .endd
17678 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17679 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17680 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17681
17682 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17683 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17684 controls what happens next.
17685
17686
17687 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17688 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17689 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17690 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17691 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17692 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17693 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17694 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17695
17696 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17697 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17698 applies to all of them.
17699
17700
17701
17702 .option pass_router routers string unset
17703 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17704 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17705 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17706 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17707 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17708 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17709 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17710 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17711 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17712 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17713
17714
17715
17716 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17717 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17718 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17719 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17720 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17721 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17722
17723 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17724 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17725 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17726 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17727
17728
17729
17730 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17731 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17732 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17733 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17734 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17735 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17736 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17737
17738 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17739 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17740 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17741 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17742
17743 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17744 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17745 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17746 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17747 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17748
17749 .cindex "NFS"
17750 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17751 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17752 unavailable.
17753
17754 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17755 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17756 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17757 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17758 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17759 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17760 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17761 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17762
17763 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17764 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17765 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17766 operates as follows:
17767
17768 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17769 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17770 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17771 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17772 used. For example:
17773 .code
17774 require_files = mail:/some/file
17775 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17776 .endd
17777 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17778 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17779
17780 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17781 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17782 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17783 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17784
17785 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17786 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17787 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17788 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17789 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17790
17791 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17792 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17793 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17794 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17795 check again in that process.
17796
17797 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17798 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17799 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17800 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17801 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17802 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17803 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17804 .code
17805 require_files = +/some/file
17806 .endd
17807 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17808 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17809 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17810
17811
17812
17813 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17814 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17815 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17816 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17817 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17818 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17819 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17820 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17821 latter kind.
17822
17823 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17824 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17825 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17826 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17827 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17828 same name.
17829
17830 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17831 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17832 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17833
17834
17835
17836 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17837 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17838 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17839 .vindex "&$home$&"
17840 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17841 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17842 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17843 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17844 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17845 cause the router to defer.
17846
17847 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17848 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17849 place.
17850 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17851 are evaluated.)
17852 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17853 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17854
17855 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17856 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17857 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17858 of these values that is set:
17859
17860 .ilist
17861 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17862 .next
17863 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17864 .next
17865 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17866 .next
17867 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17868 .endlist
17869
17870 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17871 router, but not for the transport.
17872
17873
17874
17875 .option self routers string freeze
17876 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17877 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17878 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17879 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17880 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17881 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17882 of remote hosts.
17883 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17884 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17885 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17886 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17887 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17888
17889 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17890 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17891 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17892 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17893 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17894 cases:
17895
17896 .vlist
17897 .vitem &%defer%&
17898 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17899
17900 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17901 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17902 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17903 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17904
17905 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17906 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17907 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17908 rewritten.
17909
17910 .vitem &%pass%&
17911 .oindex "&%more%&"
17912 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17913 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17914 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17915 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17916 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17917 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17918 combination
17919 .code
17920 self = pass
17921 no_more
17922 .endd
17923 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17924 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17925 be passed to the next router.
17926
17927 .vitem &%fail%&
17928 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17929
17930 .vitem &%send%&
17931 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17932 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17933 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17934 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17935 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17936 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17937 .endlist
17938
17939
17940
17941 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17942 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17943 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17944 address matches something on the list.
17945 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17946 are evaluated.
17947
17948 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17949 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17950 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17951 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17952 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17953 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17954 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17955 matters.
17956
17957
17958 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17959 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17960 .cindex "packet radio"
17961 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17962 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17963 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17964 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17965 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17966 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17967 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17968 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17969
17970 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17971 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17972 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17973 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17974 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17975 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17976 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17977 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17978 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17979 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17980 .code
17981 translate_ip_address = \
17982 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17983 {$value}fail}}
17984 .endd
17985 The file would contain lines like
17986 .code
17987 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17988 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17989 .endd
17990 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17991 are doing.
17992
17993
17994
17995 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17996 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17997 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17998 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17999 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18000 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18001 delivery is deferred.
18002
18003 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18004 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18005 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18006
18007
18008
18009 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18010 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18011 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18012 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18013 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18014 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18015 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18016 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18017 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18018 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18019 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18020 environment.
18021
18022
18023
18024
18025 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18026 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18027 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18028 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18029 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18030 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18031 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18032 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18033 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18034 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18035
18036 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18037 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18038 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18039 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18040 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18041
18042 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18043 environment.
18044
18045
18046
18047
18048 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18049 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18050 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18051 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18052 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18053 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18054 delivery to be deferred.
18055
18056 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18057 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18058 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18059 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18060 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18061 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18062
18063 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18064 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18065 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18066 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18067 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18068 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18069 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18070 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18071
18072 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18073 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18074 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18075 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18076 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18077 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18078 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18079 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18080 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18081 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18082
18083 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18084 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18085 subsequent routers.
18086
18087
18088 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18089 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18090 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18091 .cindex "transport" "local"
18092 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18093 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18094 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18095 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18096 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18097 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18098 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18099 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18100 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18101 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18102 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18103 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18104
18105
18106
18107 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18108 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18109 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18110
18111
18112 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18113 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18114 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18115 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18116 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18117 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18118 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18119 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18120 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18121 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18122
18123 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18124 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18125 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18126 user or group.
18127
18128
18129 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18130 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18131 addresses,
18132 delivering in cutthrough mode
18133 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18134 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18135 are evaluated.
18136 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18137
18138
18139 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18140 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18141 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18142 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18143 are evaluated.
18144 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18145 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18146 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18147
18148
18149
18150
18151
18152
18153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18155
18156 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18157 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18158 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18159 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18160 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18161 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18162 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18163 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18164 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18165 .code
18166 localusers:
18167 driver = accept
18168 domains = mydomain.example
18169 check_local_user
18170 transport = local_delivery
18171 .endd
18172 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18173 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18174 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18175 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18176
18177
18178
18179
18180
18181
18182 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18184
18185 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18186 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18187 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18188 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18189 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18190 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18191
18192 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18193 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18194 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18195 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18196 records.
18197
18198 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18199 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18200 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18201 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18202 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18203 generic option, the router declines.
18204
18205 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18206 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18207 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18208
18209 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18210 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18211 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18212 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18213 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18214 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18215
18216
18217 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18218 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18219 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18220 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18221 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18222 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18223
18224 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18225 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18226 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18227 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18228 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18229 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18230 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18231 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18232 case routing fails.
18233
18234
18235 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18236 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18237 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18238 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18239 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18240
18241 .new
18242 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18243 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18244 .wen
18245
18246 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18247 .ilist
18248 The domain does not exist in DNS
18249 .next
18250 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18251 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18252 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18253 .next
18254 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18255 .next
18256 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18257 .next
18258 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18259 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18260 .next
18261 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18262 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18263 .next
18264 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18265 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18266 .next
18267 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18268 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18269 .endlist
18270
18271
18272
18273
18274 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18275 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18276 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18277
18278 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18279 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18280 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18281 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18282 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18283 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18284 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18285
18286
18287 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18288 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18289 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18290 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18291 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18292 required. For example,
18293 .code
18294 check_srv = smtp
18295 .endd
18296 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18297 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18298 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18299 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18300 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18301 normal way.
18302
18303 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18304 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18305 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18306 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18307 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18308 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18309
18310 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18311 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18312 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18313 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18314 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18315 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18316 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18317 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18318
18319 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18320 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18321
18322
18323
18324
18325 .new
18326 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18327 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18328 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18329 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18330 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18331 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18332 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18333 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18334 also being queued.
18335 .wen
18336
18337
18338 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18339 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18340 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18341 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18342 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18343 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18344 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18345 setting:
18346 .code
18347 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18348 .endd
18349 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18350 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18351 the address record.
18352
18353
18354 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18355 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18356 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18357 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18358
18359
18360
18361
18362 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18363 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18364 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18365 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18366 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18367 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18368 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18369 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18370 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18371 &'resolv.conf'&.
18372
18373
18374
18375 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18376 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18377 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18378 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18379 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18380 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18381 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18382 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18383 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18384 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18385 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18386
18387 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18388 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18389 sense.
18390
18391 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18392 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18393 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18394 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18395 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18396 header rewriting.
18397
18398
18399 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18400 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18401 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18402 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18403 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18404 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18405 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18406 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18407
18408 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18409 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18410 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18411 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18412 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18413 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18414 without processing them independently,
18415 provided the following conditions are met:
18416
18417 .ilist
18418 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18419 &%headers_remove%&.
18420 .next
18421 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18422 the domain.
18423 .endlist
18424
18425
18426
18427
18428 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18429 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18430 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18431 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18432 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18433 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18434 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18435 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18436 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18437 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18438
18439 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18440 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18441 local wildcard.
18442
18443
18444
18445 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18446 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18447 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18448 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18449
18450
18451
18452
18453 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18454 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18455 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18456 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18457 if
18458 .code
18459 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18460 .endd
18461 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18462 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18463 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18464 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18465 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18466 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18467
18468
18469 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18470 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18471 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18472 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18473 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18474
18475 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18476 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18477 such as that implied by
18478 .code
18479 domains = @mx_any
18480 .endd
18481 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18482 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18483 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18484 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18485
18486
18487
18488
18489
18490
18491
18492
18493
18494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18495 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18496
18497 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18498 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18499 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18500 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18501 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18502 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18503 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18504 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18505 router handles the address
18506 .code
18507 root@[192.168.1.1]
18508 .endd
18509 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18510 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18511 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18512 .code
18513 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18514 .endd
18515 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18516 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18517
18518 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18519 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18520 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18521 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18522
18523 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18524 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18525 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18526 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18527
18528
18529
18530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18532
18533 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18534 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18535 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18536 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18537 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18538 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18539 must set
18540 .code
18541 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18542 .endd
18543 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18544
18545 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18546 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18547 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18548 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18549 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18550 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18551 must not be specified for it.
18552
18553 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18554 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18555 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18556 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18557 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18558 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18559 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18560
18561
18562 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18563 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18564 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18565 delivery to the address is deferred.
18566
18567
18568 .option port iplookup integer 0
18569 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18570 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18571 call.
18572
18573
18574 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18575 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18576 protocols is to be used.
18577
18578
18579 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18580 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18581 default value is:
18582 .code
18583 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18584 .endd
18585 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18586 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18587
18588
18589 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18590 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18591 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18592 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18593 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18594 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18595 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18596 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18597
18598
18599 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18600 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18601 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18602 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18603 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18604 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18605 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18606 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18607 following could be used:
18608 .code
18609 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18610 reroute = $local_part@$1
18611 .endd
18612
18613 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18614 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18615 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18616 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18617
18618
18619
18620
18621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18623
18624 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18625 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18626 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18627 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18628 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18629 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18630 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18631 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18632 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18633 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18634
18635 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18636 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18637 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18638 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18639 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18640 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18641 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18642
18643 .vindex "&$host$&"
18644 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18645 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18646 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18647 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18648 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18649 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18650 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18651 text string.
18652
18653 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18654 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18655 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18656 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18657 below, following the list of private options.
18658
18659
18660 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18661
18662 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18663 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18664
18665 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18666 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18667
18668 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18669 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18670 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18671 of the following values:
18672 .code
18673 decline
18674 defer
18675 fail
18676 freeze
18677 ignore
18678 pass
18679 .endd
18680 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18681 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18682 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18683 &%pass_router%&),
18684 .oindex "&%more%&"
18685 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18686 router only if &%more%& is true.
18687
18688 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18689 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18690 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18691 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18692
18693 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18694 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18695 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18696
18697
18698 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18699 .cindex "randomized host list"
18700 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18701 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18702 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18703 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18704 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18705 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18706 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18707 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18708
18709 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18710 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18711 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18712 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18713 .code
18714 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18715 .endd
18716 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18717 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18718 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18719 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18720 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18721
18722
18723 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18724 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18725 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18726 example:
18727 .code
18728 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18729 .endd
18730 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18731 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18732 deferred.
18733
18734
18735 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18736 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18737 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18738 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18739
18740
18741 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18742 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18743 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18744 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18745 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18746 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18747 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18748 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18749
18750 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18751 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18752 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18753 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18754 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18755 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18756 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18757 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18758
18759
18760
18761
18762 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18763 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18764 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18765 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18766 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18767 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18768 .display
18769 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18770 .endd
18771 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18772 no options:
18773 .code
18774 route_list = \
18775 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18776 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18777 .endd
18778 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18779 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18780 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18781 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18782 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18783 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18784 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18785 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18786 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18787 in a &%route_list%&).
18788
18789 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18790 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18791 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18792 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18793
18794
18795
18796 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18797 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18798 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18799 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18800 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18801 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18802 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18803 like this:
18804 .code
18805 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18806 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18807 .endd
18808 This data can be accessed by setting
18809 .code
18810 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18811 .endd
18812 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18813 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18814 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18815 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18816 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18817
18818
18819
18820
18821 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18822 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18823 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18824 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18825 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18826 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18827 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18828
18829 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18830 variables are set during its expansion:
18831
18832 .ilist
18833 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18834 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18835 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18836 .code
18837 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18838 .endd
18839 .next
18840 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18841 .next
18842 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18843
18844 .next
18845 .vindex "&$value$&"
18846 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18847 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18848 .code
18849 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18850 .endd
18851 .endlist
18852
18853 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18854 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18855
18856
18857
18858 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18859 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18860 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18861 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18862 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18863 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18864
18865 .ilist
18866 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18867 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18868 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18869 .code
18870 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18871 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18872 .endd
18873 .next
18874 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18875 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18876 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18877 number follows. For example:
18878 .code
18879 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18880 .endd
18881 .endlist
18882
18883 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18884 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18885 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18886 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18887 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18888 transport.
18889
18890 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18891 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18892 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18893 records in the DNS. For example:
18894 .code
18895 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18896 .endd
18897 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18898 example:
18899 .code
18900 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18901 .endd
18902 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18903 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18904 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18905 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18906 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18907 happens is controlled by the
18908 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18909 &%self%& option of the router.
18910
18911 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18912 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18913 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18914 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18915 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18916 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18917 defined by MX preferences.
18918
18919 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18920 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18921 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18922
18923 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18924 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18925 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18926 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18927
18928 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18929 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18930 router.
18931
18932 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18933 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18934 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18935
18936 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18937 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18938
18939
18940
18941 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18942 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18943 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18944 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18945 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18946 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18947 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18948
18949 .ilist
18950 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18951 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18952 .next
18953 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18954 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18955 .next
18956 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18957 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18958 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18959 .next
18960 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18961 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18962 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18963 .endlist
18964
18965 For example:
18966 .code
18967 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18968 domain2 host4:host5
18969 .endd
18970 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18971 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18972 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18973 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18974 call.
18975
18976 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18977 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18978 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18979 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18980 function called.
18981
18982
18983
18984 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18985 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18986
18987 .vindex "&$host$&"
18988 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18989 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18990
18991
18992
18993 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18994 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18995 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18996
18997 .ilist
18998 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18999 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19000 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19001 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19002 .code
19003 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19004 .endd
19005 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19006 your first router something like this:
19007 .code
19008 smart_route:
19009 driver = manualroute
19010 domains = !+local_domains
19011 transport = remote_smtp
19012 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19013 .endd
19014 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19015 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19016 they are tried in order
19017 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19018 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19019 .code
19020 smart_route:
19021 driver = manualroute
19022 transport = remote_smtp
19023 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19024 .endd
19025 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19026 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19027 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19028 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19029 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19030 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19031 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19032 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19033
19034 .next
19035 .cindex "mail hub example"
19036 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19037 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19038 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19039 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19040 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19041 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19042 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19043 lookup is easier to manage.
19044
19045 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19046 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19047 example:
19048 .code
19049 hub_route:
19050 driver = manualroute
19051 transport = remote_smtp
19052 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19053 .endd
19054 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19055 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19056 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19057 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19058 domain can be used to find the host:
19059 .code
19060 through_firewall:
19061 driver = manualroute
19062 transport = remote_smtp
19063 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19064 .endd
19065 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19066 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19067 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19068 next router.
19069
19070 .next
19071 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19072 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19073 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19074 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19075 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19076 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19077 .code
19078 save_in_file:
19079 driver = manualroute
19080 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19081 route_list = saved.domain.example
19082 .endd
19083 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19084 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19085 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19086 .code
19087 save_in_file:
19088 driver = manualroute
19089 route_list = \
19090 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19091 *.saved.domain2.example \
19092 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19093 batch_pipe
19094 .endd
19095 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19096 .vindex "&$host$&"
19097 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19098 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19099 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19100 the address if the lookup fails.
19101
19102 .next
19103 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19104 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19105 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19106 one way it can be done:
19107 .code
19108 # Transport
19109 uucp:
19110 driver = pipe
19111 user = nobody
19112 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19113 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19114 return_fail_output = true
19115
19116 # Router
19117 uucphost:
19118 transport = uucp
19119 driver = manualroute
19120 route_data = \
19121 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19122 .endd
19123 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19124 .code
19125 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19126 .endd
19127 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19128 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19129 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19130 .endlist
19131 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19132 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19133
19134
19135
19136
19137
19138
19139
19140
19141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19143
19144 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19145 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19146 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19147 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19148 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19149 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19150 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19151 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19152 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19153 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19154 options:
19155 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19156
19157 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19158 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19159 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19160 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19161 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19162
19163
19164 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19165 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19166 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19167 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19168 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19169 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19170
19171
19172 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19173 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19174 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19175 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19176 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19177 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19178 not set, a value for the gid also.
19179
19180 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19181 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19182 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19183 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19184 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19185 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19186 gid.
19187
19188
19189 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19190 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19191 before running the command.
19192
19193
19194 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19195 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19196 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19197 timeout.
19198
19199
19200 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19201 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19202 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19203 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19204 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19205
19206 .ilist
19207 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19208 below).
19209 .next
19210 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19211 &%no_more%& is set.
19212 .next
19213 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19214 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19215 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19216 included in the SMTP response.
19217 .next
19218 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19219 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19220 included in any SMTP response.
19221 .next
19222 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19223 .next
19224 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19225 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19226 .next
19227 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19228 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19229 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19230 .endlist
19231
19232 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19233 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19234 the page):
19235 .code
19236 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19237 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19238 .endd
19239 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19240 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19241 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19242 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19243
19244 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19245 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19246 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19247 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19248 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19249
19250 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19251 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19252 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19253 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19254 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19255
19256 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19257 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19258 variable. For example, this return line
19259 .code
19260 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19261 .endd
19262 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19263 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19264 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19265 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19266
19267
19268
19269
19270 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19272
19273 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19274 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19275 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19276 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19277 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19278 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19279 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19280 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19281 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19282 redirected in several different ways:
19283
19284 .ilist
19285 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19286 independently.
19287 .next
19288 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19289 .next
19290 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19291 .next
19292 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19293 .next
19294 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19295 .next
19296 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19297 .next
19298 It can be discarded.
19299 .endlist
19300
19301 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19302 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19303 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19304 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19305
19306 .new
19307 If success DSNs have been requested
19308 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19309 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19310 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19311 .wen
19312
19313
19314
19315 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19316 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19317 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19318 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19319 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19320 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19321 .code
19322 system_aliases:
19323 driver = redirect
19324 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19325 .endd
19326 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19327 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19328 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19329 cause delivery to be deferred.
19330
19331 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19332 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19333 .code
19334 userforward:
19335 driver = redirect
19336 check_local_user
19337 file = $home/.forward
19338 no_verify
19339 .endd
19340 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19341 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19342 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19343 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19344 comments.
19345
19346
19347
19348 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19349 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19350 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19351 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19352
19353 .ilist
19354 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19355 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19356 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19357 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19358 .next
19359 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19360 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19361 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19362 saves some resources.
19363 .endlist
19364
19365
19366
19367
19368
19369
19370 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19371 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19372 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19373 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19374 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19375
19376 .ilist
19377 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19378 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19379 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19380 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19381 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19382 document is intended for use by end users.
19383 .next
19384 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19385 described in the next section.
19386 .endlist
19387
19388 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19389 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19390 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19391 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19392 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19393
19394
19395
19396 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19397 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19398 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19399 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19400 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19401 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19402 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19403 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19404 commas or newlines.
19405 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19406 quotes.
19407
19408 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19409 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19410 next newline character is ignored.
19411
19412 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19413 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19414 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19415 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19416 removed.
19417
19418 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19419 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19420 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19421 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19422 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19423 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19424 setting:
19425 .code
19426 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19427 .endd
19428
19429
19430 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19431 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19432 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19433 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19434 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19435 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19436 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19437 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19438 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19439 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19440 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19441
19442 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19443 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19444 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19445 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19446 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19447 .code
19448 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19449 .endd
19450 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19451 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19452 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19453 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19454 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19455 synonymously.
19456
19457 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19458 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19459 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19460 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19461 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19462
19463 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19464 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19465 contains:
19466 .code
19467 Sam.Reman: spqr
19468 .endd
19469 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19470 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19471 this forward file:
19472 .code
19473 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19474 .endd
19475 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19476 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19477 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19478 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19479 should really contain
19480 .code
19481 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19482 .endd
19483 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19484 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19485 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19486
19487
19488
19489 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19490 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19491 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19492
19493 .ilist
19494 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19495 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19496 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19497 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19498 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19499 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19500 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19501
19502 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19503 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19504 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19505 in double quotes, for example:
19506 .code
19507 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19508 .endd
19509 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19510 quote just the command. An item such as
19511 .code
19512 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19513 .endd
19514 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19515
19516 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19517 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19518 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19519 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19520 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19521 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19522 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19523 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19524 an &%accept%& router.
19525
19526 .next
19527 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19528 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19529 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19530 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19531 .code
19532 /home/world/minbari
19533 .endd
19534 is treated as a file name, but
19535 .code
19536 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19537 .endd
19538 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19539 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19540 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19541 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19542
19543 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19544 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19545
19546 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19547 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19548 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19549 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19550
19551 .next
19552 .cindex "included address list"
19553 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19554 If an item is of the form
19555 .code
19556 :include:<path name>
19557 .endd
19558 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19559 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19560 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19561 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19562 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19563 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19564 .code
19565 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19566 .endd
19567 It must be given as
19568 .code
19569 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19570 .endd
19571 .next
19572 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19573 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19574 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19575 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19576 .cindex "black hole"
19577 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19578 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19579 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19580 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19581
19582 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19583 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19584 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19585 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19586 &_/dev/null_&.
19587
19588 .next
19589 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19590 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19591 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19592 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19593 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19594 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19595 redirection items of the form
19596 .code
19597 :defer:
19598 :fail:
19599 .endd
19600 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19601 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19602 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19603 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19604 .code
19605 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19606 .endd
19607 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19608 of a
19609 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19610 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19611 default.
19612 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19613 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19614 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19615
19616 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19617 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19618 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19619 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19620 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19621 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19622 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19623 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19624 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19625 ignored.
19626
19627 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19628 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19629 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19630 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19631
19632 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19633 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19634 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19635 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19636 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19637
19638 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19639 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19640 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19641 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19642 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19643 rules still apply.
19644
19645 .next
19646 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19647 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19648 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19649 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19650 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19651 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19652 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19653 .endlist
19654
19655
19656 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19657 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19658 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19659 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19660 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19661 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19662 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19663 aliasing scheme of the type
19664 .code
19665 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19666 localpart1: pipe
19667 localpart2: pipe
19668 .endd
19669 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19670 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19671 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19672 such as
19673 .code
19674 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19675 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19676 .endd
19677 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19678 the pipes are distinct.
19679
19680
19681
19682 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19683 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19684 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19685 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19686 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19687 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19688 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19689 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19690 can be used to avoid this.
19691
19692
19693 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19694 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19695 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19696 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19697 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19698 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19699 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19700
19701
19702
19703 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19704
19705 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19706 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19707
19708
19709 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19710 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19711 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19712
19713
19714 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19715 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19716 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19717 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19718
19719
19720 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19721 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19722 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19723 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19724 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19725 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19726 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19727
19728 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19729 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19730
19731
19732 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19733 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19734 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19735 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19736 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19737
19738
19739
19740 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19741 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19742 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19743 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19744 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19745 let ordinary users do.
19746
19747
19748
19749 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19750 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19751 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19752 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19753 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19754 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19755
19756 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19757 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19758 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19759 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19760 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19761 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19762 .code
19763 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19764 .endd
19765 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19766 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19767 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19768 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19769 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19770 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19771 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19772 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19773
19774
19775 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19776 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19777 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19778 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19779 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19780 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19781 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19782 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19783
19784
19785
19786 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19787 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19788 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19789 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19790 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19791 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19792
19793
19794 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19795 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19796 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19797 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19798 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19799 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19800
19801 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19802 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19803 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19804 .code
19805 data = #Exim filter\n\
19806 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19807 .endd
19808 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19809 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19810 choice into a newline.
19811
19812
19813 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19814 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19815 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19816 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19817 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19818
19819
19820 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19821 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19822 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19823 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19824 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19825 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19826 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19827 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19828
19829 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19830 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19831 runs a check on the containing directory,
19832 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19833 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19834 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19835 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19836 not, the router declines.
19837
19838
19839 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19840 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19841 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19842 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19843 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19844 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19845 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19846
19847
19848 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19849 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19850 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19851 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19852 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19853
19854
19855 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19856 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19857 redirection list.
19858
19859
19860 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19861 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19862 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19863
19864
19865
19866
19867 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19868 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19869 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19870 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19871 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19872 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19873 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19874 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19875 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19876
19877
19878 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19879 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19880 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19881 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19882 functions.
19883
19884 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19885 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19886 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19887 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19888
19889 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19890 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19891 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19892 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19893 &_.forward_& files).
19894
19895
19896 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19897 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19898 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19899
19900
19901 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19902 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19903 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19904 of the embedded Perl support.
19905
19906
19907 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19908 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19909 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19910
19911
19912 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19913 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19914 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19915
19916
19917 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19918 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19919 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19920 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19921 &%one_time%& is set.
19922
19923
19924 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19925 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19926 to make use of &%run%& items.
19927
19928
19929 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19930 If this option is true, items of the form
19931 .code
19932 :include:<path name>
19933 .endd
19934 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19935
19936
19937 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19938 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19939 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19940 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19941 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19942
19943
19944 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19945 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19946 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19947
19948
19949 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19950 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19951 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19952 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19953 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19954
19955
19956
19957
19958 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19959 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19960 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19961 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19962 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19963 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19964 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19965
19966
19967 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19968 .cindex "EACCES"
19969 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19970 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19971 file did not exist.
19972
19973
19974 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19975 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19976 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19977 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19978 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19979
19980 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19981 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19982 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19983 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19984 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19985 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19986 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19987 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19988
19989
19990
19991 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19992 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19993 redirection list must start with this directory.
19994
19995
19996 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19997 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19998 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19999
20000
20001 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20002 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20003 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20004 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20005 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20006 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20007 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20008 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20009 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20010 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20011 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20012 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20013 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20014 before they subscribed.
20015
20016 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20017 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20018 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20019 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20020 attempt.
20021
20022 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20023 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20024 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20025 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20026
20027 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20028 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20029 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20030
20031 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20032 &%one_time%&.
20033
20034 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20035 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20036 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20037 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20038 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20039 expansion.
20040
20041
20042 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20043 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20044 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20045 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20046 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20047 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20048 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20049 See &%check_owner%& above.
20050
20051
20052 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20053 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20054 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20055 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20056
20057
20058 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20059 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20060 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20061 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20062 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20063 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20064 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20065
20066
20067 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20068 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20069 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20070 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20071 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20072 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20073 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20074 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20075
20076 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20077 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20078 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20079 addresses.
20080
20081 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20082 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20083 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20084 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20085 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20086 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20087 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20088 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20089 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20090 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20091
20092
20093 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20094 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20095 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20096 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20097 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20098 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20099
20100
20101 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20102 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20103 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20104 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20105 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20106 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20107
20108
20109 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20110 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20111 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20112 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20113 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20114
20115
20116 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20117 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20118 :subaddress part of an address.
20119
20120 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20121 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20122 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20123 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20124
20125
20126 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20127 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20128 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20129 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20130 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20131 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20132 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20133
20134
20135
20136 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20137 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20138 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20139 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20140 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20141 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20142 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20143 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20144 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20145 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20146 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20147 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20148 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20149 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20150 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20151 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20152
20153 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20154 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20155 the following routers.
20156
20157 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20158 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20159 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20160 so it is passed to the following routers.
20161
20162 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20163 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20164 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20165 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20166
20167 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20168 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20169 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20170 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20171 .code
20172 userforward:
20173 driver = redirect
20174 allow_filter
20175 check_local_user
20176 file = $home/.forward
20177 file_transport = address_file
20178 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20179 reply_transport = address_reply
20180 no_verify
20181 skip_syntax_errors
20182 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20183 syntax_errors_text = \
20184 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20185 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20186 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20187 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20188 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20189 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20190 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20191 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20192 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20193 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20194 .endd
20195 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20196 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20197 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20198 .code
20199 real_localuser:
20200 driver = accept
20201 check_local_user
20202 local_part_prefix = real-
20203 transport = local_delivery
20204 .endd
20205 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20206 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20207 .code
20208 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20209 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20210 .endd
20211
20212
20213 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20214 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20215
20216
20217 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20218 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20219 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20220 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20221
20222
20223
20224
20225
20226
20227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20229
20230 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20231 "Environment for local transports"
20232 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20233 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20234 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20235 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20236 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20237 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20238 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20239
20240 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20241 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20242 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20243 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20244
20245 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20246 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20247 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20248 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20249 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20250
20251
20252
20253 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20254 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20255 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20256 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20257 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20258 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20259 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20260 time.
20261
20262 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20263 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20264 .code
20265 my_transport:
20266 driver = pipe
20267 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20268 .endd
20269 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20270 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20271 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20272 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20273
20274
20275
20276
20277 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20278 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20279 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20280 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20281 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20282 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20283 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20284 group (set by the transport). For example:
20285 .code
20286 # Routers ...
20287 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20288 local_users:
20289 driver = accept
20290 check_local_user
20291 transport = group_delivery
20292
20293 # Transports ...
20294 # This transport overrides the group
20295 group_delivery:
20296 driver = appendfile
20297 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20298 group = mail
20299 .endd
20300 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20301 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20302 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20303 set.
20304
20305 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20306 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20307 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20308 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20309 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20310 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20311
20312 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20313 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20314 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20315 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20316 original gid is also used.
20317
20318 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20319 following that is set is used:
20320
20321 .ilist
20322 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20323 .next
20324 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20325 .next
20326 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20327 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20328 .next
20329 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20330 .next
20331 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20332 the uid is the creator's uid;
20333 .next
20334 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20335 .endlist
20336
20337 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20338 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20339 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20340 The first of the following that is set is used:
20341
20342 .ilist
20343 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20344 .next
20345 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20346 .next
20347 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20348 .next
20349 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20350 .next
20351 The Exim uid.
20352 .endlist
20353
20354 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20355 &%never_users%& list.
20356
20357
20358
20359
20360
20361 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20362 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20363 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20364 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20365 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20366 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20367 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20368 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20369 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20370 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20371
20372 .ilist
20373 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20374 .next
20375 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20376 .next
20377 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20378 .next
20379 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20380 .endlist
20381
20382 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20383
20384 .ilist
20385 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20386 .next
20387 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20388 .endlist
20389
20390
20391 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20392 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20393 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20394
20395
20396
20397 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20398 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20399 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20400 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20401 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20402 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20403 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20404 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20405 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20406 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20407 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20408 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20409 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20410 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20411
20412
20413
20414
20415
20416
20417
20418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20420
20421 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20422 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20423 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20424 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20425 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20426
20427
20428 .option body_only transports boolean false
20429 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20430 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20431 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20432 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20433 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20434 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20435 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20436 automatically suppress them.
20437
20438
20439 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20440 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20441 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20442 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20443 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20444 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20445
20446
20447 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20448 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20449 deliveries by the transport or for any
20450 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20451 what you are doing.
20452
20453
20454 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20455 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20456 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20457 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20458 transport is run.
20459 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20460 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20461 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20462 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20463 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20464 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20465 one.
20466 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20467 transport and the router that called it.
20468
20469 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20470 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20471 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20472 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20473 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20474 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20475 safely be resent to other recipients.
20476
20477
20478 .option driver transports string unset
20479 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20480 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20481
20482
20483 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20484 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20485 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20486 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20487 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20488 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20489 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20490 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20491 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20492 resent to other recipients.
20493
20494
20495 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20496 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20497 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20498 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20499 &%user%& (see below).
20500
20501
20502 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20503 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20504 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20505 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20506 .new
20507 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20508 .wen
20509 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20510 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20511 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20512 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20513 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20514 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20515
20516 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20517 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20518
20519
20520 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20521 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20522 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20523 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20524 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20525 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20526 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20527 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20528
20529
20530 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20531 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20532 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20533 This option specifies a list of header names,
20534 .new
20535 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20536 .wen
20537 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20538 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20539 routers.
20540 Each list item is separately expanded.
20541 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20542 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20543 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20544
20545 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20546 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20547
20548 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20549 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20550 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20551
20552
20553
20554 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20555 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20556 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20557 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20558 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20559 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20560 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20561 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20562 example,
20563 .code
20564 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20565 x@y w@z
20566 .endd
20567 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20568 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20569 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20570 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20571 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20572 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20573 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20574 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20575 change envelope recipients at this time.
20576
20577
20578 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20579 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20580 .vindex "&$home$&"
20581 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20582 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20583 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20584 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20585 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20586 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20587 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20588 deferred.
20589
20590
20591 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20592 .cindex "additional groups"
20593 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20594 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20595 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20596 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20597 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20598
20599
20600 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20601 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20602 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20603 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20604 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20605 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20606 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20607 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20608 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20609 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20610 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20611 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20612 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20613 delivered.
20614
20615
20616
20617 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20618 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20619 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20620 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20621 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20622 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20623 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20624 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20625 that contains
20626 .code
20627 local_part_prefix = *-
20628 .endd
20629 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20630 is delivered with
20631 .code
20632 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20633 .endd
20634 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20635 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20636 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20637 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20638 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20639
20640
20641 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20642 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20643 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20644 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20645 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20646 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20647 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20648 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20649 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20650
20651 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20652 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20653 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20654 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20655
20656 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20657 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20658 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20659
20660
20661 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20662 .cindex "envelope sender"
20663 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20664 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20665 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20666 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20667 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20668 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20669 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20670 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20671 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20672
20673 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20674 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20675
20676 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20677 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20678 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20679 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20680 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20681 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20682 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20683
20684 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20685 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20686 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20687 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20688 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20689
20690
20691
20692 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20693 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20694 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20695 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20696 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20697 have easy access to it.
20698
20699 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20700 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20701 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20702 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20703 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20704 recipients.
20705
20706
20707 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20708 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20709
20710
20711 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20712 .cindex "shadow transport"
20713 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20714 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20715 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20716
20717 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20718 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20719 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20720 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20721 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20722 cause a log line to be written.
20723
20724 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20725 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20726 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20727 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20728 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20729 of the form
20730 .code
20731 ST=<shadow transport name>
20732 .endd
20733 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20734 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20735 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20736 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20737 headers that some sites insist on.
20738
20739
20740 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20741 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20742 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20743 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20744 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20745 individual users or via a system filter.
20746
20747 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20748 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20749 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20750 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20751 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20752
20753 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20754 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20755 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20756 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20757 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20758 &(pipe)& transports.
20759
20760 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20761 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20762 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20763 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20764 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20765
20766 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20767 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20768 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20769 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20770
20771 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20772 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20773 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20774 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20775 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20776 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20777
20778 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20779 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20780 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20781 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20782 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20783 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20784 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20785 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20786
20787 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20788 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20789 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20790 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20791 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20792 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20793 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20794 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20795 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20796 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20797
20798 .vindex "&$host$&"
20799 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20800 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20801 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20802 which the message is being sent. For example:
20803 .code
20804 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20805 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20806 .endd
20807
20808 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20809 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20810 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20811 .ilist
20812 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20813 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20814 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20815 example:
20816 .code
20817 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20818 .endd
20819 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20820 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20821 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20822 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20823 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20824 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20825 .next
20826 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20827 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20828 arguments. Consider this example:
20829 .code
20830 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20831 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20832 .endd
20833 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20834 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20835 .code
20836 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20837 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20838 .endd
20839 .endlist
20840
20841 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20842 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20843 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20844 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20845 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20846 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20847 bounced from a transport filter.
20848
20849 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20850 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20851 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20852
20853
20854 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20855 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20856 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20857 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20858 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20859 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20860 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20861 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20862 becomes a temporary error.
20863
20864
20865 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20866 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20867 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20868 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20869 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20870 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20871 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20872 option is not set.
20873
20874 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20875 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20876 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20877
20878 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20879 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20880 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20881 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20882 retry data.
20883 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20884 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20885 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20886
20887
20888
20889
20890
20891
20892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20894
20895 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20896 "Address batching"
20897 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20898 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20899 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20900 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20901 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20902 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20903 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20904
20905 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20906 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20907 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20908 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20909 local transport, for example:
20910
20911 .ilist
20912 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20913 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20914 recipients saves space.
20915 .next
20916 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20917 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20918 .next
20919 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20920 to a scanner program or
20921 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20922 acceptable.
20923 .endlist
20924
20925 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20926 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20927 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20928
20929 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20930 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20931 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20932 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20933 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20934 to certain conditions:
20935
20936 .ilist
20937 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20938 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20939 batching is possible.
20940 .next
20941 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20942 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20943 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20944 .next
20945 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20946 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20947 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20948 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20949 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20950 from taking place.
20951 .next
20952 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20953 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20954 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20955 be the same.
20956 .endlist
20957
20958 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20959 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20960 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20961 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20962 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20963 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20964 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20965 .code
20966 check_string = "."
20967 escape_string = ".."
20968 .endd
20969 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20970 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20971 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20972
20973 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20974 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20975 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20976 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20977 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20978 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20979
20980 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20981 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20982 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20983 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20984 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20985 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20986 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20987 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20988 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20989
20990
20991
20992
20993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20995
20996 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20997 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20998 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20999 .cindex "directory creation"
21000 .cindex "creating directories"
21001 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21002 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21003 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21004 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21005 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21006 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21007 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21008 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21009 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21010 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21011
21012 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21013 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21014 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21015 included.
21016
21017 .cindex "quota" "system"
21018 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21019 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21020 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21021
21022 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21023 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21024 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21025 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21026
21027 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21028 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21029 private options.
21030
21031 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21032 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21033 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21034 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21035 option).
21036
21037
21038
21039 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21040 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21041 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21042 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21043 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21044
21045 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21046 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21047 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21048 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21049 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21050 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21051 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21052 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21053 operation. There are two cases:
21054
21055 .ilist
21056 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21057 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21058 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21059 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21060 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21061 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21062 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21063 .next
21064 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21065 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21066 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21067 .endlist
21068
21069
21070 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21071 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21072 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21073 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21074 form:
21075 .code
21076 save folder23
21077 .endd
21078 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21079 .code
21080 require "fileinto";
21081 fileinto "folder23";
21082 .endd
21083 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21084 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21085 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21086 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21087 way of handling this requirement:
21088 .code
21089 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21090 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21091 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21092 {$address_file} \
21093 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21094 }} \
21095 }
21096 .endd
21097 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21098 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21099 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21100
21101 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21102 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21103 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21104 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21105 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21106 path to the transport.
21107
21108 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21109 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21110
21111
21112
21113
21114 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21115 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21116
21117
21118
21119 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21120 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21121 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21122 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21123 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21124 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21125 delivery is deferred.
21126
21127
21128 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21129 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21130 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21131 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21132 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21133 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21134 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21135 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21136
21137
21138 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21139 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21140 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21141 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21142 file.
21143
21144
21145 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21146 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21147
21148
21149 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21150 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21151 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21152 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21153 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21154
21155
21156 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21157 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21158 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21159 process is running.
21160
21161
21162 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21163 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21164 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21165 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21166 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21167 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21168 contains is significant.
21169
21170 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21171 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21172 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21173 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21174 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21175
21176 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21177 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21178 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21179 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21180 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21181 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21182 .code
21183 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21184 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21185 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21186 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21187 .endd
21188 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21189 .cindex "directory creation"
21190 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21191 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21192 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21193
21194 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21195 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21196 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21197 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21198 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21199
21200
21201
21202 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21203 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21204 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21205 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21206 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21207 beneath.
21208
21209 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21210 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21211 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21212 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21213 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21214 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21215 &%file_must_exist%&.
21216
21217
21218 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21219 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21220 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21221 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21222
21223 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21224 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21225 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21226 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21227 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21228
21229
21230 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21231 .cindex "base62"
21232 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21233 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21234 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21235 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21236 .code
21237 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21238 .endd
21239 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21240 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21241 option.
21242
21243
21244 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21245 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21246 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21247
21248
21249 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21250 See &%check_string%& above.
21251
21252
21253 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21254 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21255 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21256 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21257 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21258 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21259 &%file%&.
21260
21261 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21262 .cindex "locking files"
21263 .cindex "lock files"
21264 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21265 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21266
21267 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21268 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21269 examples:
21270 .code
21271 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21272 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21273 file = $home/inbox
21274 .endd
21275 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21276 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21277 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21278 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21279 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21280 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21281
21282
21283
21284 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21285 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21286 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21287 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21288 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21289 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21290 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21291 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21292 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21293 this added to it:
21294 .code
21295 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21296 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21297 .endd
21298 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21299 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21300 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21301 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21302 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21303 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21304 delivery is deferred.
21305
21306
21307 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21308 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21309 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21310 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21311
21312
21313 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21314 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21315 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21316 .cindex "locking files"
21317 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21318 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21319 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21320 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21321 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21322 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21323 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21324 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21325
21326 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21327 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21328 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21329 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21330
21331 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21332 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21333 retries is
21334 .code
21335 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21336 .endd
21337 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21338 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21339 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21340
21341 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21342 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21343 .code
21344 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21345 .endd
21346
21347 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21348 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21349 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21350 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21351
21352
21353 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21354 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21355 for details of locking.
21356
21357
21358 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21359 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21360 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21361
21362
21363 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21364 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21365 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21366
21367
21368 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21369 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21370 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21371 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21372 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21373
21374
21375 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21376 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21377 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21378 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21379 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21380 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21381 external source that maintains the data.
21382
21383
21384 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21385 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21386 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21387 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21388 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21389 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21390 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21391 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21392
21393
21394
21395 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21396 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21397 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21398 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21399 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21400 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21401 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21402 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21403 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21404 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21405
21406
21407 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21408 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21409 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21410 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21411 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21412 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21413 calculation. The default value is:
21414 .code
21415 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21416 .endd
21417 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21418 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21419 &_Trash_&
21420 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21421 .code
21422 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21423 .endd
21424 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21425 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21426 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21427 directly into that directory.
21428
21429
21430 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21431 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21432 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21433
21434
21435 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21436 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21437 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21438
21439
21440 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21441 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21442 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21443 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21444 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21445 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21446 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21447 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21448
21449 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21450 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21451 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21452 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21453 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21454 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21455 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21456 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21457 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21458 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21459
21460
21461 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21462 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21463 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21464 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21465 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21466 below for further details.
21467
21468
21469 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21470 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21471 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21472
21473
21474 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21475 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21476 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21477
21478
21479 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21480 .cindex "locking files"
21481 .cindex "file" "locking"
21482 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21483 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21484 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21485 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21486 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21487 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21488 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21489
21490 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21491 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21492 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21493 combination:
21494 .code
21495 mbx_format = true
21496 message_prefix =
21497 message_suffix =
21498 .endd
21499 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21500 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21501 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21502 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21503 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21504 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21505 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21506 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21507
21508 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21509 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21510 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21511 append messages to it.
21512
21513
21514 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21515 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21516 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21517 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21518 in which case it is:
21519 .code
21520 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21521 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21522 .endd
21523 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21524 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21525
21526 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21527 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21528 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21529 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21530 setting
21531 .code
21532 message_suffix =
21533 .endd
21534 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21535 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21536
21537 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21538 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21539 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21540 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21541 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21542 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21543 value, and this option is ignored.
21544
21545
21546 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21547 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21548 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21549 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21550 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21551
21552
21553 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21554 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21555 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21556 on users about incoming mail.
21557
21558
21559 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21560 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21561 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21562 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21563 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21564 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21565 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21566 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21567 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21568
21569 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21570 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21571 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21572
21573 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21574 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21575 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21576 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21577 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21578 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21579
21580 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21581 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21582 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21583 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21584 be handled.
21585
21586 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21587
21588 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21589 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21590 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21591 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21592 system quota failures.
21593
21594 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21595 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21596 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21597 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21598 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21599 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21600 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21601 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21602 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21603 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21604
21605
21606 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21607 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21608 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21609 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21610 delivery directory.
21611
21612
21613 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21614 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21615 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21616 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21617 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21618 &"no quota"&.
21619
21620
21621 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21622 See &%quota%& above.
21623
21624
21625 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21626 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21627 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21628 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21629 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21630 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21631 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21632
21633 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21634 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21635 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21636 the file length to the file name. For example:
21637 .code
21638 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21639 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21640 .endd
21641 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21642 number of lines in the message.
21643
21644 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21645 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21646 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21647
21648 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21649
21650
21651 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21652 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21653 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21654 .code
21655 quota_warn_message = "\
21656 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21657 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21658 This message is automatically created \
21659 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21660 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21661 a warning threshold that is\n\
21662 set by the system administrator.\n"
21663 .endd
21664
21665
21666 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21667 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21668 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21669 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21670 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21671 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21672 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21673 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21674 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21675 sign. For example:
21676 .code
21677 quota = 10M
21678 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21679 .endd
21680 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21681 percent sign is ignored.
21682
21683 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21684 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21685 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21686 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21687 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21688 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21689 .code
21690 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21691 .endd
21692 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21693 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21694 option.
21695
21696 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21697 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21698 percentage.
21699
21700
21701 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21702 .cindex "envelope sender"
21703 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21704 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21705 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21706 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21707 for details of batch SMTP.
21708
21709
21710 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21711 .cindex "carriage return"
21712 .cindex "linefeed"
21713 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21714 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21715 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21716 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21717
21718 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21719 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21720 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21721 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21722 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21723 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21724
21725
21726 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21727 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21728 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21729 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21730 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21731 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21732
21733
21734 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21735 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21736 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21737 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21738 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21739
21740 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21741 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21742 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21743 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21744
21745 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21746 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21747 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21748 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21749 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21750 error.
21751
21752 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21753 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21754
21755
21756 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21757 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21758 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21759 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21760 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21761 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21762 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21763
21764 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21765 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21766 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21767 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21768 file corruption.
21769
21770 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21771 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21772 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21773
21774
21775 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21776 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21777 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21778 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21779 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21780 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21781 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21782 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21783 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21784
21785 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21786 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21787 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21788 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21789
21790
21791
21792
21793 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21794 .cindex "appending to a file"
21795 .cindex "file" "appending"
21796 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21797
21798 .ilist
21799 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21800 return is given.
21801
21802 .next
21803 .cindex "directory creation"
21804 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21805 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21806 &%directory_mode%& option.
21807
21808 .next
21809 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21810 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21811 transport.
21812
21813 .next
21814 .cindex "file" "locking"
21815 .cindex "locking files"
21816 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21817 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21818 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21819
21820 .olist
21821 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21822 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21823 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21824 .next
21825 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21826 .next
21827 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21828 Unlink the hitching post name.
21829 .next
21830 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21831 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21832 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21833 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21834 .next
21835 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21836 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21837 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21838 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21839 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21840 it before trying again.
21841 .endlist olist
21842
21843 .next
21844 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21845 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21846 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21847
21848 .next
21849 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21850 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21851 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21852 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21853 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21854 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21855 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21856 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21857 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21858 checked.
21859
21860 .next
21861 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21862 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21863 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21864 delivery is deferred.
21865
21866 .next
21867 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21868 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21869 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21870 permissions.
21871
21872 .next
21873 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21874 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21875 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21876
21877 .next
21878 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21879 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21880 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21881
21882 .next
21883 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21884 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21885 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21886 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21887 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21888 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21889 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21890 that prevents link following.
21891
21892 .next
21893 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21894 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21895 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21896 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21897 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21898
21899 .next
21900 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21901
21902 .next
21903 .cindex "file" "locking"
21904 .cindex "locking files"
21905 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21906 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21907 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21908 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21909 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21910 .code
21911 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21912 .endd
21913 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21914 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21915 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21916
21917 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21918 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21919 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21920
21921 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21922 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21923 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21924 delivery is deferred.
21925
21926 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21927 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21928 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21929 immediately. It retries up to
21930 .code
21931 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21932 .endd
21933 times (rounded up).
21934 .endlist
21935
21936 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21937 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21938
21939
21940 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21941 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21942 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21943 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21944 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21945 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21946 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21947 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21948 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21949 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21950
21951 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21952 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21953 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21954 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21955 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21956 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21957 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21958
21959 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21960 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21961 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21962 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21963
21964
21965 .cindex "maildir format"
21966 .cindex "mailstore format"
21967 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21968 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21969 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21970 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21971 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21972
21973 .cindex "directory creation"
21974 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21975 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21976 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21977 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21978 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21979 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21980 deferred.
21981
21982
21983
21984 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21985 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21986 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21987 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21988 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21989 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21990 &_new_& subdirectory.
21991
21992 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21993 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21994 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21995 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21996 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21997 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21998 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21999
22000 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22001 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22002 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22003 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22004 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22005 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22006 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22007 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22008
22009 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22010 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22011 folders. Consider this example:
22012 .code
22013 maildir_format = true
22014 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22015 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22016 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22017 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22018 .endd
22019 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22020 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22021 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22022 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22023 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22024 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22025
22026 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22027 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22028 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22029 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22030 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22031
22032 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22033 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22034 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22035
22036 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22037 .cindex "maildir++"
22038 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22039 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22040 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22041 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22042 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22043 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22044 amount of space used.
22045
22046 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22047 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22048 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22049 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22050 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22051 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22052
22053
22054
22055
22056 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22057 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22058 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22059 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22060 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22061 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22062
22063
22064 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22065 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22066 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22067 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22068 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22069 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22070 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22071 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22072 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22073 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22074 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22075 backwards compatibility).
22076
22077 For one common implementation, you might set:
22078 .code
22079 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22080 .endd
22081 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22082
22083 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22084 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22085 &[stat()]& each message file.
22086
22087
22088 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22089 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22090 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22091 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22092 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22093 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22094 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22095 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22096 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22097
22098 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22099 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22100 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22101 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22102 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22103 need to know the quota.
22104
22105 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22106 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22107
22108 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22109 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22110 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22111 details.
22112
22113
22114 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22115 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22116 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22117 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22118 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22119 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22120 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22121 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22122
22123 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22124 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22125 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22126 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22127 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22128 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22129
22130 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22131 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22132 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22133 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22134 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22135 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22136
22137 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22138 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22139 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22140 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22141
22142
22143 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22144 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22145 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22146 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22147 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22148 .code
22149 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22150 .endd
22151 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22152 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22153 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22154 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22155 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22156
22157
22158
22159
22160
22161
22162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22164
22165 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22166 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22167 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22168 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22169 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22170 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22171 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22172 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22173
22174 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22175 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22176 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22177 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22178 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22179
22180
22181 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22182 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22183 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22184 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22185 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22186
22187 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22188 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22189 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22190 transport is run as a consequence of a
22191 &%mail%&
22192 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22193 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22194 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22195 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22196 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22197 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22198
22199 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22200 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22201 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22202 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22203
22204 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22205 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22206 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22207 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22208 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22209 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22210 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22211
22212 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22213 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22214 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22215 the transport defers.
22216 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22217 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22218
22219 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22220 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22221 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22222 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22223
22224 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22225 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22226 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22227 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22228 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22229 problems. They are just discarded.
22230
22231
22232
22233 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22234 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22235
22236 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22237 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22238 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22239
22240
22241 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22242 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22243 when the message is specified by the transport.
22244
22245
22246 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22247 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22248 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22249 string comes first.
22250
22251
22252 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22253 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22254 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22255
22256
22257 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22258 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22259 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22260
22261
22262 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22263 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22264 specified by the transport.
22265
22266
22267 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22268 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22269 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22270 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22271
22272
22273 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22274 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22275 the message is specified by the transport.
22276
22277
22278 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22279 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22280 used.
22281
22282
22283 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22284 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22285 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22286 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22287 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22288
22289
22290
22291 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22292 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22293 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22294 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22295
22296 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22297 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22298 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22299 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22300 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22301 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22302 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22303 infinity.
22304
22305 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22306 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22307 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22308 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22309 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22310
22311 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22312 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22313 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22314 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22315 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22316 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22317
22318
22319 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22320 See &%once%& above.
22321
22322
22323 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22324 See &%once%& above.
22325 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22326
22327
22328 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22329 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22330 specified by the transport.
22331
22332
22333 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22334 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22335 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22336 configuration option.
22337
22338
22339 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22340 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22341 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22342 automatic responses. For example:
22343 .code
22344 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22345 .endd
22346 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22347 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22348 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22349 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22350 small.
22351
22352
22353
22354 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22355 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22356 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22357 the text comes first.
22358
22359
22360 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22361 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22362 when the message is specified by the transport.
22363 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22364 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22365
22366
22367
22368
22369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22371
22372 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22373 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22374 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22375 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22376 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22377 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22378 specified command
22379 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22380 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22381 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22382 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22383 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22384 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22385 .code
22386 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22387 .endd
22388 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22389 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22390 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22391 as follows:
22392
22393 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22394 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22395
22396
22397 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22398 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22399 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22400 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22401 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22402
22403
22404 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22405 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22406 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22407 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22408 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22409 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22410 LMTP protocol.
22411
22412 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22413 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22414 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22415 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22416 in its response to the LHLO command.
22417
22418 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22419 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22420 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22421 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22422
22423
22424 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22425 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22426 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22427 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22428 LMTP transport:
22429 .code
22430 lmtp:
22431 driver = lmtp
22432 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22433 batch_max = 20
22434 user = exim
22435 .endd
22436 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22437 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22438
22439
22440
22441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22443
22444 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22445 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22446 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22447 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22448 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22449 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22450 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22451 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22452 following ways:
22453
22454 .ilist
22455 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22456 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22457 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22458 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22459 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22460 .next
22461 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22462 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22463 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22464 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22465 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22466 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22467 that are routed to the transport.
22468 .next
22469 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22470 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22471 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22472 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22473 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22474 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22475 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22476 .endlist
22477
22478
22479 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22480 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22481 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22482
22483 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22484 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22485 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22486 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22487 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22488 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22489 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22490
22491
22492 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22493 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22494 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22495 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22496 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22497
22498
22499
22500
22501 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22502 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22503 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22504 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22505 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22506 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22507 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22508 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22509 &"local delivery failed"&.
22510
22511 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22512 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22513 will be sent as normal.
22514
22515 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22516 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22517 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22518 apply in this case.
22519
22520 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22521 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22522 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22523 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22524
22525 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22526 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22527 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22528 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22529 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22530 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22531 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22532 &%temp_errors%&.
22533
22534
22535
22536 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22537 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22538 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22539 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22540 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22541 run.
22542
22543 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22544 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22545 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22546 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22547
22548 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22549 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22550 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22551 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22552 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22553 .code
22554 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22555 .endd
22556 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22557 arguments. You have to write
22558 .code
22559 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22560 .endd
22561 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22562 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22563 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22564 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22565 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22566 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22567 example:
22568 .code
22569 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22570 .endd
22571
22572 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22573 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22574 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22575 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22576 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22577 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22578 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22579 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22580 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22581 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22582
22583 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22584 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22585 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22586 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22587 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22588 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22589 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22590 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22591
22592 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22593 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22594 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22595 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22596 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22597 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22598 control what is done with it.
22599
22600 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22601 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22602 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22603 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22604 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22605 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22606 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22607 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22608 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22609 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22610 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22611
22612
22613
22614 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22615 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22616 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22617 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22618 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22619 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22620 environment.
22621 .display
22622 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22623 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22624 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22625 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22626 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22627 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22628 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22629 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22630 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22631 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22632 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22633 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22634 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22635 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22636 &`USER `& see below
22637 .endd
22638 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22639 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22640 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22641 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22642 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22643 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22644 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22645
22646 .cindex "HOST"
22647 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22648 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22649 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22650 the router.
22651
22652 .cindex "HOME"
22653 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22654 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22655 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22656 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22657
22658
22659 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22660 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22661
22662
22663
22664 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22665 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22666 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22667 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22668 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22669 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22670 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22671 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22672 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22673 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22674 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22675 example, if
22676 .code
22677 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22678 .endd
22679 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22680 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22681 &%use_shell%& is set.
22682
22683
22684 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22685 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22686
22687
22688 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22689 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22690 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22691
22692
22693 .option check_string pipe string unset
22694 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22695 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22696 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22697 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22698 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22699 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22700 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22701 ignored.
22702
22703
22704 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22705 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22706 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22707 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22708 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22709 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22710 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22711
22712
22713 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22714 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22715 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22716 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22717 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22718 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22719 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22720
22721
22722 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22723 See &%check_string%& above.
22724
22725
22726 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22727 .cindex "exec failure"
22728 .cindex "failure of exec"
22729 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22730 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22731 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22732 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22733 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22734
22735
22736 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22737 .cindex "signal exit"
22738 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22739 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22740 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22741 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22742
22743
22744 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22745 .cindex "force command"
22746 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22747 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22748 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22749 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22750 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22751 command. For example:
22752 .code
22753 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22754 force_command
22755 .endd
22756
22757 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22758 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22759 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22760
22761 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22762 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22763 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22764 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22765 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22766 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22767
22768 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22769 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22770
22771 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22772 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22773 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22774 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22775 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22776
22777
22778 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22779 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22780 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22781 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22782 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22783 Only one of them may be set.
22784
22785
22786
22787 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22788 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22789 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22790 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22791
22792
22793
22794 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22795 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22796 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22797 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22798 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22799 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22800 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22801 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22802
22803
22804 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22805 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22806 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22807 .code
22808 message_prefix = \
22809 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22810 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22811 .endd
22812 .cindex "Cyrus"
22813 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22814 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22815 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22816 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22817 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22818 setting
22819 .code
22820 message_prefix =
22821 .endd
22822 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22823 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22824
22825
22826 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22827 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22828 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22829 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22830 .code
22831 message_suffix =
22832 .endd
22833 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22834 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22835
22836
22837 .option path pipe string "see below"
22838 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22839 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22840 .code
22841 /bin:/usr/bin
22842 .endd
22843 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22844 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22845 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22846
22847
22848 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22849 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22850 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22851 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22852 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22853 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22854 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22855 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22856 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22857
22858
22859 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22860 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22861 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22862 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22863 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22864 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22865 accept the message is used.
22866
22867
22868 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22869 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22870 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22871 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22872 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22873 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22874
22875
22876 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22877 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22878 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22879 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22880 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22881 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22882 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22883
22884
22885
22886 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22887 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22888 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22889 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22890 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22891 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22892 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22893 of them may be set.
22894
22895
22896
22897 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22898 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22899 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22900 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22901 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22902 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22903 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22904 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22905 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22906 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22907 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22908 and 73, respectively.
22909
22910
22911 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22912 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22913 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22914 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22915 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22916 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22917 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22918
22919 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22920 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22921 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22922 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22923 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22924 delivery to be deferred.
22925
22926 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22927 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22928
22929
22930 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22931 .cindex "envelope sender"
22932 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22933 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22934 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22935 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22936 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22937
22938 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22939 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22940 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22941 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22942 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22943 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22944 class database.
22945
22946
22947 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22948 .cindex "carriage return"
22949 .cindex "linefeed"
22950 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22951 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22952 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22953 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22954
22955 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22956 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22957 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22958 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22959 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22960
22961
22962 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22963 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22964 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22965 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22966 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22967 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22968 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22969 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22970 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22971 its &%-c%& option.
22972
22973
22974
22975 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22976 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22977 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22978 .cindex "external local delivery"
22979 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22980 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22981 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22982 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22983 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22984 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22985 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22986 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22987 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22988 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22989 .code
22990 # transport
22991 procmail_pipe:
22992 driver = pipe
22993 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22994 return_path_add
22995 delivery_date_add
22996 envelope_to_add
22997 check_string = "From "
22998 escape_string = ">From "
22999 umask = 077
23000 user = $local_part
23001 group = mail
23002
23003 # router
23004 procmail:
23005 driver = accept
23006 check_local_user
23007 transport = procmail_pipe
23008 .endd
23009 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23010 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23011 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23012 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23013 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23014 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23015
23016 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23017 .code
23018 IFS=" "
23019 .endd
23020 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23021 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23022
23023 .cindex "Cyrus"
23024 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23025 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23026 .code
23027 # transport
23028 local_delivery_cyrus:
23029 driver = pipe
23030 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23031 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23032 user = cyrus
23033 group = mail
23034 return_output
23035 log_output
23036 message_prefix =
23037 message_suffix =
23038
23039 # router
23040 local_user_cyrus:
23041 driver = accept
23042 check_local_user
23043 local_part_suffix = .*
23044 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23045 .endd
23046 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23047 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23048 sender.
23049 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23050 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23051
23052
23053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23054 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23055
23056 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23057 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23058 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23059 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23060 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23061 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23062 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23063 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23064
23065
23066 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23067 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23068 two ways:
23069
23070 .ilist
23071 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23072 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23073 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23074 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23075 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23076 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23077 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23078 .next
23079 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23080 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23081 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23082 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23083 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23084 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23085 process.
23086 .endlist
23087
23088
23089 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23090 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23091 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23092
23093
23094
23095 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23096 .vindex "&$host$&"
23097 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23098 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23099 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23100 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23101 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23102 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23103 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23104 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23105
23106
23107 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23108 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23109 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23110 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23111 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23112 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23113 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23114 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23115 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23116 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23117 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23118 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23119 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23120 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23121
23122 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23123 and will be removed in a future release.
23124
23125
23126 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23127 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23128 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23129
23130
23131 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23132 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23133 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23134 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23135 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23136 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23137 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23138 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23139
23140 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23141 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23142 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23143 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23144 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23145 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23146 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23147 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23148 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23149
23150
23151 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23152 .cindex "Cyrus"
23153 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23154 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23155 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23156 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23157 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23158 ignored.
23159
23160 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23161 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23162 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23163 particular connection.
23164
23165 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23166 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23167 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23168 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23169
23170 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23171 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23172 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23173 .code
23174 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23175 .endd
23176 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23177 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23178
23179 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23180 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23181 value.
23182
23183
23184 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23185 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23186 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23187 authenticated as a client.
23188
23189
23190 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23191 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23192 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23193 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23194
23195
23196 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23197 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23198 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23199 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23200 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23201 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23202 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23203
23204
23205 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23206 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23207 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23208 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23209 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23210 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23211 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23212 option.
23213
23214
23215 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23216 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23217 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23218 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23219
23220
23221 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23222 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23223 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23224 cutoff times.
23225
23226 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23227 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23228 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23229 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23230 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23231 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23232
23233 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23234 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23235 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23236 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23237 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23238 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23239 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23240 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23241 to them.
23242
23243
23244 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23245 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23246 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23247 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23248 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23249
23250
23251 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23252 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23253 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23254 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23255 details.
23256
23257
23258 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23259 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23260 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23261 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23262 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23263 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23264 the dnssec request bit set.
23265 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23266
23267
23268
23269 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23270 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23271 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23272 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23273 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23274 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23275 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23276 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23277 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23278
23279
23280
23281 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23282 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23283 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23284 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23285 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23286 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23287 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23288
23289 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23290 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23291 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23292 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23293 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23294
23295
23296 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23297 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23298 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23299 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23300 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23301 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23302 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23303 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23304
23305 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23306 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23307 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23308 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23309 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23310 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23311
23312 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23313 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23314 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23315 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23316 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23317
23318 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23319 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23320 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23321 copy of the message is sent.
23322
23323 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23324 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23325 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23326 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23327 fails"& facility.
23328
23329
23330 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23331 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23332 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23333 zero.
23334
23335 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23336 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23337 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23338 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23339 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23340 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23341
23342 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23343 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23344 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23345 implementations of TLS.
23346
23347 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23348 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23349 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23350 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23351 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23352 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23353 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23354 option is:
23355 .code
23356 $primary_hostname
23357 .endd
23358 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23359 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23360 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23361 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23362 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23363 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23364 interface address, you could use this:
23365 .code
23366 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23367 {$primary_hostname}}
23368 .endd
23369 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23370 callouts.
23371
23372 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23373 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23374 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23375 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23376 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23377 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23378
23379 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23380 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23381 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23382 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23383
23384 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23385 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23386 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23387 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23388 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23389 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23390 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23391
23392 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23393 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23394 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23395 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23396 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23397 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23398 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23399 address are used.
23400
23401 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23402 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23403
23404
23405 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23406 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23407 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23408 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23409 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23410 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23411 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23412 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23413 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23414 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23415
23416
23417 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23418 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23419 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23420 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23421
23422
23423 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23424 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23425 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23426 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23427
23428 .new
23429 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23430 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23431 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23432 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23433 to any host that matches this list.
23434 .wen
23435
23436
23437 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23438 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23439 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23440 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23441 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23442 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23443 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23444 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23445
23446
23447 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23448 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23449 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23450 why it exists.
23451
23452
23453
23454 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23455 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23456 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23457 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23458 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23459 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23460 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23461 explanation of when this might be needed.
23462
23463
23464 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23465 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23466 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23467 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23468 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23469
23470
23471 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23472 .cindex "randomized host list"
23473 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23474 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23475 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23476 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23477 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23478 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23479 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23480 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23481
23482 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23483 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23484 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23485 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23486 .code
23487 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23488 .endd
23489 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23490 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23491 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23492
23493 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23494 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23495 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23496 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23497 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23498 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23499 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23500 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23501 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23502
23503
23504 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23505 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23506 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23507 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23508 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23509
23510 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23511 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23512 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23513 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23514 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23515
23516 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23517 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23518 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23519 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23520 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23521 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23522
23523 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23524 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23525 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23526 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23527 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23528 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23529 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23530
23531 .new
23532 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23533 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23534 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23535 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23536 for multi-recipient messages.
23537 The option can usually be left as default.
23538 .wen
23539
23540 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23541 .cindex "bind IP address"
23542 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23543 .vindex "&$host$&"
23544 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23545 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23546 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23547 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23548 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23549 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23550 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23551 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23552 unknown.
23553
23554 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23555 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23556 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23557 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23558 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23559 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23560 .code
23561 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23562 .endd
23563 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23564 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23565 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23566 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23567
23568
23569 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23570 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23571 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23572 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23573 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23574 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23575 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23576 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23577 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23578 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23579 unreachable hosts.
23580
23581
23582 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23583 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23584 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23585 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23586 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23587
23588 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23589 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23590 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23591 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23592 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23593 permits this.
23594
23595
23596 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23597 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23598 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23599 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23600 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23601 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23602 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23603 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23604
23605 .new
23606 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23607 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23608 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23609 .wen
23610
23611 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23612 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23613 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23614 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23615 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23616 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23617 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23618 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23619
23620 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23621 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23622 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23623 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23624 is deferred.
23625
23626
23627
23628 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23629 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23630 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23631 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23632 .vindex "&$port$&"
23633 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23634 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23635 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23636 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23637 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23638
23639 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23640 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23641 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23642 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23643
23644
23645 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23646 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23647 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23648 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23649 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23650 addresses is not affected.
23651
23652 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23653 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23654 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23655 Exim to use only the host name.
23656 .new
23657 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23658 .wen
23659
23660
23661 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23662 .cindex "serializing connections"
23663 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23664 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23665 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23666 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23667 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23668 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23669 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23670
23671 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23672 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23673 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23674 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23675 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23676 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23677
23678 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23679 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23680 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23681 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23682 are used for ETRN serialization.
23683
23684
23685 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23686 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23687 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23688 .cindex "size" "of message"
23689 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23690 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23691 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23692 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23693 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23694 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23695 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23696 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23697
23698 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23699 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23700
23701
23702 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23703 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23704 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23705 .vindex "&$host$&"
23706 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23707 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23708 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23709 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23710 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23711 details of TLS.
23712
23713 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23714 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23715 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23716 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23717 client.
23718
23719
23720 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23721 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23722 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23723 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23724 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23725
23726
23727 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23728 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23729 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23730 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23731 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23732 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23733 will fail.
23734
23735 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23736
23737
23738 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23739 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23740 .vindex "&$host$&"
23741 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23742 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23743 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23744 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23745 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23746 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23747 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23748 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23749
23750
23751 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23752 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23753 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23754 .vindex "&$host$&"
23755 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23756 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23757 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23758 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23759 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23760 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23761 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23762 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23763 ciphers is a preference order.
23764
23765
23766
23767 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23768 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23769 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23770 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23771 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23772 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23773 certificate and private key for the session.
23774
23775 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23776
23777 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23778 TLS extensions.
23779
23780
23781
23782
23783 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23784 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23785 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23786 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23787 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23788 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23789 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23790 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23791 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23792 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23793 in clear.
23794
23795
23796 .new
23797 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23798 .wen
23799 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23800 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23801 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23802 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23803 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23804 Note that unless the host is in this list
23805 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23806 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23807 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23808 certificate verification succeeds.
23809
23810
23811 .new
23812 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23813 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23814 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23815 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23816 while verifying the server certificate,
23817 checks will be included on the host name
23818 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23819 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23820 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23821
23822 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23823 .wen
23824
23825
23826 .new
23827 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23828 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23829 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23830 .vindex "&$host$&"
23831 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23832 The value of this option must be either the
23833 word "system"
23834 or the absolute path to
23835 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23836 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23837
23838 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23839 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23840 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23841 must be specified.
23842
23843 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23844 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23845 .wen
23846
23847 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23848 explicitly
23849 either by file or directory
23850 are added to those given by the system default location.
23851
23852 The values of &$host$& and
23853 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23854 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23855
23856 For back-compatibility,
23857 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23858 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23859 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23860
23861
23862 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23863 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23864 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23865 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23866 certificate verification must succeed.
23867 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23868 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23869 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23870
23871
23872
23873
23874 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23875 "SECTvalhosmax"
23876 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23877 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23878 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23879 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23880 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23881
23882
23883 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23884 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23885 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23886 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23887 retrying.
23888
23889 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23890 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23891 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23892
23893 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23894 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23895 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23896 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23897 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23898
23899 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23900 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23901 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23902 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23903 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23904 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23905 see below for an exception).
23906
23907 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23908 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23909 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23910 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23911 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23912
23913 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23914 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23915 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23916 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23917 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23918 reached their retry times.
23919
23920 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23921 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23922 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23923 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23924 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23925 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23926 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23927 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23928 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23929 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23930 reached.
23931
23932 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23933 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23934 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23935 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23936 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23937 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23938
23939 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23940 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23941 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23942 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23943 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23944 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23945
23946
23947
23948
23949
23950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23952
23953 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23954 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23955 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23956 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23957 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23958 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23959
23960 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23961 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23962 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23963 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23964 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23965 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23966 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23967
23968 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23969 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23970 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23971 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23972
23973
23974 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23975 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23976 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23977 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23978
23979 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23980 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23981 facility; you do not have to use it.
23982
23983 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23984 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23985 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23986 address to which it applies.
23987
23988 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23989 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23990 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23991 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23992 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23993 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23994 rules.
23995
23996 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23997 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23998 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23999 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24000
24001
24002 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24003 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24004 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24005 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24006 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24007 discouraged.
24008
24009 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24010 illustrated by these examples:
24011
24012 .ilist
24013 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24014 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24015 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24016 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24017 .next
24018 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24019 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24020 .endlist
24021
24022
24023
24024 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24025 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24026 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24027 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24028 message's processing.
24029
24030 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24031 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24032 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24033 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24034 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24035 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24036 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24037 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24038 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24039
24040 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24041 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24042 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24043 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24044 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24045 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24046 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24047 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24048 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24049 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24050
24051 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24052 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24053 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24054 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24055 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24056 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24057
24058 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24059 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24060 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24061
24062 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24063 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24064 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24065 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24066 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24067 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24068 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24069 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24070 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24071
24072 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24073 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24074 transport time.
24075
24076
24077
24078
24079 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24080 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24081 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24082 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24083 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24084 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24085 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24086 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24087 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24088 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24089 .code
24090 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24091 .endd
24092 might produce the output
24093 .code
24094 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24095 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24096 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24097 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24098 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24099 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24100 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24101 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24102 .endd
24103 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24104 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24105 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24106 set for a particular transport.
24107
24108
24109 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24110 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24111 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24112 rules in the form
24113 .display
24114 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24115 .endd
24116 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24117 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24118 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24119 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24120
24121 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24122 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24123 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24124 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24125 ignored.
24126
24127 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24128 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24129 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24130
24131 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24132 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24133 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24134 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24135 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24136 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24137 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24138
24139 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24140 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24141 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24142 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24143 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24144 .code
24145 *@* ${lookup ...
24146 .endd
24147 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24148 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24149
24150
24151 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24152 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24153 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24154 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24155 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24156 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24157 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24158 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24159 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24160
24161 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24162 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24163 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24164
24165 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24166 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24167 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24168 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24169 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24170 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24171 of pattern they are set as follows:
24172
24173 .ilist
24174 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24175 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24176 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24177 pattern
24178 .code
24179 *queen@*.fict.example
24180 .endd
24181 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24182 .code
24183 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24184 $1 = hearts-
24185 $2 = wonderland
24186 .endd
24187 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24188 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24189
24190 .next
24191 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24192 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24193 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24194 rewriting rule of the form
24195 .display
24196 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24197 .endd
24198 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24199 .code
24200 $1 = foo
24201 $2 = bar
24202 $3 = baz.example
24203 .endd
24204 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24205 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24206 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24207 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24208 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24209 .endlist
24210
24211
24212 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24213 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24214 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24215 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24216 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24217 .code
24218 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24219 .endd
24220 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24221 &'From:'& headers.
24222
24223 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24224 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24225 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24226 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24227 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24228 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24229 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24230 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24231 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24232 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24233 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24234 entry written to the panic log.
24235
24236
24237
24238 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24239 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24240
24241 .ilist
24242 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24243 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24244 .next
24245 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24246 .next
24247 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24248 .endlist
24249
24250 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24251 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24252
24253
24254
24255 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24256 "SECID154"
24257 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24258 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24259 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24260 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24261 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24262 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24263 .display
24264 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24265 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24266 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24267 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24268 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24269 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24270 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24271 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24272 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24273 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24274 .endd
24275 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24276 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24277 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24278
24279 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24280 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24281
24282
24283 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24284 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24285 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24286 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24287 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24288 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24289 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24290 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24291 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24292
24293 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24294 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24295 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24296 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24297 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24298 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24299 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24300 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24301
24302
24303 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24304 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24305 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24306 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24307
24308 .ilist
24309 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24310 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24311 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24312 .next
24313 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24314 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24315 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24316 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24317 .next
24318 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24319 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24320 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24321 .next
24322 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24323 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24324 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24325 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24326 .code
24327 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24328 .endd
24329 into
24330 .code
24331 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24332 .endd
24333 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24334 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24335 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24336 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24337 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24338 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24339 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24340 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24341 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24342
24343 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24344 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24345 .endlist
24346
24347
24348 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24349 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24350 .code
24351 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24352 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24353 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24354 .endd
24355 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24356 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24357 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24358 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24359 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24360 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24361 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24362 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24363
24364 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24365 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24366 .code
24367 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24368 .endd
24369 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24370 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24371
24372 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24373 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24374 messages that originate outside the local host:
24375 .code
24376 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24377 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24378 .endd
24379 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24380 space.
24381
24382 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24383 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24384 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24385 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24386 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24387 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24388 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24389 components. For example, the rule
24390 .code
24391 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24392 .endd
24393 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24394 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24395 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24396 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24397 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24398 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24399 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24400 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24401
24402
24403
24404
24405
24406 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24407 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24408
24409 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24410 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24411 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24412 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24413 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24414 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24415 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24416 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24417 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24418 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24419 address, domain and error.
24420
24421 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24422 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24423 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24424 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24425 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24426 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24427 log selector is set, the message
24428 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24429 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24430 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24431 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24432
24433 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24434 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24435 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24436 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24437 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24438 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24439 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24440 domain are maintained independently.
24441
24442 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24443 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24444 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24445 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24446 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24447 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24448 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24449 the local address is reached.
24450
24451 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24452 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24453 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24454 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24455 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24456
24457 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24458 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24459 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24460 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24461 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24462 messages that it should now be retaining.
24463
24464
24465
24466 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24467 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24468 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24469 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24470 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24471 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24472 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24473 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24474 message's sender, respectively.
24475
24476
24477 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24478 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24479 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24480 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24481 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24482 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24483 example,
24484 .code
24485 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24486 .endd
24487 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24488 whereas
24489 .code
24490 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24491 .endd
24492 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24493 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24494 part.
24495
24496 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24497 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24498 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24499 expressions work in address lists.
24500 .display
24501 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24502 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24503 .endd
24504
24505
24506 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24507 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24508 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24509 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24510 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24511 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24512 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24513 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24514 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24515
24516 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24517 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24518 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24519 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24520 local transports).
24521
24522 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24523 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24524 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24525 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24526 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24527 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24528 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24529 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24530 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24531 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24532 commands.
24533
24534
24535
24536 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24537 "SECID160"
24538 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24539 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24540 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24541 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24542 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24543 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24544 .code
24545 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24546 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24547 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24548 .endd
24549 and the retry rules are
24550 .code
24551 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24552 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24553 .endd
24554 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24555 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24556 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24557 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24558 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24559 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24560
24561 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24562 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24563 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24564 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24565
24566 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24567 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24568 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24569 .code
24570 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24571 .endd
24572 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24573 textual form of the IP address.
24574
24575 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24576 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24577 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24578 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24579
24580 .vlist
24581 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24582 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24583 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24584
24585 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24586 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24587 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24588
24589 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24590 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24591
24592 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24593 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24594 .endlist
24595
24596 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24597 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24598 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24599 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24600 retry rule of this form:
24601 .code
24602 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24603 .endd
24604 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24605 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24606
24607 .vlist
24608 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24609 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24610 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24611 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24612
24613 .new
24614 .vitem &%lookup%&
24615 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24616 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24617 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24618 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24619 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24620 .wen
24621
24622 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24623 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24624
24625 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24626 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24627
24628 .vitem &%refused%&
24629 A connection was refused.
24630
24631 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24632 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24633
24634 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24635 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24636
24637 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24638 A connection attempt timed out.
24639
24640 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24641 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24642 obtained from an MX record.
24643
24644 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24645 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24646 obtained from an MX record.
24647
24648 .vitem &%timeout%&
24649 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24650
24651 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24652 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24653 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24654 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24655
24656 .vitem &%quota%&
24657 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24658 transport.
24659
24660 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24661 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24662 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24663 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24664 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24665 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24666 for four days.
24667 .endlist
24668
24669 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24670 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24671 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24672 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24673 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24674 heuristic rules:
24675
24676 .ilist
24677 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24678 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24679 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24680 .next
24681 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24682 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24683 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24684 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24685 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24686 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24687 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24688 .next
24689 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24690 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24691 .endlist
24692
24693 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24694 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24695 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24696 error).
24697
24698
24699
24700 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24701 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24702 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24703 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24704 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24705 form:
24706 .display
24707 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24708 .endd
24709 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24710 .code
24711 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24712 .endd
24713 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24714 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24715 For example:
24716 .code
24717 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24718 .endd
24719 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24720 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24721 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24722 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24723 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24724
24725 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24726 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24727 .code
24728 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24729 .endd
24730 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24731 list is never matched.
24732
24733
24734
24735
24736
24737 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24738 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24739 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24740 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24741 .display
24742 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24743 .endd
24744 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24745 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24746 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24747 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24748 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24749
24750 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24751 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24752 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24753 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24754 The available algorithms are:
24755
24756 .ilist
24757 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24758 the interval.
24759 .next
24760 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24761 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24762 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24763 .next
24764 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24765 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24766 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24767 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24768 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24769 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24770 queue processing times.
24771 .endlist
24772
24773 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24774 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24775 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24776 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24777 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24778 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24779 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24780 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24781 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24782 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24783 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24784 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24785
24786 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24787 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24788 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24789 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24790 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24791 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24792 time.
24793
24794 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24795 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24796 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24797 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24798 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24799 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24800 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24801 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24802 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24803 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24804 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24805 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24806
24807 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24808 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24809 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24810 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24811 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24812 deliveries that have been deferred.
24813
24814
24815 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24816 Here are some example retry rules:
24817 .code
24818 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24819 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24820 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24821 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24822 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24823 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24824 .endd
24825 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24826 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24827 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24828 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24829 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24830 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24831 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24832 days.
24833
24834 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24835 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24836 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24837 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24838 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24839
24840 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24841 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24842 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24843 were not obtained from an MX record.
24844
24845 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24846 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24847 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24848 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24849 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24850
24851
24852
24853 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24854 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24855 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24856 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24857 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24858 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24859 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24860 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24861 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24862 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24863 failing for the first time.
24864
24865 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24866 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24867 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24868 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24869
24870 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24871 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24872 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24873
24874
24875
24876
24877 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24878 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24879 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24880 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24881 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24882 default retry rule:
24883 .code
24884 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24885 .endd
24886 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24887 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24888 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24889
24890 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24891 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24892 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24893 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24894 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24895
24896 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24897 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24898 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24899
24900 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24901 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24902 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24903 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24904 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24905 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24906 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24907 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24908
24909 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24910 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24911 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24912 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24913 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24914 notice.
24915
24916 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24917 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24918 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24919 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24920 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24921 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24922 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24923 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24924 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24925 true.
24926
24927 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24928 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24929 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24930 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24931 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24932 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24933 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24934 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24935 reached.
24936
24937 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24938 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24939 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24940 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24941 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24942 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24943 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24944 time out the address.
24945
24946 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24947 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24948 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24949 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24950 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24951 considered immediately.
24952 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24953 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24954
24955
24956
24957
24958
24959
24960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24962
24963 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24964 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24965 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24966 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24967 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24968 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24969 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24970 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24971 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24972 other.
24973
24974 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24975 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24976
24977 .ilist
24978 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24979 the client's EHLO command.
24980 .next
24981 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24982 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24983 .next
24984 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24985 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24986 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24987 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24988 with the AUTH command.
24989 .next
24990 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24991 .next
24992 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24993 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24994 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24995 connection.
24996 .next
24997 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24998 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24999 unauthenticated connection.
25000 .endlist
25001
25002 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25003 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25004 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25005 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25006 .display
25007 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25008 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25009 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25010 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25011 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25012 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25013 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25014 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25015 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25016 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25017 &`250 HELP`&
25018 .endd
25019 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25020 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25021 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25022 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25023 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25024 included by setting
25025 .code
25026 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25027 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25028 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25029 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25030 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25031 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25032 AUTH_SPA=yes
25033 AUTH_TLS=yes
25034 .endd
25035 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25036 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25037 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25038 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25039 work via a socket interface.
25040 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25041 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25042 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25043 supporting setting a server keytab.
25044 The sixth can be configured to support
25045 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25046 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25047 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25048 .new
25049 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25050 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25051 .wen
25052
25053 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25054 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25055 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25056 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25057 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25058 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25059 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25060
25061 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25062 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25063 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25064 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25065 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25066 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25067 .code
25068 cram:
25069 driver = cram_md5
25070 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25071 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25072 client_name = ph10
25073 client_secret = secret2
25074 .endd
25075 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25076 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25077
25078 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25079 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25080 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25081 in Exim.
25082
25083 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25084 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25085 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25086 authenticating data.
25087
25088 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25089 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25090 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25091 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25092 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25093 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25094 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25095 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25096 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25097 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25098 choose to honour.
25099
25100 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25101 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25102 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25103 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25104
25105
25106
25107 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25108 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25109 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25110
25111 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25112 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25113 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25114 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25115 encrypted by a setting such as:
25116 .code
25117 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25118 .endd
25119
25120
25121 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25122 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25123 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25124 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25125
25126
25127 .option driver authenticators string unset
25128 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25129 authenticators is to be used.
25130
25131
25132 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25133 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25134 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25135 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25136 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25137 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25138
25139
25140 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25141 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25142 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25143 mechanism is not advertised.
25144 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25145 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25146 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25147
25148
25149 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25150 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25151 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25152 for details.
25153
25154 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25155 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25156
25157 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25158 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25159 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25160 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25161 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25162 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25163 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25164 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25165 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25166 the error text.
25167
25168
25169 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25170 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25171 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25172 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25173 out the values of variables.
25174 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25175 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25176
25177
25178 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25179 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25180 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25181 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25182 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25183 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25184 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25185 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25186 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25187
25188
25189 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25190 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25191 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25192 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25193 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25194 remembered for later use.
25195 How it is used is described in the following section.
25196
25197
25198
25199
25200
25201 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25202 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25203 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25204 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25205 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25206 message:
25207
25208 .ilist
25209 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25210 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25211 .next
25212 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25213 .next
25214 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25215 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25216 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25217 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25218 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25219 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25220 given for the MAIL command.
25221 .next
25222 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25223 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25224 authenticated.
25225 .next
25226 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25227 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25228 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25229 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25230 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25231 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25232 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25233 message.
25234 .endlist
25235
25236
25237 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25238 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25239 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25240 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25241
25242 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25243 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25244 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25245 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25246 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25247 ACL is run.
25248
25249
25250
25251 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25252 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25253 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25254 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25255 conditions:
25256
25257 .ilist
25258 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25259 .next
25260 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25261 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25262 .endlist
25263
25264 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25265 the mechanisms are advertised.
25266
25267 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25268 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25269 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25270 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25271 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25272 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25273 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25274 .code
25275 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25276 .endd
25277 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25278
25279 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25280 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25281 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25282 such as:
25283 .code
25284 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25285 .endd
25286 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25287 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25288 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25289
25290 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25291 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25292 command. This is the case if
25293
25294 .ilist
25295 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25296 .next
25297 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25298 .next
25299 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25300 server authenticators.
25301 .endlist
25302
25303
25304 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25305 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25306 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25307
25308 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25309 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25310 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25311 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25312 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25313 rejected with a 504 error.
25314
25315 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25316 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25317 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25318 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25319 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25320 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25321 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25322 no successful authentication.
25323
25324
25325
25326
25327 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25328 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25329 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25330 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25331 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25332 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25333 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25334 script:
25335 .code
25336 use MIME::Base64;
25337 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25338 .endd
25339 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25340 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25341 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25342 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25343 command line to run this script on such data might be
25344 .code
25345 encode '\0user\0password'
25346 .endd
25347 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25348 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25349 whose code value is zero.
25350
25351 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25352 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25353 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25354 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25355
25356 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25357 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25358 example, a command such as
25359 .code
25360 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25361 .endd
25362 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25363
25364 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25365 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25366 .code
25367 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25368 .endd
25369 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25370 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25371 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25372 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25373
25374
25375
25376 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25377 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25378 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25379 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25380 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25381 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25382
25383 .ilist
25384 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25385 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25386 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25387 of the authenticator.
25388 .next
25389 .vindex "&$host$&"
25390 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25391 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25392 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25393 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25394 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25395 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25396 delivery to be deferred.
25397 .next
25398 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25399 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25400 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25401 usual way.
25402 .next
25403 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25404 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25405 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25406 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25407 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25408 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25409 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25410 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25411 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25412 .endlist
25413
25414 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25415 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25416 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25417 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25418 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25419 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25420 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25421 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25422 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25423 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25424 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25425 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25426 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25427
25428
25429
25430
25431
25432
25433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25435
25436 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25437 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25438 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25439 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25440 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25441 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25442 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25443 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25444 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25445 connections as you do for login accounts.
25446
25447 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25448 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25449 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25450
25451 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25452 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25453 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25454
25455 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25456 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25457 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25458 given.
25459
25460 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25461 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25462 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25463 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25464 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25465 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25466 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25467
25468 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25469 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25470 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25471 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25472 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25473 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25474 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25475
25476 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25477 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25478 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25479 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25480
25481 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25482 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25483 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25484
25485 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25486 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25487 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25488 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25489 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25490 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25491 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25492 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25493 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25494 string as the error text
25495
25496 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25497 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25498 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25499
25500
25501
25502 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25503 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25504 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25505 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25506 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25507 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25508 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25509 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25510
25511 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25512 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25513 configured as follows:
25514 .code
25515 fixed_plain:
25516 driver = plaintext
25517 public_name = PLAIN
25518 server_prompts = :
25519 server_condition = \
25520 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25521 server_set_id = $auth2
25522 .endd
25523 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25524 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25525 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25526 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25527
25528 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25529 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25530 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25531 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25532 .code
25533 250-AUTH PLAIN
25534 .endd
25535 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25536 .code
25537 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25538 .endd
25539 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25540 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25541 .code
25542 AUTH PLAIN
25543 .endd
25544 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25545 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25546
25547 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25548 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25549 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25550 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25551 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25552
25553 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25554 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25555 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25556
25557 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25558 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25559 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25560 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25561 This is an incorrect example:
25562 .code
25563 server_condition = \
25564 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25565 .endd
25566 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25567 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25568 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25569 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25570 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25571 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25572 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25573 .code
25574 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25575 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25576 .endd
25577 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25578 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25579 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25580 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25581 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25582
25583
25584 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25585 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25586 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25587 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25588 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25589 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25590 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25591 .code
25592 fixed_login:
25593 driver = plaintext
25594 public_name = LOGIN
25595 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25596 server_condition = \
25597 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25598 server_set_id = $auth1
25599 .endd
25600 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25601 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25602 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25603 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25604
25605 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25606 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25607 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25608 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25609 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25610 .code
25611 login:
25612 driver = plaintext
25613 public_name = LOGIN
25614 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25615 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25616 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25617 ldapauth{\
25618 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25619 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25620 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25621 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25622 .endd
25623 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25624 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25625 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25626 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25627 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25628 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25629 uninterpreted string.
25630
25631
25632 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25633 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25634 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25635 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25636 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25637 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25638
25639
25640
25641
25642 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25643 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25644 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25645
25646 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25647 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25648 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25649 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25650 usual.
25651
25652 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25653 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25654 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25655 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25656 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25657 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25658 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25659 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25660 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25661 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25662 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25663 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25664
25665 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25666 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25667
25668 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25669 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25670 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25671 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25672 the string.
25673
25674 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25675 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25676 .code
25677 fixed_plain:
25678 driver = plaintext
25679 public_name = PLAIN
25680 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25681 .endd
25682 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25683 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25684 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25685 .code
25686 fixed_login:
25687 driver = plaintext
25688 public_name = LOGIN
25689 client_send = : username : mysecret
25690 .endd
25691 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25692 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25693 prompts.
25694 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25695 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25696
25697
25698
25699
25700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25702
25703 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25704 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25705 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25706 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25707 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25708 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25709 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25710 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25711 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25712 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25713 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25714 available in plain text at either end.
25715
25716
25717 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25718 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25719 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25720 authenticator as a server:
25721
25722 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25723 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25724 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25725 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25726 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25727 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25728 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25729 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25730 returned to the client.
25731
25732 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25733 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25734 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25735 numeric variables for other things.
25736
25737 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25738 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25739 user name, authentication fails.
25740 .code
25741 fixed_cram:
25742 driver = cram_md5
25743 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25744 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25745 server_set_id = $auth1
25746 .endd
25747 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25748 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25749 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25750 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25751 .code
25752 lookup_cram:
25753 driver = cram_md5
25754 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25755 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25756 {$value}fail}
25757 server_set_id = $auth1
25758 .endd
25759 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25760 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25761
25762 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25763 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25764 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25765 realm, with:
25766 .code
25767 cyrusless_crammd5:
25768 driver = cram_md5
25769 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25770 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25771 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25772 server_set_id = $auth1
25773 .endd
25774
25775 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25776 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25777 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25778
25779
25780
25781 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25782 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25783 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25784
25785
25786 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25787 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25788 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25789
25790
25791 .vindex "&$host$&"
25792 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25793 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25794 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25795 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25796 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25797 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25798 send the message to the current server.
25799
25800 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25801 strings, is:
25802 .code
25803 fixed_cram:
25804 driver = cram_md5
25805 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25806 client_name = ph10
25807 client_secret = secret
25808 .endd
25809 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25810 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25811
25812
25813
25814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25815 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25816
25817 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25818 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25819 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25820 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25821 .cindex "Kerberos"
25822 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25823 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25824
25825 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25826 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25827 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25828 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25829 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25830
25831 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25832 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25833 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25834 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25835
25836 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25837 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25838 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25839 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25840 depending on the driver you are using.
25841
25842 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25843 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25844 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25845 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25846 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25847 implementation.
25848
25849 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25850 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25851 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25852 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25853 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25854 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25855 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25856 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25857
25858
25859 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25860 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25861 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25862 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25863 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25864 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25865 things.
25866
25867
25868 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25869 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25870 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25871 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25872
25873
25874 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25875 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25876 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25877 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25878 example:
25879 .code
25880 sasl:
25881 driver = cyrus_sasl
25882 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25883 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25884 server_set_id = $auth1
25885 .endd
25886
25887 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25888 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25889
25890
25891 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25892 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25893
25894
25895 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25896 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25897 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25898 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25899 .code
25900 sasl_cram_md5:
25901 driver = cyrus_sasl
25902 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25903 server_set_id = $auth1
25904
25905 sasl_plain:
25906 driver = cyrus_sasl
25907 public_name = PLAIN
25908 server_set_id = $auth2
25909 .endd
25910 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25911 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25912 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25913 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25914 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25915
25916
25917
25918
25919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25921 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25922 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25923 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25924 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25925 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25926 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25927 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25928 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25929 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25930
25931 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25932
25933 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25934 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25935 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25936 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25937 .code
25938 dovecot_plain:
25939 driver = dovecot
25940 public_name = PLAIN
25941 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25942 server_set_id = $auth1
25943
25944 dovecot_ntlm:
25945 driver = dovecot
25946 public_name = NTLM
25947 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25948 server_set_id = $auth1
25949 .endd
25950 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25951 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25952 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25953 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25954 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25955 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25956 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25957 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25958
25959
25960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25962 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25963 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25964 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25965 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25966 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25967 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25968 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25969 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25970 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25971 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25972 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25973 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25974 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25975 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25976 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25977 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25978 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25979 without code changes in Exim.
25980
25981
25982 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25983 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25984 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25985 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25986 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25987 context.
25988
25989 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25990 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25991 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25992
25993 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25994 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25995 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25996
25997 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25998 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25999 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26000
26001
26002 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26003 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26004 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26005 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26006
26007
26008 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26009 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26010 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26011 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26012 example:
26013 .code
26014 sasl:
26015 driver = gsasl
26016 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26017 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26018 server_set_id = $auth1
26019 .endd
26020
26021
26022 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26023 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26024 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26025 the password itself.
26026
26027 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26028 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26029 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26030 if available, else the empty string.
26031 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26032 else the empty string.
26033
26034 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26035
26036 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26037 option to be simply "true".
26038
26039
26040 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26041 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26042 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26043
26044
26045 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26046 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26047 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26048 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26049
26050
26051 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26052 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26053 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26054 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26055
26056
26057 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26058 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26059 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26060
26061
26062 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26063 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26064 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26065 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26066
26067 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26068 meanings for these variables:
26069
26070 .ilist
26071 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26072 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26073 .next
26074 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26075 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26076 .next
26077 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26078 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26079 .endlist
26080
26081 On a per-mechanism basis:
26082
26083 .ilist
26084 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26085 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26086 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26087 .next
26088 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26089 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26090 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26091 .next
26092 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26093 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26094 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26095 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26096 .endlist
26097
26098 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26099 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26100 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26101
26102
26103 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26104 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26105 .code
26106 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26107 driver = gsasl
26108 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26109 server_realm = imap.example.org
26110 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26111 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26112 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26113 server_condition = yes
26114 .endd
26115
26116
26117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26119
26120 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26121 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26122 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26123 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26124 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26125 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26126 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26127 reliably.
26128
26129 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26130 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26131 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26132 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26133
26134 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26135 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26136 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26137 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26138
26139 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26140 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26141 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26142 from the keytab.
26143
26144
26145 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26146 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26147 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26148 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26149
26150 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26151 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26152 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26153 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26154
26155 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26156 .ilist
26157 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26158 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26159 .next
26160 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26161 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26162 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26163 GSS Display Name.
26164 .endlist
26165
26166
26167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26169
26170 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26171 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26172 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26173 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26174 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26175 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26176 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26177 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26178 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26179 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26180 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26181 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26182 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26183 follows:
26184
26185 .ilist
26186 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26187 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26188 .next
26189 The server sends back a challenge.
26190 .next
26191 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26192 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26193 .endlist
26194
26195 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26196
26197
26198
26199 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26200 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26201 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26202
26203 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26204 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26205 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26206 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26207 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26208 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26209 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26210 for other things. For example:
26211 .code
26212 spa:
26213 driver = spa
26214 public_name = NTLM
26215 server_password = \
26216 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26217 .endd
26218 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26219 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26220
26221
26222
26223
26224
26225 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26226 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26227 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26228
26229
26230
26231 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26232 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26233
26234
26235 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26236 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26237
26238
26239 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26240 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26241 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26242 &'msn.com'&:
26243 .code
26244 msn:
26245 driver = spa
26246 public_name = MSN
26247 client_username = msn/msn_username
26248 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26249 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26250 .endd
26251 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26252 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26253
26254
26255
26256
26257
26258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26259 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26260
26261 .new
26262 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26263 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26264 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26265 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26266 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26267 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26268 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26269 authentication based on client certificates.
26270
26271 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26272 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26273 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26274 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26275 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26276 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26277
26278 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26279 for which it must have been requested via the
26280 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26281 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26282
26283 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26284 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26285 and can authenticate the connection.
26286 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26287
26288 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26289
26290
26291 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26292 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26293
26294 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26295 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26296 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26297 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26298 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26299 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26300
26301 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26302 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26303 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26304
26305 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26306
26307
26308 Example:
26309 .code
26310 tls:
26311 driver = tls
26312 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26313 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26314 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26315 {!= {0} \
26316 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26317 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26318 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26319 } } } }
26320 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26321 .endd
26322 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26323 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26324 .wen
26325
26326
26327 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26328 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26329 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26330
26331
26332
26333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26335
26336 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26337 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26338 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26339 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26340 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26341 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26342 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26343 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26344 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26345 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26346 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26347 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26348 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26349 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26350 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26351 certificates are used.
26352
26353 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26354 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26355 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26356 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26357 between them is encrypted.
26358
26359 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26360 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26361 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26362 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26363 encryption state.
26364
26365 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26366 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26367 in order to get TLS to work.
26368
26369
26370
26371 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26372 "SECID284"
26373 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26374 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26375 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26376 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26377 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26378 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26379 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26380 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26381 allocated for this purpose.
26382
26383 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26384 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26385 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26386 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26387 .code
26388 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26389 .endd
26390 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26391 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26392 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26393 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26394 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26395 defined elsewhere.
26396
26397 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26398 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26399
26400
26401
26402
26403
26404
26405 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26406 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26407 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26408 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26409 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26410 .code
26411 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26412 .endd
26413 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26414 .code
26415 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26416 .endd
26417 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26418 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26419
26420 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26421
26422 .ilist
26423 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26424 cannot be the path of a directory
26425 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26426 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26427 .next
26428 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26429 .next
26430 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26431 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26432 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26433 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26434 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26435 .next
26436 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26437 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26438 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26439 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26440 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26441 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26442 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26443 option).
26444 .next
26445 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26446 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26447 .next
26448 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26449 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26450 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26451 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26452 .next
26453 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26454 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26455 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26456 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26457 .endlist
26458
26459
26460 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26461 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26462 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26463 but not the chosen filename.
26464 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26465 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26466
26467 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26468 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26469 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26470 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26471 of bits requested.
26472 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26473 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26474 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26475 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26476 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26477 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26478 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26479
26480 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26481 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26482 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26483 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26484 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26485
26486 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26487 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26488 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26489 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26490 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26491 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26492
26493 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26494 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26495 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26496
26497 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26498 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26499 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26500 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26501 .code
26502 # ls
26503 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26504 # rm -f new-params
26505 # touch new-params
26506 # chown exim:exim new-params
26507 # chmod 0600 new-params
26508 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26509 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26510 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26511 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26512 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26513 # chmod 0400 new-params
26514 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26515 .endd
26516 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26517 stalling is removed.
26518
26519 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26520 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26521 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26522 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26523 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26524 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26525 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26526 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26527 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26528 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26529 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26530
26531 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26532 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26533 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26534 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26535
26536 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26537 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26538 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26539 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26540 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26541
26542
26543 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26544 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26545 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26546 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26547 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26548 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26549 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26550 directly to this function call.
26551 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26552 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26553 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26554 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26555
26556 .ilist
26557 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26558 .next
26559 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26560 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26561 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26562 SSL v3 algorithms.
26563 .next
26564 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26565 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26566 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26567 algorithms.
26568 .endlist
26569
26570 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26571 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26572 .ilist
26573 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26574 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26575 stated.
26576 .next
26577 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26578 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26579 .next
26580 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26581 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26582 .endlist
26583
26584 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26585 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26586 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26587 not be moved to the end of the list.
26588 .endlist
26589
26590 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26591 string:
26592 .code
26593 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26594 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26595 .endd
26596
26597 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26598 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26599 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26600 choice of clients used:
26601 .code
26602 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26603 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26604 {DEFAULT}\
26605 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26606 .endd
26607
26608
26609
26610 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26611 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26612 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26613 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26614 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26615 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26616 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26617 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26618 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26619 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26620 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26621 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26622
26623 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26624 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26625
26626 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26627 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26628 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26629 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26630 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26631 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26632
26633 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26634 "Priority strings". This is online as
26635 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26636 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26637 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26638 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26639 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26640
26641 For example:
26642 .code
26643 # Disable older versions of protocols
26644 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26645 .endd
26646
26647 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26648 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26649 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26650
26651 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26652 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26653 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26654 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26655 used:
26656 .code
26657 # GnuTLS variant
26658 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26659 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26660 {SECURE128}}
26661 .endd
26662
26663
26664 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26665 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26666 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26667 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26668 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26669 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26670 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26671 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26672
26673 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26674 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26675 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26676 with the error
26677 .code
26678 554 Security failure
26679 .endd
26680 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26681 rejected with a 554 error code.
26682
26683 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26684 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26685 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26686 without some further configuration at the server end.
26687
26688 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26689 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26690 .code
26691 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26692 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26693 .endd
26694 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26695 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26696 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26697 that goes with it. These files need to be
26698 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26699 always be given as full path names.
26700 The key must not be password-protected.
26701 They can be the same file if both the
26702 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26703 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26704 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26705 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26706 the server's certificate.
26707
26708 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26709 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26710 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26711
26712 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26713 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26714 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26715 transport.
26716
26717 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26718 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26719 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26720 .code
26721 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26722 .endd
26723 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26724 with the parameters contained in the file.
26725 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26726 available:
26727 .code
26728 tls_dhparam = none
26729 .endd
26730 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26731 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26732 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26733 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26734
26735 See the command
26736 .code
26737 openssl dhparam
26738 .endd
26739 for a way of generating file data.
26740
26741 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26742 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26743 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26744 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26745 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26746
26747 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26748 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26749 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26750 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26751 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26752 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26753 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26754 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26755 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26756
26757 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26758 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26759 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26760 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26761 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26762 documentation for more details.
26763
26764 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26765 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26766
26767
26768 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26769 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26770 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26771 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26772 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26773 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26774 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26775 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26776 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26777 expected certificates.
26778 .new
26779 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26780 .wen
26781 an explicit file or,
26782 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26783 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26784
26785 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26786 directory is used
26787 (OpenSSL only),
26788 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26789 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26790 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26791 .code
26792 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26793 .endd
26794 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26795
26796 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26797 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26798 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26799 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26800 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26801 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26802 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26803 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26804 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26805 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26806
26807 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26808 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26809 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26810 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26811
26812 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26813 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26814 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26815 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26816 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26817 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26818
26819
26820 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26821 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26822 .cindex "revocation list"
26823 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26824 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26825 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26826 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26827 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26828 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26829 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26830 CRL in PEM format.
26831 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26832 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26833
26834 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26835 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26836 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26837 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26838 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26839 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26840
26841 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26842 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26843 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26844 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26845
26846 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26847 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26848 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26849 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26850 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26851 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26852 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26853 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26854
26855 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26856 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26857 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26858
26859 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26860 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26861 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26862 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26863 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26864
26865 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26866 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26867 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26868 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26869 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26870 next connection.
26871
26872 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26873 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26874 ignored.
26875
26876 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26877 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26878 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26879 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26880 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26881 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26882
26883 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26884 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26885
26886 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26887
26888 .code
26889 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26890 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26891 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26892
26893 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26894 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26895 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26896 .endd
26897
26898
26899
26900
26901 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26902 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26903 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26904 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26905 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26906 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26907 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26908 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26909 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26910
26911 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26912 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26913 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26914 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26915 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26916
26917 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26918 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26919 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26920 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26921 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26922 usual way.
26923
26924 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26925 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26926 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26927 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26928 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26929 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26930 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26931 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26932 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26933 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26934 unencrypted.
26935
26936 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26937 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26938 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26939 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26940
26941 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26942 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26943 .new
26944 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26945 .wen
26946 a file or,
26947 depending on library version, a directory,
26948 must name a file or,
26949 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26950 The client verifies the server's certificate
26951 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26952 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26953 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26954 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26955
26956 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26957 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26958 or need not succeed respectively.
26959
26960 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26961 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26962 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26963 value is empty.
26964 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26965 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26966 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26967 otherwise.
26968
26969 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26970 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26971 for OCSP to be relevant.
26972
26973 If
26974 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26975 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26976 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26977 alternative hosts, if any.
26978
26979 &*Note*&:
26980 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26981 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26982 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26983 client.
26984
26985 .vindex "&$host$&"
26986 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26987 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26988 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26989 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26990 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26991
26992 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26993 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26994 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26995 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26996 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26997 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26998 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26999 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27000 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27001 outgoing connection.
27002
27003
27004
27005 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27006 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27007 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27008 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27009 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27010 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27011 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27012 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27013 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27014 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27015 for this session.
27016
27017 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27018 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27019 address.
27020
27021 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27022 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27023 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27024 be of limited use in that environment.
27025
27026 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27027 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27028 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27029 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27030 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27031
27032 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27033 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27034 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27035 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27036 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27037
27038 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27039 received from a client.
27040 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27041
27042 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27043 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27044 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27045
27046 .ilist
27047 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27048 &%tls_certificate%&
27049 .next
27050 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27051 &%tls_crl%&
27052 .next
27053 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27054 &%tls_privatekey%&
27055 .next
27056 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27057 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27058 .next
27059 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27060 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27061 .endlist
27062
27063 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27064 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27065 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27066 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27067
27068 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27069 are re-expanded.
27070
27071 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27072 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27073 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27074 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27075
27076 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27077 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27078 built, then you have SNI support).
27079
27080
27081
27082 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27083 "SECTmulmessam"
27084 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27085 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27086 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27087 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27088 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27089 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27090 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27091 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27092 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27093 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27094 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27095
27096 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27097 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27098 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27099 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27100 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27101 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27102 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27103 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27104 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27105
27106 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27107 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27108 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27109 information is recorded.
27110
27111 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27112 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27113 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27114
27115
27116
27117
27118 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27119 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27120 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27121 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27122 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27123 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27124 to Apache, currently at
27125 .display
27126 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27127 .endd
27128 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27129 links to further files.
27130 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27131 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27132 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27133 .display
27134 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27135 .endd
27136
27137
27138 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27139 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27140 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27141 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27142 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27143 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27144 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27145 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27146 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27147 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27148 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27149 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27150 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27151
27152 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27153 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27154 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27155 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27156
27157
27158
27159 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27160 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27161 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27162 with OpenSSL, like this:
27163 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27164 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27165 .code
27166 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27167 -days 9999 -nodes
27168 .endd
27169 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27170 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27171 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27172 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27173 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27174 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27175 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27176
27177 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27178 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27179 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27180 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27181 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27182 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27183 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27184 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27185 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27186 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27187 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27188 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27189 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27190 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27191 be a sensible resolution).
27192
27193 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27194 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27195 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27196
27197 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27198 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27199 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27200 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27201 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27202 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27203
27204 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27205 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27206 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27207 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27208 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27209 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27210
27211
27212
27213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27215
27216 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27217 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27218 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27219 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27220 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27221 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27222 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27223 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27224 one very small ACL:
27225 .code
27226 begin acl
27227 small_acl:
27228 accept hosts = one.host.only
27229 .endd
27230 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27231 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27232
27233 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27234 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27235 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27236 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27237 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27238 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27239 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27240 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27241
27242
27243 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27244 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27245 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27246 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27247 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27248
27249
27250
27251 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27252 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27253 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27254 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27255 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27256 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27257 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27258 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27259 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27260 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27261 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27262 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27263 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27264 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27265 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27266 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27267 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27268 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27269 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27270 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27271
27272 .table2 140pt
27273 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27274 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27275 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27276 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27277 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27278 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27279 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27280 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27281 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27282 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27283 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27284 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27285 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27286 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27287 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27288 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27289 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27290 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27291 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27292 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27293 .endtable
27294
27295 For example, if you set
27296 .code
27297 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27298 .endd
27299 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27300 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27301 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27302 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27303 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27304 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27305 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27306
27307
27308 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27309 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27310 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27311 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27312 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27313 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27314 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27315 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27316 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27317 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27318 in any of these ACLs.
27319
27320 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27321 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27322 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27323 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27324 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27325 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27326 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27327 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27328 .code
27329 control = suppress_local_fixups
27330 .endd
27331 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27332 run, it is too late.
27333
27334 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27335 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27336
27337 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27338 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27339 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27340
27341
27342 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27343 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27344 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27345 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27346 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27347 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27348 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27349 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27350 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27351
27352
27353 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27354 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27355 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27356 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27357 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27358 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27359 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27360 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27361 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27362
27363 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27364 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27365 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27366 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27367 an EHLO response.
27368
27369
27370 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27371 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27372 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27373 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27374 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27375 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27376 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27377 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27378 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27379 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27380
27381 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27382 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27383 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27384 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27385 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27386 associated with the DATA command.
27387
27388 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27389 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27390 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27391 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27392 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27393 your resources.
27394
27395 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27396 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27397 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27398 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27399
27400 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27401 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27402 enabled (which is the default).
27403
27404 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27405 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27406 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27407
27408 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27409
27410 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27411
27412
27413 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27414 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27415 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27416
27417 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27418
27419
27420 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27421 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27422 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27423 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27424 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27425 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27426 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27427 has been accepted.
27428
27429 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27430 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27431 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27432 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27433 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27434 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27435 for some or all recipients.
27436
27437 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27438 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27439 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27440 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27441 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27442 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27443 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27444
27445 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27446 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27447
27448 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27449 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27450 the feature was not requested by the client.
27451
27452 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27453 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27454 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27455 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27456 does not in fact control any access.
27457 .new
27458 For this reason, it may only accept
27459 or warn as its final result.
27460 .wen
27461
27462 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27463 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27464 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27465 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27466
27467 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27468 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27469
27470 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27471 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27472 response to QUIT.
27473
27474 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27475 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27476 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27477 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27478 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27479
27480
27481 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27482 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27483 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27484 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27485 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27486 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27487 situation even worse.
27488
27489 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27490 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27491 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27492 and &%warn%&.
27493
27494 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27495 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27496 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27497 connection. The possible values are:
27498 .table2
27499 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27500 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27501 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27502 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27503 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27504 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27505 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27506 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27507 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27508 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27509 .endtable
27510 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27511 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27512 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27513 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27514 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27515 used.
27516
27517
27518 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27519 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27520 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27521 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27522 .code
27523 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27524 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27525 .endd
27526 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27527 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27528 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27529 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27530 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27531
27532 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27533 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27534 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27535
27536 .ilist
27537 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27538 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27539 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27540 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27541 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27542 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27543 .code
27544 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27545 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27546 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27547 .endd
27548 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27549 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27550 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27551 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27552 .next
27553 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27554 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27555 matches the string.
27556 .next
27557 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27558 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27559 want to have something like
27560 .code
27561 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27562 .endd
27563 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27564 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27565 .endlist
27566
27567
27568
27569
27570 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27571 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27572 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27573 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27574 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27575 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27576 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27577 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27578 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27579
27580 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27581 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27582 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27583
27584
27585 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27586 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27587 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27588 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27589
27590 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27591 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27592 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27593 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27594 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27595 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27596 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27597
27598
27599 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27600 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27601 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27602
27603
27604
27605 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27606 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27607 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27608 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27609 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27610 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27611
27612 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27613 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27614 used to accept or reject anything.
27615
27616 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27617 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27618 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27619 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27620
27621 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27622 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27623 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27624 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27625 configuration file.
27626
27627
27628
27629
27630 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27631 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27632 .vindex &$domain$&
27633 .vindex &$local_part$&
27634 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27635 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27636 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27637 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27638 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27639 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27640 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27641 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27642 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27643
27644 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27645 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27646 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27647 how it is used.
27648
27649 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27650 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27651 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27652 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27653 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27654 received).
27655
27656 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27657 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27658 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27659 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27660 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27661 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27662 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27663 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27664
27665
27666
27667
27668
27669 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27670 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27671 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27672 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27673 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27674 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27675 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27676 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27677 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27678 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27679 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27680 unencrypted connections.
27681 .code
27682 acl_check_auth:
27683 accept encrypted = *
27684 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27685 {CRAM-MD5}}
27686 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27687 .endd
27688 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27689 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27690 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27691 option to do this.)
27692
27693
27694
27695 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27696 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27697 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27698 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27699 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27700 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27701 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27702
27703 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27704 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27705 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27706 example:
27707 .code
27708 deny dnslists = list1.example
27709 dnslists = list2.example
27710 .endd
27711 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27712 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27713 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27714 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27715 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27716
27717
27718 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27719 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27720
27721 .ilist
27722 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27723 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27724 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27725 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27726 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27727 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27728 check a RCPT command:
27729 .code
27730 accept domains = +local_domains
27731 endpass
27732 verify = recipient
27733 .endd
27734 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27735 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27736 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27737 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27738 &%endpass%&.
27739
27740 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27741 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27742 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27743 configuration.
27744
27745 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27746 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27747 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27748 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27749 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27750 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27751 .display
27752 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27753 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27754 .endd
27755 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27756 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27757 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27758
27759 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27760 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27761 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27762 of &%endpass%&.
27763
27764
27765 .next
27766 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27767 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27768 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27769 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27770 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27771 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27772 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27773
27774
27775 .next
27776 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27777 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27778 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27779 example,
27780 .code
27781 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27782 .endd
27783 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27784
27785
27786 .next
27787 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27788 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27789 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27790 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27791 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27792 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27793 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27794 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27795 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27796
27797 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27798 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27799 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27800
27801
27802 .next
27803 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27804 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27805 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27806 .code
27807 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27808 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27809 .endd
27810 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27811 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27812
27813 .next
27814 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27815 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27816 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27817 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27818 .code
27819 require message = Sender did not verify
27820 verify = sender
27821 .endd
27822 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27823 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27824 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27825 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27826
27827 .next
27828 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27829 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27830 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27831 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27832 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27833 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27834 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27835
27836 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27837 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27838 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27839 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27840 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27841
27842 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27843 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27844 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27845 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27846 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27847 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27848 onwards.
27849
27850
27851 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27852 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27853 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27854 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27855 .code
27856 warn !verify = sender
27857 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27858 .endd
27859 .endlist
27860
27861 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27862
27863 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27864 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27865 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27866 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27867 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27868
27869
27870
27871 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27872 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27873 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27874 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27875 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27876 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27877 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27878 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27879 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27880 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27881 .ilist
27882 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27883 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27884 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27885 on the same SMTP connection.
27886 .next
27887 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27888 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27889 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27890 .endlist
27891
27892 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27893 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27894 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27895 .code
27896 accept hosts = whatever
27897 set acl_m4 = some value
27898 accept authenticated = *
27899 set acl_c_auth = yes
27900 .endd
27901 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27902 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27903 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27904
27905 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27906 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27907 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27908 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27909 error is generated.
27910
27911 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27912 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27913
27914
27915 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27916 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27917 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27918 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27919 .code
27920 deny domains = *.dom.example
27921 !verify = recipient
27922 .endd
27923 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27924 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27925 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27926 two statements are equivalent:
27927 .code
27928 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27929 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27930 .endd
27931 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27932 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27933
27934 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27935 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27936 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27937 .code
27938 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27939 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27940 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27941 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27942 .endd
27943 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27944 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27945 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27946 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27947 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27948 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27949 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27950
27951 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27952 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27953 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27954 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27955 message is handled.
27956
27957 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27958 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27959 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27960 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27961 .code
27962 require message = Can't verify sender
27963 verify = sender
27964 message = Can't verify recipient
27965 verify = recipient
27966 message = This message cannot be used
27967 .endd
27968 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27969 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27970 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27971 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27972 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27973 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27974
27975 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27976 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27977 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27978 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27979 .code
27980 deny hosts = ...
27981 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27982 message = Invalid sender from client host
27983 .endd
27984 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27985 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27986
27987
27988
27989 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27990 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27991 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27992
27993 .vlist
27994 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27995 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27996 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27997 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27998
27999 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28000 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28001 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28002 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28003 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28004 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28005 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28006 write rather ugly lines like this:
28007 .display
28008 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28009 .endd
28010 Instead, all you need is
28011 .display
28012 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28013 .endd
28014
28015 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28016 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28017 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28018 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28019 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28020 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28021 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28022 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28023
28024 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28025 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28026 in several different ways. For example:
28027
28028 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28029 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28030 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28031 . ==== way.
28032
28033 .ilist
28034 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28035 .code
28036 accept ...some conditions
28037 control = queue_only
28038 .endd
28039 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28040 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28041
28042 .next
28043 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28044 .code
28045 accept ...some conditions...
28046 control = queue_only
28047 ...some more conditions...
28048 .endd
28049 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28050 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28051 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28052 to be relevant.
28053
28054 .next
28055 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28056 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28057 example:
28058 .code
28059 warn ...some conditions...
28060 control = freeze
28061 accept ...
28062 .endd
28063 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28064 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28065 log entry.
28066
28067 .next
28068 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28069 &%require%& verb. For example:
28070 .code
28071 require control = no_multiline_responses
28072 .endd
28073 .endlist
28074
28075 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28076 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28077 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28078 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28079 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28080 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28081 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28082 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28083 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28084
28085 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28086 example:
28087 .code
28088 deny ...some conditions...
28089 delay = 30s
28090 .endd
28091 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28092 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28093 .code
28094 deny delay = 30s
28095 ...some conditions...
28096 .endd
28097 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28098 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28099 .code
28100 warn ...some conditions...
28101 delay = 2m
28102 control = freeze
28103 accept ...
28104 .endd
28105
28106 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28107 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28108 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28109 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28110 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28111 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28112 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28113
28114
28115 .vitem &*endpass*&
28116 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28117 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28118 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28119 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28120 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28121 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28122 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28123
28124
28125 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28126 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28127 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28128 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28129 .code
28130 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28131 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28132 .endd
28133 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28134 example:
28135 .display
28136 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28137 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28138 .endd
28139 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28140 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28141 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28142 message.
28143
28144 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28145 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28146 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28147 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28148 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28149 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28150 ignored.
28151
28152 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28153 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28154 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28155 error message.
28156
28157 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28158 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28159 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28160 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28161 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28162 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28163
28164 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28165 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28166 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28167 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28168 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28169 logging rejections.
28170
28171
28172 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28173 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28174 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28175 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28176 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28177 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28178 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28179 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28180 .display
28181 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28182 &` log_reject_target =`&
28183 .endd
28184 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28185 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28186 current ACL.
28187
28188
28189 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28190 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28191 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28192 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28193 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28194 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28195 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28196 ACLs. For example:
28197 .display
28198 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28199 &` control = freeze`&
28200 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28201 .endd
28202 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28203 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28204 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28205 example:
28206 .code
28207 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28208 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28209 .endd
28210
28211
28212 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28213 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28214 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28215 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28216 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28217 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28218 &%accept%& for details.)
28219
28220 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28221 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28222 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28223 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28224 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28225 .code
28226 require message = Host not recognized
28227 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28228 .endd
28229 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28230 processed.)
28231
28232 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28233 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28234 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28235 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28236 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28237 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28238 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28239 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28240 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28241 EHLO options.
28242
28243 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28244 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28245 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28246 .code
28247 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28248 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28249 .endd
28250 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28251 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28252 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28253 2&'xx'&.
28254
28255 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28256 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28257
28258 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28259 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28260 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28261 response.
28262
28263 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28264 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28265 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28266
28267 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28268 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28269 However, the original message is available in the variable
28270 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28271 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28272 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28273 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28274
28275 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28276 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28277 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28278 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28279 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28280 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28281 effect.
28282
28283
28284 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28285 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28286 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28287 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28288
28289
28290 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28291 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28292 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28293 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28294
28295
28296 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28297 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28298 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28299 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28300 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28301 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28302 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28303 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28304 when:
28305 .code
28306 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28307 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28308 .endd
28309 .endlist
28310
28311
28312
28313
28314 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28315 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28316 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28317
28318 .vlist
28319 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28320 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28321 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28322 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28323 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28324 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28325 not work without it. For example:
28326 .code
28327 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28328 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28329 .endd
28330 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28331 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28332 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28333 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28334 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28335
28336
28337 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28338 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28339 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28340 .cindex "case of local parts"
28341 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28342 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28343 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28344 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28345 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28346 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28347 is encountered.
28348
28349 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28350 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28351 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28352 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28353 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28354
28355 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28356 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28357 spam score:
28358 .code
28359 warn control = caseful_local_part
28360 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28361 $acl_m4 + \
28362 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28363 }
28364 control = caselower_local_part
28365 .endd
28366 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28367 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28368
28369
28370 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28371 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28372 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28373 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28374
28375 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28376 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28377 .new
28378 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28379 is used for all recipients of the message,
28380 .wen
28381 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28382 and data is copied from one to the other.
28383
28384 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28385 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28386 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28387 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28388 .new
28389 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28390 .wen
28391 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28392
28393 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28394 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28395 Note also that headers cannot be
28396 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28397 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28398
28399 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28400 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28401 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28402 .new
28403 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28404 .wen
28405
28406 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28407 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28408 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28409 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28410 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28411 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28412
28413 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28414 (possibly faked)
28415 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28416
28417
28418 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28419 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28420 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28421 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28422 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28423 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28424 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28425 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28426 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28427 contexts):
28428 .code
28429 control = debug
28430 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28431 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28432 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28433 .endd
28434
28435
28436 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28437 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28438 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28439 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28440 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28441
28442
28443 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28444 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28445 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28446 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28447 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28448 strings or to numeric value.
28449 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28450 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28451 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28452
28453 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28454 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28455 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28456 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28457 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28458
28459
28460 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28461 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28462 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28463 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28464 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28465 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28466 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28467 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28468
28469 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28470 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28471 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28472 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28473 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28474 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28475 work with.
28476
28477
28478 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28479 .cindex "fake defer"
28480 .cindex "defer, fake"
28481 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28482 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28483 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28484 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28485 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28486
28487 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28488 .cindex "fake rejection"
28489 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28490 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28491 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28492 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28493 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28494 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28495 the same SMTP connection.
28496
28497 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28498 message is supplied, the following is used:
28499 .code
28500 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28501 550-kept for evaluation.
28502 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28503 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28504 .endd
28505 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28506
28507 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28508 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28509 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28510 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28511 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28512 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28513 SMTP connection.
28514
28515 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28516 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28517 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28518 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28519
28520 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28521 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28522 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28523 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28524 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28525 disables such output flushing.
28526
28527 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28528 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28529 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28530 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28531 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28532 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28533
28534 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28535 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28536 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28537 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28538 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28539 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28540 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28541 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28542 to be useful in production.
28543
28544 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28545 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28546 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28547 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28548 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28549
28550 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28551 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28552 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28553 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28554 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28555 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28556
28557 .ilist
28558 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28559 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28560 verification failed"&) is sent.
28561 .next
28562 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28563 line is output.
28564 .endlist
28565
28566 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28567 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28568
28569 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28570 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28571 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28572 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28573 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28574 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28575 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28576
28577 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28578 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28579 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28580 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28581 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28582 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28583 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28584 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28585 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28586 same SMTP connection.
28587
28588 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28589 .cindex "message" "submission"
28590 .cindex "submission mode"
28591 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28592 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28593 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28594 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28595 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28596 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28597 late (the message has already been created).
28598
28599 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28600 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28601 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28602 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28603 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28604
28605 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28606 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28607 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28608 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28609 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28610
28611 .ilist
28612 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28613 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28614 .next
28615 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28616 .next
28617 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28618 .endlist ilist
28619
28620 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28621 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28622 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28623 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28624 data is read.
28625
28626 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28627 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28628 .endlist vlist
28629
28630
28631 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28632 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28633
28634 .ilist
28635 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28636 .next
28637 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28638 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28639 .next
28640 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28641 .next
28642 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28643 .endlist
28644
28645
28646
28647 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28648 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28649 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28650 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28651 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28652 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28653 .code
28654 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28655 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28656 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28657 .endd
28658 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28659 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28660 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28661 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28662 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28663 RCPT ACL).
28664
28665 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28666 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28667
28668 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28669 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28670 contains one or more newlines that
28671 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28672 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28673 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28674
28675 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28676 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28677 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28678 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28679 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28680 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28681 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28682 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28683 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28684 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28685 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28686
28687 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28688 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28689 of message headers
28690 until they are added to the
28691 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28692 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28693 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28694 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28695 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28696 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28697 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28698
28699 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28700
28701 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28702 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28703 .display
28704 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28705 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28706
28707 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28708 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28709 .endd
28710 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28711 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28712 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28713 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28714 honoured.
28715
28716 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28717 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28718 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28719 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28720 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28721 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28722 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28723 specifications.
28724
28725 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28726 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28727 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28728 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28729 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28730
28731 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28732 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28733 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28734 to be a header name first.) For example:
28735 .code
28736 warn add_header = \
28737 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28738 .endd
28739 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28740 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28741 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28742 up in reverse order.
28743
28744 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28745 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28746 system filter or in a router or transport.
28747
28748
28749
28750 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28751 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28752 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28753 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28754 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28755 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28756 .code
28757 warn message = Remove internal headers
28758 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28759 .endd
28760 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28761 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28762 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28763 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28764 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28765 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28766
28767 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28768 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28769
28770 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28771 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28772 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28773 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28774 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28775 .code
28776 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28777 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28778 warn message = Remove internal headers
28779 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28780 .endd
28781 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28782 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28783 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28784 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28785 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28786 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28787 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28788 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28789 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28790 would have been removed.
28791
28792 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28793 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28794 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28795 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28796 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28797 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28798 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28799 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28800 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28801
28802 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28803 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28804 .display
28805 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28806 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28807
28808 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28809 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28810 .endd
28811 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28812 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28813 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28814 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28815 are honoured.
28816
28817 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28818 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28819 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28820
28821
28822
28823
28824 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28825 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28826 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28827 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28828 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28829 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28830
28831 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28832 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28833 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28834 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28835 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28836 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28837 The conditions are as follows:
28838
28839
28840 .vlist
28841 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28842 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28843 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28844 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28845 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28846 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28847 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28848 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28849 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28850 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28851 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28852 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28853
28854 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28855 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28856 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28857 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28858 The name and values are expanded separately.
28859 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28860 will act as argument separators.
28861
28862 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28863 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28864 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28865 conditions are tested.
28866
28867 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28868 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28869 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28870 for different local users or different local domains.
28871
28872 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28873 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28874 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28875 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28876 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28877 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28878 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28879 .code
28880 authenticated = *
28881 .endd
28882
28883 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28884 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28885 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28886 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28887 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28888 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28889 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28890 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28891 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28892 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28893 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28894 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28895 negative.
28896
28897 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28898 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28899 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28900 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28901 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28902 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28903 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28904 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28905
28906 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28907 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28908 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28909 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28910 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28911
28912 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28913 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28914 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28915 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28916 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28917 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28918 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28919 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28920 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28921 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28922
28923 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28924 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28925 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28926 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28927 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28928 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28929 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28930 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28931 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28932 &%domains%& test.
28933
28934 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28935 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28936
28937
28938 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28939 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28940 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28941 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28942 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28943 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28944 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28945 .code
28946 encrypted = *
28947 .endd
28948
28949
28950 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28951 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28952 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28953 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28954 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28955 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28956 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28957 .code
28958 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28959 .endd
28960 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28961 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28962 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28963
28964 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28965 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28966 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28967 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28968 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28969 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28970
28971 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28972 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28973 .code
28974 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28975 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28976 .endd
28977 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28978 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28979 statement can then check the IP address.
28980
28981 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28982 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28983 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28984 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28985 .code
28986 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28987 message = $host_data
28988 .endd
28989 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28990
28991 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28992 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28993 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28994 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28995 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28996 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28997 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28998 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28999 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29000 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29001
29002 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29003 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29004 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29005 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29006 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29007 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29008 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29009
29010 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29011 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29012 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29013 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29014 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29015 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29016 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29017 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29018
29019 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29020 .cindex "rate limiting"
29021 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29022 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29023
29024 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29025 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29026 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29027 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29028 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29029 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29030
29031 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29032 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29033 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29034 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29035 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29036 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29037 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29038
29039 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29040 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29041 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29042 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29043 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29044 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29045 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29046 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29047 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29048 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29049 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29050 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29051 influence the sender checking.
29052
29053 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29054 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29055
29056 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29057 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29058 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29059 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29060 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29061 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29062 .code
29063 senders = :
29064 .endd
29065 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29066 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29067
29068 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29069 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29070 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29071 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29072 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29073 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29074
29075 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29076 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29077 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29078 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29079 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29080 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29081 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29082 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29083 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29084 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29085
29086 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29087 .cindex "CSA verification"
29088 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29089 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29090 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29091
29092 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29093 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29094 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29095 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29096 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29097 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29098 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29099 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29100 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29101 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29102
29103 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29104 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29105 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29106
29107 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29108 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29109 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29110 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29111 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29112 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29113 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29114 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29115 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29116 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29117 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29118 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29119 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29120 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29121 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29122
29123 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29124 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29125 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29126 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29127 .code
29128 deny senders = :
29129 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29130 !verify = header_sender
29131 .endd
29132
29133 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29134 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29135 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29136 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29137 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29138 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29139 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29140 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29141 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29142 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29143 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29144 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29145 appropriate.
29146
29147 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29148 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29149 .code
29150 To: @
29151 .endd
29152 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29153 common as they used to be.
29154
29155 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29156 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29157 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29158 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29159 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29160 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29161 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29162 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29163 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29164 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29165 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29166 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29167 independently of this condition.
29168
29169 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29170 option), this condition is always true.
29171
29172
29173 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29174 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29175 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29176 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29177 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29178 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29179 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29180 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29181 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29182
29183 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29184 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29185
29186
29187 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29188 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29189 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29190 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29191 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29192 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29193 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29194 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29195 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29196 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29197 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29198 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29199 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29200 value for the child address.
29201
29202 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29203 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29204 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29205 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29206 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29207 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29208 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29209 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29210 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29211 original IP address.
29212
29213 .new
29214 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29215 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29216 .wen
29217
29218 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29219 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29220
29221 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29222 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29223 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29224 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29225 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29226 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29227 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29228 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29229 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29230
29231 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29232 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29233 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29234 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29235 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29236 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29237 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29238
29239 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29240 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29241 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29242
29243 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29244 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29245 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29246 verified as a sender.
29247 .endlist
29248
29249
29250
29251 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29252 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29253 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29254 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29255 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29256 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29257 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29258 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29259 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29260 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29261 .code
29262 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29263 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29264 .endd
29265 the following records are looked up:
29266 .code
29267 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29268 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29269 .endd
29270 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29271 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29272 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29273 use two separate conditions:
29274 .code
29275 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29276 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29277 .endd
29278 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29279 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29280 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29281 processed.
29282
29283 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29284 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29285 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29286 following special items in the list:
29287 .display
29288 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29289 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29290 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29291 .endd
29292 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29293 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29294 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29295 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29296 .code
29297 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29298 .endd
29299 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29300 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29301 .code
29302 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29303 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29304 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29305 .endd
29306 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
29307 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29308 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29309 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29310
29311
29312
29313 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29314 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29315 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29316 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29317 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29318 .code
29319 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29320 .endd
29321 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29322 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29323 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29324 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29325
29326
29327
29328
29329 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29330 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29331 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29332 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29333 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29334 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29335 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29336 .code
29337 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29338 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29339 .endd
29340 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29341 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29342 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29343 up by this example is
29344 .code
29345 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29346 .endd
29347 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29348 addresses. For example:
29349 .code
29350 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29351 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29352 .endd
29353 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29354 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29355
29356
29357
29358
29359 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29360 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29361 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29362 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29363 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29364 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29365 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29366 either to double the separators like this:
29367 .code
29368 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29369 .endd
29370 or to change the separator character, like this:
29371 .code
29372 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29373 .endd
29374 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29375 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29376 occurs. Consider this condition:
29377 .code
29378 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29379 .endd
29380 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29381 .code
29382 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29383 a.domain.black.list.tld
29384 .endd
29385 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29386 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29387 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29388 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29389 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29390 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29391 error for a previous item.
29392
29393 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29394 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29395 .code
29396 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29397 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29398 .endd
29399 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29400 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29401 .code
29402 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29403 $sender_address_domain \
29404 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29405 see $dnslist_text.
29406 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29407 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29408 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29409 .endd
29410 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29411 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29412 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29413 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29414 .code
29415 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29416 .endd
29417 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29418 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29419
29420 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29421 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29422
29423
29424
29425
29426 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29427 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29428 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29429 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29430 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29431 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29432 .display
29433 127.1.0.1 RBL
29434 127.1.0.2 DUL
29435 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29436 127.1.0.4 RSS
29437 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29438 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29439 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29440 .endd
29441 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29442 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29443 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29444
29445
29446 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29447 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29448 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29449 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29450 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29451 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29452 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29453 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29454 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29455 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29456 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29457 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29458 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29459 cases, for example:
29460 .code
29461 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29462 .endd
29463 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29464 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29465 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29466 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29467 .code
29468 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29469 .endd
29470 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29471 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29472
29473 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29474 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29475 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29476 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29477 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29478 information.
29479
29480 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29481 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29482 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29483 .code
29484 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29485 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29486 at $dnslist_domain
29487 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29488 .endd
29489
29490
29491
29492 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29493 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29494 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29495 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29496 For example,
29497 .code
29498 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29499 .endd
29500 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29501 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29502 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29503 describes how multiple records are handled.
29504
29505 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29506 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29507 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29508 .code
29509 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29510 .endd
29511 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29512 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29513 first. For example:
29514 .code
29515 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29516 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29517 .endd
29518
29519 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29520 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29521 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29522 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29523 tested. For example:
29524 .code
29525 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29526 .endd
29527 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29528 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29529 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29530 .code
29531 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29532 .endd
29533 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29534 an odd number.
29535
29536
29537
29538 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29539 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29540 condition. Whereas
29541 .code
29542 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29543 .endd
29544 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29545 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29546 .code
29547 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29548 .endd
29549 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29550 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29551 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29552 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29553
29554 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29555 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29556
29557 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29558 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29559 .code
29560 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29561 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29562 .endd
29563 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29564 Consider this example:
29565 .code
29566 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29567 list.dsbl.org : \
29568 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29569 relays.ordb.org
29570 .endd
29571 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29572 .code
29573 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29574 list.dsbl.org
29575 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29576 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29577 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29578 .endd
29579 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29580
29581
29582
29583
29584 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29585 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29586 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29587 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29588 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29589 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29590 .code
29591 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29592 .endd
29593 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29594 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29595 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29596 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29597 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29598 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29599
29600 .ilist
29601 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29602 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29603 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29604 .next
29605 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29606 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29607 changed to:
29608 .code
29609 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29610 .endd
29611 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29612 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29613 .code
29614 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29615 .endd
29616 for the condition to be true.
29617 .endlist
29618
29619 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29620 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29621 .ilist
29622 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29623 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29624 .code
29625 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29626 .endd
29627 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29628 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29629 .next
29630 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29631 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29632 .code
29633 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29634 .endd
29635 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29636 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29637 .code
29638 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29639 .endd
29640 for the condition to be false.
29641 .endlist
29642 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29643 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29644
29645
29646
29647
29648 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29649 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29650 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29651 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29652 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29653 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29654 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29655 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29656 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29657 lists.
29658
29659 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29660 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29661 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29662 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29663 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29664 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29665 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29666 .code
29667 reject message = \
29668 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29669 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29670 dnslists = \
29671 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29672 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29673 .endd
29674 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29675 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29676 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29677 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29678 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29679 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29680
29681 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29682 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29683 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29684 .code
29685 reject dnslists = \
29686 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29687 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29688 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29689 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29690 .endd
29691 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29692 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29693 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29694
29695
29696
29697 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29698 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29699 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29700 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29701 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29702 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29703 .code
29704 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29705 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29706 .endd
29707 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29708 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29709 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29710 .code
29711 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29712 .endd
29713 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29714 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29715
29716 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29717 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29718 .code
29719 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29720 dnslists = some.list.example
29721 .endd
29722
29723 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29724 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29725 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29726 .code
29727 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29728 .endd
29729
29730 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29731 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29732 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29733 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29734 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29735 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29736 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29737 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29738 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29739 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29740 .display
29741 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29742 .endd
29743 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29744 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29745
29746 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29747 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29748 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29749 of &'p'&.
29750
29751 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29752 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29753 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29754 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29755 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29756 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29757 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29758 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29759 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29760
29761 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29762 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29763 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29764 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29765
29766 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29767 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29768 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29769 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29770 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29771 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29772 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29773 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29774 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29775 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29776
29777 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29778 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29779 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29780 ACL.
29781
29782 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29783 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29784 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29785 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29786 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29787 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29788
29789 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29790 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29791 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29792 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29793 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29794 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29795 the &%count=%& option.
29796
29797
29798 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29799 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29800 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29801 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29802 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29803
29804 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29805 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29806 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29807 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29808
29809 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29810 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29811 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29812 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29813 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29814 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29815 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29816
29817 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29818 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29819 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29820 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29821 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29822 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29823 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29824
29825 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29826 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29827 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29828 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29829 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29830
29831 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29832 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29833 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29834 multiple different commands.
29835
29836 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29837 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29838 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29839 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29840 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29841
29842 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29843
29844
29845 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29846 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29847 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29848 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29849 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29850
29851 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29852 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29853
29854 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29855 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29856 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29857 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29858 new rate.
29859 .code
29860 acl_check_connect:
29861 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29862 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29863 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29864 # ...
29865 acl_check_mail:
29866 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29867 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29868 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29869 .endd
29870
29871 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29872 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29873 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29874 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29875 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29876 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29877 checks.
29878
29879 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29880 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29881 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29882 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29883 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29884
29885
29886 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29887 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29888 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29889 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29890 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29891 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29892 rest of the ACL.
29893
29894 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29895 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29896 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29897 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29898 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29899 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29900 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29901 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29902 from getting any email through.
29903
29904 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29905 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29906 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29907 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29908 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29909 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29910 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29911 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29912 .code
29913 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29914 .endd
29915
29916
29917 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29918 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29919 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29920 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29921 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29922 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29923 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29924 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29925 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29926
29927 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29928 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29929 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29930 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29931 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29932 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29933
29934 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29935 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29936 rate.
29937
29938 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29939 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29940 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29941 required increases with larger limits.
29942
29943 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29944 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29945 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29946 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29947 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29948 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29949 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29950 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29951 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29952 as intended.
29953
29954
29955 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29956 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29957 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29958 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29959 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29960 message. For example:
29961 .code
29962 # Log all senders' rates
29963 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29964 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29965
29966 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29967 # at the decimal point.
29968 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29969 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29970 $sender_rate_limit }s
29971
29972 # Keep authenticated users under control
29973 deny authenticated = *
29974 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29975
29976 # System-wide rate limit
29977 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29978 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29979
29980 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29981 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29982 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29983 messages per $sender_rate_period
29984 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29985 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29986 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29987 .endd
29988 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29989 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29990 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29991 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29992 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29993 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29994 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29995
29996
29997
29998 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29999 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30000 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30001 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30002 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30003 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30004 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30005 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30006 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30007 .code
30008 verify = sender/callout
30009 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30010 .endd
30011 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30012 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30013 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30014 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30015 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30016 The available options are as follows:
30017
30018 .ilist
30019 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30020 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30021 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30022 .next
30023 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30024 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30025 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30026 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30027 .next
30028 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30029 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30030 .next
30031 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30032 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30033 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30034 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30035 .endlist
30036
30037 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30038 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30039 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30040 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30041 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30042 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30043 coding like this:
30044 .code
30045 warn !verify = sender
30046 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30047 .endd
30048 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30049 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30050 verification failure.
30051
30052 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30053 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30054
30055 .ilist
30056 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30057 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30058 .next
30059 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30060 .next
30061 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30062 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30063 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30064 .next
30065 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30066 .next
30067 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30068 .endlist
30069
30070 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30071 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30072
30073
30074
30075
30076 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30077 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30078 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30079 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30080 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30081 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30082 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30083 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30084 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30085 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30086 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30087 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30088 sender's domain.
30089
30090 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30091 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30092 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30093 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30094 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30095 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30096
30097 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30098 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30099 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30100 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30101 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30102
30103 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30104 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30105 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30106 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30107 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30108 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30109 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30110 supplies a host list.
30111 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30112
30113 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30114 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30115 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30116 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30117 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30118 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30119 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30120
30121 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30122 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30123 following SMTP commands are sent:
30124 .display
30125 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30126 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30127 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30128 &`QUIT`&
30129 .endd
30130 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30131 set to &"lmtp"&.
30132
30133 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30134 settings.
30135
30136 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30137 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30138 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30139 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30140 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30141 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30142
30143 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30144 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30145 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30146 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30147 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30148
30149 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30150 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30151 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30152 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30153 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30154
30155
30156
30157
30158 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30159 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30160 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30161 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30162 .code
30163 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30164 .endd
30165 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30166 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30167 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30168
30169
30170 .vlist
30171 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30172 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30173 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30174 For example:
30175 .code
30176 verify = sender/callout=5s
30177 .endd
30178 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30179 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30180 the &%connect%& parameter.
30181
30182
30183 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30184 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30185 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30186 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30187 .code
30188 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30189 .endd
30190 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30191
30192 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30193 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30194 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30195 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30196 updated in this circumstance.
30197
30198 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30199 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30200 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30201 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30202 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30203 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30204
30205
30206 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30207 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30208 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30209 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30210 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30211 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30212 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30213 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30214 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30215 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30216 .code
30217 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30218 .endd
30219 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30220
30221
30222 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30223 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30224 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30225 For example:
30226 .code
30227 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30228 .endd
30229 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30230 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30231 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30232 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30233 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30234
30235
30236 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30237 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30238 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30239 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30240
30241 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30242 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30243 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30244 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30245 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30246 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30247 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30248 made, until the cache record expires.
30249
30250 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30251 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30252 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30253 For example:
30254 .code
30255 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30256 .endd
30257 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30258 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30259 .code
30260 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30261 .endd
30262 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30263 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30264 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30265 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30266
30267
30268 .vitem &*random*&
30269 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30270 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30271 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30272 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30273 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30274 .code
30275 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30276 .endd
30277 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30278 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30279 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30280 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30281 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30282
30283 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30284 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30285 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30286 .code
30287 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30288 .endd
30289 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30290 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30291 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30292 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30293 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30294
30295 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30296 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30297 .code
30298 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30299 .endd
30300 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30301 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30302 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30303 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30304 usefulness of callout caching.
30305 .endlist
30306
30307 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30308 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30309 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30310 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30311 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30312 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30313 these circumstances.
30314
30315 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30316 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30317 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30318 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30319 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30320 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30321 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30322
30323 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30324 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30325 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30326 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30327
30328
30329
30330
30331 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30332 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30333 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30334 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30335 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30336 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30337 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30338 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30339 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30340 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30341
30342 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30343 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30344 is not available.
30345
30346 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30347 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30348 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30349
30350 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30351 commands up to and including
30352 .code
30353 MAIL FROM:<>
30354 .endd
30355 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30356 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30357 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30358 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30359 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30360 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30361 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30362
30363 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30364 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30365 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30366 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30367 will eventually be noticed.
30368
30369 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30370 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30371 behaviour will be the same.
30372
30373
30374
30375 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30376 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30377 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30378 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30379 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30380 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30381 you might see:
30382 .code
30383 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30384 250 OK
30385 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30386 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30387 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30388 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30389 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30390 550 Sender verification failed
30391 .endd
30392 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30393 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30394 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30395 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30396 example:
30397 .code
30398 verify = sender/no_details
30399 .endd
30400
30401 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30402 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30403 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30404 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30405 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30406 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30407 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30408
30409 .ilist
30410 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30411 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30412 verification also fails.
30413 .next
30414 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30415 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30416 .endlist
30417
30418 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30419 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30420 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30421 .code
30422 A.Wol: aw123
30423 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30424 .endd
30425 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30426 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30427 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30428 verification to succeed.
30429
30430 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30431 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30432 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30433 option. For example:
30434 .code
30435 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30436 .endd
30437 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30438 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30439
30440 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30441 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30442 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30443 address and a report is output for each of them.
30444
30445
30446
30447 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30448 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30449 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30450 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30451 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30452 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30453 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30454 .code
30455 verify = csa
30456 .endd
30457 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30458 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30459 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30460 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30461 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30462 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30463
30464 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30465 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30466 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30467 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30468
30469 .ilist
30470 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30471 .next
30472 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30473 .next
30474 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30475 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30476 .next
30477 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30478 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30479 .endlist
30480
30481 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30482 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30483 .code
30484 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30485 .endd
30486 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30487 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30488 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30489 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30490 meaningful to say:
30491 .code
30492 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30493 .endd
30494 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30495 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30496 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30497
30498 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30499 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30500 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30501 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30502 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30503 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30504 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30505 of legitimate HELO domains.
30506
30507 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30508 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30509 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30510 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30511 lookup such as:
30512 .code
30513 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30514 .endd
30515 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30516 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30517 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30518
30519
30520
30521
30522 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30523 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30524 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30525 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30526 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30527 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30528 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30529 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30530
30531 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30532 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30533 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30534 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30535 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30536 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30537 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30538
30539 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30540 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30541 like this:
30542 .code
30543 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30544 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30545 }{$value}}
30546 .endd
30547 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30548 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30549 use this:
30550 .code
30551 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30552 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30553 senders = :
30554 recipients = +batv_senders
30555
30556 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30557 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30558 senders = :
30559 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30560 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30561 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30562 .endd
30563 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30564 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30565 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30566 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30567 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30568
30569 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30570 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30571 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30572 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30573 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30574 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30575 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30576
30577 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30578 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30579 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30580 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30581 .code
30582 batv_redirect:
30583 driver = redirect
30584 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30585 .endd
30586 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30587 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30588 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30589 local addresses.
30590
30591 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30592 can be used:
30593 .code
30594 external_smtp_batv:
30595 driver = smtp
30596 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30597 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30598 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30599 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30600 {$value}fail}}}
30601 .endd
30602 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30603
30604
30605
30606 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30607 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30608 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30609 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30610 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30611 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30612 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30613 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30614 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30615 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30616
30617 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30618 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30619 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30620 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30621 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30622 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30623 . ///
30624 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30625 . ///
30626 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30627 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30628 system to arbitrary domains.
30629
30630
30631 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30632 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30633 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30634 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30635
30636 .ilist
30637 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30638 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30639 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30640 .next
30641 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30642 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30643 .next
30644 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30645 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30646 .endlist
30647
30648
30649 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30650 .code
30651 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30652 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30653 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30654 .endd
30655 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30656 command:
30657 .code
30658 acl_check_rcpt:
30659 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30660 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30661 .endd
30662 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30663 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30664 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30665 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30666 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30667 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30668 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30669
30670
30671
30672 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30673 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30674 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30675 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30676 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30677
30678 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30679 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30680 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30681 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30682 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30683 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30684 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30685 .ecindex IIDacl
30686
30687
30688
30689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30691
30692 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30693 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30694 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30695 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30696 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30697 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30698 specification.
30699
30700 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30701 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30702 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30703 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30704 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30705
30706 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30707 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30708 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30709
30710 .ilist
30711 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30712 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30713 .next
30714 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30715 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30716 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30717 .next
30718 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30719 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30720 .next
30721 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30722 conditions.
30723 .next
30724 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30725 .endlist
30726
30727 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30728 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30729 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30730
30731 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30732 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30733 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30734 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30735 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30736 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30737
30738 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30739 temporarily created in a file called:
30740 .display
30741 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30742 .endd
30743 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30744 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30745 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30746 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30747 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30748 .code
30749 control = no_mbox_unspool
30750 .endd
30751 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30752 same directory by default.
30753
30754
30755
30756 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30757 .cindex "virus scanning"
30758 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30759 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30760 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30761 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30762 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30763 in memory and thus are much faster.
30764
30765 .new
30766 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30767 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30768 .wen
30769
30770 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30771 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30772 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30773 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30774 .display
30775 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30776 .endd
30777 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30778 .code
30779 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30780 .endd
30781 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30782 before use.
30783 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30784 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30785
30786 .vlist
30787 .new
30788 .vitem &%avast%&
30789 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30790 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30791 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30792 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30793 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30794 This scanner type takes one option,
30795 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30796 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30797 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30798 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30799 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30800 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30801 For example:
30802 .code
30803 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30804 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30805 .endd
30806 If you omit the argument, the default path
30807 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30808 is used.
30809 If you use a remote host,
30810 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30811 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30812 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30813 .code
30814 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30815 FLAGS
30816 SENSITIVITY
30817 PACK
30818 .endd
30819 .wen
30820
30821
30822 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30823 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30824 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30825 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30826 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30827 example:
30828 .code
30829 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30830 .endd
30831
30832
30833 .vitem &%clamd%&
30834 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30835 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30836 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30837 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30838 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30839
30840 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30841 a UNIX socket specification,
30842 a TCP socket specification,
30843 or a (global) option.
30844
30845 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30846 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30847 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30848 and the second a port number,
30849 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30850 These per-server options are supported:
30851 .code
30852 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30853 .endd
30854
30855 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30856 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30857
30858 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30859
30860 Examples:
30861 .code
30862 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30863 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30864 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30865 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30866 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30867 .endd
30868 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30869 &`local`&
30870 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30871 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30872 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30873 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30874 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30875 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30876
30877 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30878 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30879 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30880 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30881 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30882 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30883 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30884 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30885 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30886 .code
30887 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30888 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30889 (Connection refused)
30890 .endd
30891
30892 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30893 contributing the code for this scanner.
30894
30895 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30896 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30897 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30898 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30899 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30900
30901 .olist
30902 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30903 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30904
30905 .next
30906 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30907 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30908 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30909 the &"trigger"& expression.
30910
30911 .next
30912 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30913 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30914 &"name"& expression.
30915 .endlist olist
30916
30917 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30918 .code
30919 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30920 .endd
30921 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30922 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30923 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30924 configuration setting:
30925 .code
30926 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30927 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30928 found in file:'(.+)'
30929 .endd
30930 .vitem &%drweb%&
30931 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30932 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30933 takes one option,
30934 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30935 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30936 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30937 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30938 For example:
30939 .code
30940 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30941 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30942 .endd
30943 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30944 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30945
30946 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30947 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30948 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30949 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30950 (or port-range).
30951 For example:
30952 .code
30953 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30954 .endd
30955 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30956
30957 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30958 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30959 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30960 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30961 .code
30962 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30963 .endd
30964 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30965 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30966
30967 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30968 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30969 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30970 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30971 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30972 For example:
30973 .code
30974 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30975 .endd
30976 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30977
30978 .vitem &%mksd%&
30979 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30980 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30981 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30982 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30983 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30984 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30985 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30986 .code
30987 av_scanner = mksd:2
30988 .endd
30989 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30990
30991 .vitem &%sock%&
30992 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30993 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30994 running on the local machine.
30995 There are four options:
30996 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30997 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30998 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30999 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31000 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31001 For example:
31002 .code
31003 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31004 .endd
31005 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31006 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31007 Both regular-expressions are required.
31008
31009 .vitem &%sophie%&
31010 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31011 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31012 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31013 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31014 client communication. For example:
31015 .code
31016 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31017 .endd
31018 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31019 the option.
31020 .endlist
31021
31022 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31023 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31024 ACL.
31025
31026 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31027 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31028 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31029 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31030 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31031 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31032 message.
31033
31034 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31035 .new
31036 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31037 .wen
31038 The first element can then be one of
31039
31040 .ilist
31041 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31042 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31043 recommended usage.
31044 .next
31045 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31046 the condition fails immediately.
31047 .next
31048 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31049 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31050 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31051 .new
31052 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31053 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31054 .wen
31055 .endlist
31056
31057 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31058 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31059 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31060
31061 .new
31062 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31063 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31064 For example:
31065 .code
31066 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31067 .endd
31068 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31069 .wen
31070
31071 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31072 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31073 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31074 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31075 logging data.
31076
31077 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31078 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31079 &%malware%& condition.
31080
31081 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31082 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31083
31084 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31085 .code
31086 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31087 demime = *
31088 malware = *
31089 .endd
31090 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31091 .code
31092 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31093 demime = *
31094 malware = */defer_ok
31095 .endd
31096 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31097 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31098 .code
31099 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31100 .endd
31101 in the main Exim configuration.
31102 .code
31103 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31104 set acl_m0 = sophie
31105 malware = *
31106
31107 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31108 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31109 malware = *
31110 .endd
31111
31112
31113 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31114 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31115 .cindex "spam scanning"
31116 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31117 .cindex "Rspamd"
31118 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31119 score and a report for the message.
31120 .new
31121 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31122
31123 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31124 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31125 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31126 .wen
31127
31128 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31129 .code
31130 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31131 .endd
31132 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31133 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31134 nicely, however.
31135
31136 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31137 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31138 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31139 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31140 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31141 configuration as follows (example):
31142 .code
31143 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31144 .endd
31145
31146 .new
31147 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31148 on TCP port 11333)
31149 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31150 .code
31151 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31152 .endd
31153 .wen
31154
31155 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31156 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31157 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31158 .code
31159 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31160 .endd
31161 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31162 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31163 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31164 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31165 .code
31166 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31167 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31168 192.168.2.12 783
31169 .endd
31170 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31171 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31172 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31173 condition defers.
31174
31175 .new
31176 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31177 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31178 and changeable in the usual way.
31179
31180 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31181 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31182 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31183 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31184
31185 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31186 are options.
31187 The supported option are:
31188 .code
31189 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31190 weight=<value> Selection bias
31191 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31192 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31193 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31194 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31195 .endd
31196
31197 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31198 higher values being tried first.
31199 The default priority is 1.
31200
31201 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31202 Within a priority set
31203 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31204 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31205
31206 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31207 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31208 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31209 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31210
31211 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31212 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31213
31214 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31215 The default value is two minutes.
31216
31217 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31218 a failed connect is made.
31219 The default is to not retry.
31220 .wen
31221
31222 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31223 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31224 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31225 expansion.
31226
31227 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31228 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31229 .code
31230 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31231 spam = joe
31232 .endd
31233 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31234 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31235 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31236 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31237 .new
31238 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31239 right-hand side.
31240 .wen
31241
31242 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31243 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31244 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31245 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31246 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31247 are not set.
31248 .new
31249 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31250 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31251 after the first),
31252 or the use of PRDR,
31253 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31254 are needed to use this feature.
31255 .wen
31256
31257 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31258 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31259 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31260
31261
31262 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31263 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31264 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31265 example:
31266 .code
31267 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31268 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31269 spam = nobody
31270 .endd
31271
31272 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31273 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31274 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31275 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31276
31277 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31278 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31279 variables.
31280 .new
31281 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31282 .wen
31283 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31284 available for use at delivery time.
31285
31286 .vlist
31287 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31288 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31289 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31290
31291 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31292 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31293 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31294 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31295 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31296
31297 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31298 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31299 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31300 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31301 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
31302
31303 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31304 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31305 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31306 .new
31307 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31308 .wen
31309
31310 .new
31311 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31312 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31313 spam score versus threshold.
31314 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31315 .wen
31316
31317 .endlist
31318
31319 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31320 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31321 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31322
31323 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31324 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31325 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31326 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31327 spam condition, like this:
31328 .code
31329 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31330 spam = joe/defer_ok
31331 .endd
31332 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31333
31334 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31335 condition:
31336 .code
31337 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31338 warn spam = nobody:true
31339 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31340 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31341
31342 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31343 # is over threshold
31344 warn spam = nobody
31345 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31346
31347 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31348 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31349 spam = nobody:true
31350 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31351 .endd
31352
31353
31354
31355 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31356 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31357 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31358 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31359 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31360 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31361 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31362 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31363 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31364 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31365 cases.
31366
31367 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31368 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31369 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31370 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31371 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31372 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31373 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31374
31375 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31376 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31377 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31378 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31379 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31380
31381 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31382 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31383 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31384 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31385 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31386 syntax is:
31387 .display
31388 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31389 .endd
31390 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31391 the value can be:
31392
31393 .olist
31394 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31395 .next
31396 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31397 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31398 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31399 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31400 .next
31401 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31402 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31403 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31404 the full path and file name.
31405 .next
31406 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31407 filename, and the default path is then used.
31408 .endlist
31409 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31410 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31411 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31412 .code
31413 decode = $mime_filename
31414 .endd
31415 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31416 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31417 automatically unlinked.
31418
31419 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31420 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31421 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31422 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31423 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31424
31425 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31426 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31427 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31428
31429 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31430 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31431 available in the MIME ACL:
31432
31433 .vlist
31434 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31435 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31436 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31437 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31438 contains the empty string.
31439
31440 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31441 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31442 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31443 .code
31444 us-ascii
31445 gb2312 (Chinese)
31446 iso-8859-1
31447 .endd
31448 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31449 case-insensitively.
31450
31451 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31452 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31453 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31454 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31455 only used for display purposes.
31456
31457 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31458 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31459 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31460
31461 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31462 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31463 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31464
31465 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31466 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31467 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31468 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31469 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31470
31471 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31472 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31473 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31474 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31475
31476 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31477 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31478 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31479 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31480 .code
31481 text/plain
31482 text/html
31483 application/octet-stream
31484 image/jpeg
31485 audio/midi
31486 .endd
31487 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31488 empty string.
31489
31490 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31491 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31492 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31493 containing the decoded data.
31494 .endlist
31495
31496 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31497 .vlist
31498 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31499 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31500 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31501 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31502 RFC2047
31503 .new
31504 or RFC2231
31505 .wen
31506 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31507 If no filename was
31508 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31509
31510 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31511 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31512 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31513 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31514
31515 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31516 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31517 follows:
31518
31519 .olist
31520 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31521
31522 .next
31523 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31524 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31525
31526 .next
31527 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31528 and the rest are attachments.
31529
31530 .next
31531 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31532 .endlist olist
31533
31534 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31535 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31536 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31537 .code
31538 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31539 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31540 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31541 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31542 .endd
31543 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31544 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31545 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31546 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31547 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31548
31549 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31550 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31551 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31552 decoding is fully recursive.
31553
31554 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31555 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31556 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31557 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31558 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31559 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31560 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31561 .endlist
31562
31563
31564
31565 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31566 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31567 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31568 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31569 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31570
31571 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31572 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31573 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31574 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31575 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31576
31577 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31578 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31579 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31580 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31581 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31582 32K characters are checked.
31583
31584 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31585 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31586 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31587 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31588 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31589 .code
31590 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31591 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31592 .endd
31593 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31594 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31595 matching regular expression.
31596
31597 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31598 CPU-intensive.
31599
31600
31601
31602
31603 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31604 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31605 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31606 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31607 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31608 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31609 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31610 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31611 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31612 use the &%demime%& condition.
31613
31614 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31615 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31616 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31617 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31618 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31619 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31620
31621 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31622 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31623 example:
31624 .code
31625 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31626 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31627 .endd
31628 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31629 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31630 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31631 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31632
31633 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31634 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31635 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31636
31637 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31638
31639 .vlist
31640 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31641 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31642 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31643 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31644 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31645 zero, no error occurred.
31646
31647 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31648 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31649 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31650 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31651 .endlist
31652
31653 .vlist
31654 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31655 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31656 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31657 extension it found.
31658 .endlist
31659
31660 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31661 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31662
31663 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31664 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31665 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31666 facility:
31667 .code
31668 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31669 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31670 demime = *
31671 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31672
31673 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31674 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31675 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31676 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31677
31678 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31679 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31680 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31681 demime = exe:doc
31682 control = freeze
31683 .endd
31684 .ecindex IIDcosca
31685
31686
31687
31688
31689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31691
31692 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31693 "Local scan function"
31694 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31695 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31696 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31697 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31698 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31699
31700 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31701 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31702 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31703 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31704 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31705
31706 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31707 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31708 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31709 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31710
31711 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31712 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31713 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31714 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31715
31716 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31717 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31718 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31719 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31720 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31721 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31722 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31723 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31724 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31725
31726
31727
31728 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31729 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31730 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31731 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31732 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31733 directory, so you might set
31734 .code
31735 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31736 .endd
31737 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31738 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31739 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31740 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31741 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31742 _src/local_scan.c_.
31743
31744 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31745 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31746 .code
31747 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31748 .endd
31749 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31750
31751
31752
31753
31754 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31755 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31756 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31757 .code
31758 #include "local_scan.h"
31759 .endd
31760 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31761 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31762 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31763 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31764 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31765 strings and pointers to character strings:
31766 .code
31767 #define CS (char *)
31768 #define CCS (const char *)
31769 #define CSS (char **)
31770 #define US (unsigned char *)
31771 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31772 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31773 .endd
31774 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31775 .code
31776 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31777 .endd
31778 The arguments are as follows:
31779
31780 .ilist
31781 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31782 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31783 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31784
31785 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31786 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31787 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31788 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31789 case this changes in some future version.
31790 .next
31791 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31792 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31793 .endlist
31794
31795 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31796
31797 .vlist
31798 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31799 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31800 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31801 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31802 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31803 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31804
31805 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31806 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31807 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31808
31809 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31810 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31811 queued without immediate delivery.
31812
31813 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31814 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31815 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31816 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31817 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31818 used.
31819
31820 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31821 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31822 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31823 problem"& is used.
31824
31825 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31826 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31827 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31828 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31829 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31830 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31831 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31832
31833 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31834 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31835 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31836 .endlist
31837
31838 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31839 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31840 &%-oe%& command line options.
31841
31842
31843
31844 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31845 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31846 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31847 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31848 want to do this, you must have the line
31849 .code
31850 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31851 .endd
31852 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31853 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31854 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31855 to define them.
31856
31857 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31858 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31859 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31860 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31861 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31862 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31863 .code
31864 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31865 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31866
31867 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31868 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31869 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31870 };
31871
31872 int local_scan_options_count =
31873 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31874 .endd
31875 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31876 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31877 .code
31878 begin local_scan
31879 my_integer = 99
31880 my_string = some string of text...
31881 .endd
31882 The available types of option data are as follows:
31883
31884 .vlist
31885 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31886 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31887 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31888 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31889 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31890 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31891 values.)
31892
31893 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31894 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31895 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31896 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31897
31898 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31899 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31900 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31901 Exim.
31902
31903 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31904 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31905 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31906 printed with the suffix K or M.
31907
31908 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31909 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31910 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31911 always output in octal.
31912
31913 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31914 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31915 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31916
31917 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31918 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31919 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31920 .endlist
31921
31922 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31923 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31924
31925
31926
31927 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31928 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31929 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31930 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31931 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31932 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31933 C variables are as follows:
31934
31935 .vlist
31936 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31937 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31938
31939 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31940 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31941
31942 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31943 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31944 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31945 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31946
31947 .ilist
31948 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31949 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31950 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31951
31952 .next
31953 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31954 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31955 of debugging bits.
31956 .endlist ilist
31957
31958 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31959 selected, you should use code like this:
31960 .code
31961 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31962 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31963 .endd
31964 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31965 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31966 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31967
31968 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31969 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31970 discussed below.
31971
31972 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31973 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31974
31975 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31976 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31977
31978 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31979 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31980 &%-bh%& command line option.
31981
31982 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31983 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31984 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31985
31986 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31987 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31988 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31989 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31990
31991 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31992 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31993 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31994
31995 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31996 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31997
31998 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31999 The number of accepted recipients.
32000
32001 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32002 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32003 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32004 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32005 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32006 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32007 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32008 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32009 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32010 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32011 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32012 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32013
32014 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32015 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32016
32017 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32018 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32019 locally-submitted messages.
32020
32021 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32022 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32023 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32024
32025 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32026 The name of the sending host, if known.
32027
32028 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32029 The port on the sending host.
32030
32031 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32032 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32033
32034 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32035 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32036
32037 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32038 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32039 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32040 .endlist
32041
32042
32043 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32044 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32045 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32046 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32047 their type to *.
32048
32049
32050 .vlist
32051 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32052 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32053
32054 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32055 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32056 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32057 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32058 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32059 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32060 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32061
32062 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32063 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32064 internal newlines.
32065
32066 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32067 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32068 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32069 .endlist
32070
32071
32072
32073 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32074 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32075
32076 .vlist
32077 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32078 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32079
32080 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32081 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32082 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32083 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32084
32085 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32086 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32087 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32088 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32089 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32090 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32091 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32092 is NULL for all recipients.
32093 .endlist
32094
32095
32096
32097 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32098 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32099 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32100 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32101 release:
32102
32103 .vlist
32104 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32105 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32106
32107 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32108 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32109 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32110 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32111
32112 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32113 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32114 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32115 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32116 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32117
32118 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32119
32120 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32121 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32122 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32123 return value is as follows:
32124
32125 .ilist
32126 >= 0
32127
32128 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32129 ending status.
32130
32131 .next
32132 < 0 and > &--256
32133
32134 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32135 signal number.
32136
32137 .next
32138 &--256
32139
32140 The process timed out.
32141 .next
32142 &--257
32143
32144 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32145 .endlist
32146
32147 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32148 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32149 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32150 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32151 forks a subprocess that is running
32152 .code
32153 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32154 .endd
32155 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32156 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32157 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32158 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32159
32160 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32161 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32162 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32163 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32164
32165
32166 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32167 *sender_authentication)*&
32168 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32169 that it runs is:
32170 .display
32171 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32172 .endd
32173 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32174
32175
32176 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32177 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32178 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32179 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32180 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32181 .code
32182 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32183 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32184 .endd
32185
32186 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32187 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32188 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32189 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32190 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32191 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32192 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32193 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32194
32195 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32196 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32197 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32198 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32199 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32200 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32201
32202 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32203 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32204 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32205 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32206
32207 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32208 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32209 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32210 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32211 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32212 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32213 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32214 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32215 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32216 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32217 .code
32218 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32219 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32220 .endd
32221 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32222 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32223
32224
32225 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32226 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32227 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32228 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32229 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32230
32231
32232 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32233 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32234 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32235 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32236 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32237 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32238 .code
32239 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32240 .endd
32241 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32242 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32243 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32244 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32245 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32246 zero-terminated.
32247
32248 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32249 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32250 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32251 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32252 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32253 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32254 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32255 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32256
32257 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32258 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32259 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32260 .display
32261 &`OK `& match succeeded
32262 &`FAIL `& match failed
32263 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32264 .endd
32265 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32266 inability to contact a database.
32267
32268 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32269 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32270 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32271 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32272 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32273
32274 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32275 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32276 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32277 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32278 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32279
32280 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32281 uschar&~*list)*&"
32282 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32283 expected to be
32284 .code
32285 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32286 .endd
32287 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32288 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32289 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32290 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32291 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32292 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32293 failed.
32294
32295 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32296 *format,&~...)*&"
32297 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32298 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32299 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32300 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32301 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32302 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32303
32304
32305 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32306 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32307 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32308 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32309
32310 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32311 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32312 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32313 value afterwards. For example:
32314 .code
32315 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32316 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32317 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32318 .endd
32319
32320 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32321 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32322 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32323 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32324 address.
32325 .endlist
32326
32327
32328 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32329 .vlist
32330 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32331 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32332 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32333 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32334 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32335 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32336 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32337 binary string is returned with an error message.
32338
32339 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32340 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32341 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32342
32343 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32344 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32345 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32346 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32347 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32348
32349 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32350 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32351 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32352
32353 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32354 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32355 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32356 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32357 with translation.
32358
32359
32360 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32361 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32362 below.
32363
32364 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32365 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32366 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32367 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32368 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32369 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32370 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32371 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32372 is involved.
32373
32374 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32375 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32376
32377 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32378 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32379 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32380 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32381 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32382 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32383 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32384 .code
32385 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32386 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32387 .endd
32388 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32389 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32390 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32391 multiple output lines.
32392
32393 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32394 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32395 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32396 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32397 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32398 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32399 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32400 is an error.
32401
32402 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32403 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32404 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32405 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32406
32407 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32408 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32409 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32410
32411 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32412 See below.
32413
32414 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32415 See below.
32416
32417 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32418 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32419 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32420 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32421 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32422 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32423 more discussion.
32424 .endlist
32425
32426
32427
32428 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32429 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32430 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32431 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32432 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32433 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32434 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32435 terminates.
32436
32437 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32438 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32439 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32440 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32441
32442 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32443 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32444 .code
32445 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32446 .endd
32447 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32448 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32449 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32450 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32451
32452 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32453 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32454 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32455 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32456 &%store_pool%&.
32457 .ecindex IIDlosca
32458
32459
32460
32461
32462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32464
32465 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32466 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32467 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32468 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32469 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32470 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32471 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32472 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32473
32474 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32475 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32476 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32477 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32478 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32479
32480 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32481 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32482 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32483 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32484 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32485 prevent it happening on retries.
32486
32487 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32488 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32489 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32490 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32491 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32492 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32493 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32494 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32495
32496
32497 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32498 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32499 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32500 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32501 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32502 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32503 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32504 .code
32505 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32506 system_filter_user = exim
32507 .endd
32508 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32509 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32510 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32511 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32512 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32513 by the &%reply%& command.
32514
32515
32516 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32517 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32518 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32519 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32520
32521 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32522 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32523
32524
32525
32526 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32527 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32528 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32529 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32530 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32531 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32532 they cause errors.
32533
32534 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32535 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32536 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32537 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32538 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32539 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32540 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32541
32542 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32543 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32544 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32545 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32546 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32547
32548 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32549 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32550 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32551 to which users' filter files can refer.
32552
32553
32554
32555 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32556 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32557 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32558 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32559 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32560
32561
32562
32563 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32564 .cindex "freezing messages"
32565 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32566 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32567 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32568 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32569 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32570 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32571 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32572 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32573 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32574 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32575 .code
32576 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32577 .endd
32578 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32579
32580 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32581 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32582 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32583 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32584 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32585 run.
32586
32587 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32588 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32589 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32590 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32591
32592 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32593 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32594 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32595 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32596 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32597 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32598 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32599 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32600 message. For example:
32601 .code
32602 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32603 because it contains attachments that we are \
32604 not prepared to receive."
32605 .endd
32606
32607 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32608 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32609 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32610 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32611 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32612 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32613 use, for example
32614 .code
32615 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32616 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32617 .endd
32618 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32619 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32620 generated by the filter.
32621
32622 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32623 &%defer%&,
32624 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32625 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32626 as
32627 .code
32628 mail ...
32629 freeze
32630 .endd
32631 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32632 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32633 take place.
32634
32635
32636
32637 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32638 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32639 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32640 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32641 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32642 .code
32643 headers add <string>
32644 headers remove <string>
32645 .endd
32646 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32647 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32648 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32649 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32650 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32651
32652 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32653 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32654 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32655 example:
32656 .code
32657 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32658 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32659 X-header-2: ...."
32660 .endd
32661 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32662 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32663 space after input continuations is ignored.
32664
32665 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32666 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32667 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32668 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32669 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32670
32671 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32672 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32673 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32674 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32675 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32676 used for all recipients of the message.
32677
32678 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32679 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32680 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32681 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32682 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32683 until the message is actually being written (see section
32684 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32685
32686 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32687 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32688 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32689 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32690 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32691 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32692 modified more than once.
32693
32694 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32695 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32696 For example:
32697 .code
32698 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32699 headers remove "Subject"
32700 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32701 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32702 .endd
32703
32704
32705
32706 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32707 .cindex "envelope sender"
32708 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32709 .code
32710 errors_to <some address>
32711 .endd
32712 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32713 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32714 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32715 might use
32716 .code
32717 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32718 .endd
32719 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32720 address if its delivery failed.
32721
32722
32723
32724 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32725 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32726 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32727 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32728 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32729 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32730 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32731 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32732 which implements such a filter:
32733 .code
32734 central_filter:
32735 check_local_user
32736 driver = redirect
32737 domains = +local_domains
32738 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32739 no_verify
32740 allow_filter
32741 allow_freeze
32742 .endd
32743 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32744 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32745 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32746 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32747
32748 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32749 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32750 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32751 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32752 normal way.
32753 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32754 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32755 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32756
32757
32758
32759
32760
32761
32762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32764
32765 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32766 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32767 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32768 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32769 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32770 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32771 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32772 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32773
32774 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32775 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32776 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32777 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32778 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32779
32780 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32781 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32782 loopback interface specially in any way.
32783
32784 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32785 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32786
32787
32788
32789
32790 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32791 .cindex "message" "submission"
32792 .cindex "submission mode"
32793 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32794 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32795 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32796 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32797 .code
32798 control = submission
32799 .endd
32800 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32801 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32802 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32803 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32804 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32805 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32806 .code
32807 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32808 control = submission
32809 .endd
32810 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32811 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32812 is used to separate options. For example:
32813 .code
32814 control = submission/sender_retain
32815 .endd
32816 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32817 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32818 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32819 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32820 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32821 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32822 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32823
32824 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32825 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32826 example:
32827 .code
32828 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32829 .endd
32830 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32831 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32832 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32833 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32834 .code
32835 accept authenticated = *
32836 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32837 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32838 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32839 .endd
32840 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32841 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32842 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32843 .code
32844 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32845 .endd
32846 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32847 line would be:
32848 .code
32849 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32850 .endd
32851 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32852 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32853 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32854 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32855
32856 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32857 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32858 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32859 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32860 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32861 spoof another's address.
32862
32863 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32864 .cindex "line endings"
32865 .cindex "carriage return"
32866 .cindex "linefeed"
32867 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32868 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32869 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32870 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32871 use CRLF or just CR.
32872
32873 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32874 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32875 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32876 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32877 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32878 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32879 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32880 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32881 follows:
32882
32883 .ilist
32884 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32885 .next
32886 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32887 is ignored.
32888 .next
32889 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32890 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32891 terminator.
32892 .next
32893 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32894 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32895 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32896 people trying to play silly games.
32897 .next
32898 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32899 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32900 line.
32901 .endlist
32902
32903
32904
32905
32906
32907 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32908 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32909 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32910 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32911 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32912 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32913 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32914 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32915
32916 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32917 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32918 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32919 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32920 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32921
32922 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32923 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32924 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32925 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32926 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32927 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32928 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32929 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32930
32931
32932
32933
32934 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32935 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32936 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32937 .cindex "sender" "address"
32938 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32939 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32940 .cindex "envelope sender"
32941 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32942 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32943 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32944 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32945 .code
32946 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32947 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32948 .endd
32949 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32950 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32951 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32952 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32953 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32954 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32955 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32956 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32957 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32958
32959 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32960 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32961 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32962 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32963 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32964 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32965 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32966
32967 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32968 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32969 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32970
32971 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32972 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32973 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32974 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32975
32976
32977
32978 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32979 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32980 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32981 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32982 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32983 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32984 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32985
32986 .blockquote
32987 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32988 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32989 .endblockquote
32990
32991 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32992 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32993 follows:
32994
32995 .ilist
32996 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32997 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32998 .next
32999 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33000 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33001 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33002 .next
33003 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33004 also removed.
33005 .next
33006 For a locally-submitted message,
33007 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33008 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33009 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33010 included in log lines in this case.
33011 .next
33012 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33013 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33014 .endlist
33015
33016
33017
33018
33019 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33020 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33021 includes the header line:
33022 .code
33023 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33024 .endd
33025
33026 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33027 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33028 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33029 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33030 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33031 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33032
33033
33034 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33035 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33036 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33037 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33038 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33039
33040 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33041 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33042 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33043 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33044 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33045 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33046 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33047 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33048 messages.
33049
33050
33051 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33052 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33053 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33054 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33055 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33056 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33057 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33058 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33059 messages.
33060
33061
33062 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33063 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33064 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33065 .cindex "message" "submission"
33066 .cindex "submission mode"
33067 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33068 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33069
33070 .ilist
33071 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33072 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33073 .next
33074 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33075 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33076 .olist
33077 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33078 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33079 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33080 .next
33081 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33082 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33083 .next
33084 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33085 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33086 .endlist
33087 .endlist
33088
33089 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33090
33091 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33092 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33093 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33094 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33095 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33096 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33097 &%qualify_domain%&.
33098
33099 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33100 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33101 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33102 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33103
33104
33105 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33106 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33107 .cindex "message" "submission"
33108 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33109 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33110 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33111 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33112 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33113 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33114 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33115 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33116 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33117 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33118
33119
33120 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33121 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33122 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33123 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33124 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33125
33126 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33127 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33128 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33129 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33130
33131 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33132 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33133 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33134
33135
33136 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33137 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33138 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33139 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33140 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33141 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33142 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33143 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33144 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33145 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33146 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33147
33148
33149
33150 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33151 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33152 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33153 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33154 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33155 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33156 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33157 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33158
33159
33160
33161 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33162 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33163 .cindex "message" "submission"
33164 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33165 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33166 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33167 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33168 control setting.
33169
33170 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33171 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33172 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33173 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33174 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33175 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33176 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33177 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33178 line is added to the message.
33179
33180 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33181 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33182 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33183 options true at the same time.
33184
33185 .cindex "submission mode"
33186 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33187 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33188 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33189 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33190
33191 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33192 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33193 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33194 created as follows:
33195
33196 .ilist
33197 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33198 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33199 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33200 .next
33201 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33202 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33203 .next
33204 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33205 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33206 .endlist
33207
33208 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33209 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33210 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33211 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33212
33213 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33214 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33215 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33216 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33217
33218
33219
33220 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33221 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33222 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33223 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33224 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33225 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33226 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33227 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33228 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33229
33230 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33231 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33232 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33233 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33234 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33235 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33236
33237 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33238 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33239 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33240
33241 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33242 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33243 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33244 .code
33245 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33246 X-added-second: another added header line
33247 .endd
33248 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33249
33250 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33251 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33252 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33253
33254 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33255 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33256 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33257 not part of the names. For example:
33258 .code
33259 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33260 .endd
33261
33262 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33263 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33264 Each item is separately expanded.
33265 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33266 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33267 will act as list separators.
33268
33269 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33270 items are expanded at routing time,
33271 and then associated with all addresses that are
33272 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33273 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33274 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33275
33276 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33277 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33278 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33279 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33280
33281 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33282 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33283 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33284 requirements.
33285
33286 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33287 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33288 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33289 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33290 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33291 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33292 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33293
33294 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33295 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33296 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33297 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33298
33299 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33300 the following consequences:
33301
33302 .ilist
33303 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33304 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33305 to it, at all times.
33306 .next
33307 Header lines that are added by a router's
33308 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33309 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33310 .next
33311 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33312 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33313 .next
33314 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33315 a later router or by a transport.
33316 .next
33317 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33318 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33319 .code
33320 headers_remove = subject
33321 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33322 .endd
33323 .endlist
33324
33325 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33326 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33327
33328
33329
33330
33331
33332 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33333 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33334 .cindex "constructed address"
33335 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33336 the form
33337 .display
33338 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33339 .endd
33340 For example:
33341 .code
33342 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33343 .endd
33344 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33345 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33346 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33347 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33348 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33349 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33350 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33351 there is no password file entry.
33352
33353 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33354 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33355 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33356 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33357 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33358 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33359 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33360 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33361 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33362
33363
33364
33365 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33366 .cindex "case of local parts"
33367 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33368 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33369 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33370 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33371 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33372 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33373 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33374 router option.
33375
33376 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33377 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33378 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33379 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33380 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33381 .code
33382 correct_case:
33383 driver = redirect
33384 domains = +local_domains
33385 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33386 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33387 @$domain
33388 .endd
33389 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33390 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33391 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33392 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33393 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33394
33395
33396
33397 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33398 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33399 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33400 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33401 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33402 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33403 empty components for compatibility.
33404
33405
33406
33407 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33408 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33409 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33410 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33411 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33412 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33413
33414 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33415 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33416 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33417 example, a header such as
33418 .code
33419 To: hare@teaparty
33420 .endd
33421 might get rewritten as
33422 .code
33423 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33424 .endd
33425 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33426 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33427 been routed.
33428
33429 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33430 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33431 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33432 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33433 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33434 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33435 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33436
33437
33438
33439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33441
33442 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33443 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33444 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33445 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33446 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33447 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33448 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33449
33450 .ilist
33451 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33452 .next
33453 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33454 .next
33455 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33456 .endlist
33457
33458 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33459
33460 .ilist
33461 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33462 .next
33463 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33464 &"lmtp"&);
33465 .next
33466 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33467 transport);
33468 .next
33469 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33470 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33471 .endlist
33472
33473 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33474 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33475 used to contain the envelope information.
33476
33477
33478
33479 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33480 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33481 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33482 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33483 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33484 .cindex "EHLO"
33485 .cindex "HELO"
33486 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33487 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33488 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33489 processing is the same in both cases.
33490
33491 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33492 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33493 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33494 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33495 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33496 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33497 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33498 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33499 suppressed.
33500
33501 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33502 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33503 required for the transaction.
33504
33505 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33506 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33507 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33508 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33509 is called for verification.
33510
33511 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33512 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33513 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33514
33515 .cindex "carriage return"
33516 .cindex "linefeed"
33517 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33518 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33519 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33520 line terminator.
33521
33522 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33523 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33524 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33525 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33526 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33527 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33528 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33529 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33530 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33531
33532 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33533 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33534 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33535 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33536
33537 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33538 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33539 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33540 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33541
33542 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33543 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33544 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33545 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33546 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33547 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33548 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33549 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33550 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33551 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33552
33553 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33554 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33555
33556 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33557 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33558 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33559 square bracket of the IP address.
33560
33561
33562
33563
33564 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33565 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33566 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33567 .cindex "host" "error"
33568 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33569 message errors, and recipient errors.
33570
33571 .vlist
33572 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33573 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33574 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33575
33576 .ilist
33577 Connection refused or timed out,
33578 .next
33579 Any error response code on connection,
33580 .next
33581 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33582 .next
33583 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33584 .next
33585 I/O errors at any time,
33586 .next
33587 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33588 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33589 .endlist ilist
33590
33591 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33592 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33593 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33594 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33595 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33596 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33597 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33598 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33599
33600 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33601 .cindex "message" "error"
33602 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33603 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33604 message errors are:
33605
33606 .ilist
33607 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33608 the data,
33609 .next
33610 Timeout after MAIL,
33611 .next
33612 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33613 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33614 connection at any other time.
33615 .endlist ilist
33616
33617 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33618 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33619 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33620 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33621 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33622 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33623 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33624 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33625 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33626 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33627
33628 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33629 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33630 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33631 response to MAIL.
33632
33633 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33634 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33635 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33636 recipient errors are:
33637
33638 .ilist
33639 Any error response to RCPT,
33640 .next
33641 Timeout after RCPT.
33642 .endlist
33643
33644 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33645 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33646 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33647 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33648 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33649 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33650 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33651 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33652 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33653 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33654 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33655 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33656 the retry clock is reset.
33657
33658 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33659 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33660 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33661 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33662 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33663 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33664 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33665 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33666 recipient's retry time.
33667 .endlist
33668
33669 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33670 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33671 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33672 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33673 until the next delivery attempt.
33674
33675 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33676 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33677 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33678 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33679 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33680 is created.
33681
33682 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33683 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33684 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33685 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33686 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33687 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33688 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33689
33690 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33691 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33692 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33693 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33694 then to be treated as a host error.
33695
33696 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33697 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33698 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33699 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33700 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33701
33702
33703
33704
33705 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33706 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33707 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33708 .cindex "inetd"
33709 .cindex "daemon"
33710 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33711 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33712 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33713 .code
33714 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33715 .endd
33716 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33717 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33718 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33719 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33720 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33721 stream and exits with an error code.
33722
33723 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33724 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33725 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33726 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33727
33728 .cindex "carriage return"
33729 .cindex "linefeed"
33730 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33731 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33732 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33733 line terminator.
33734 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33735 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33736 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33737
33738 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33739 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33740 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33741 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33742 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33743 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33744 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33745 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33746
33747 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33748 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33749 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33750 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33751 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33752 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33753 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33754 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33755 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33756
33757 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33758 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33759 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33760
33761 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33762 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33763 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33764 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33765 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33766
33767 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33768 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33769 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33770 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33771 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33772 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33773 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33774
33775 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33776 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33777 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33778 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33779 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33780
33781 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33782 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33783 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33784 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33785 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33786 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33787 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33788 a delivery process.
33789
33790 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33791 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33792 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33793 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33794 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33795
33796 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33797 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33798 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33799 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33800
33801 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33802 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33803 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33804
33805
33806
33807 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33808 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33809 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33810 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33811 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33812 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33813 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33814 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33815
33816
33817 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33818 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33819 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33820 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33821 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33822 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33823 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33824 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33825 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33826 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33827 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33828
33829
33830
33831 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33832 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33833 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33834 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33835 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33836 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33837 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33838 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33839
33840 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33841 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33842 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33843 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33844 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33845 counted.
33846
33847 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33848 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33849 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33850
33851 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33852 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33853 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33854 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33855 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33856
33857
33858
33859
33860 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33861 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33862 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33863 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33864 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33865
33866 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33867 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33868 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33869
33870 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33871 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33872 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33873 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33874 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33875 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33876 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33877 RCPT failures.
33878
33879
33880
33881 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33882 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33883 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33884 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33885 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33886 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33887 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33888
33889 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33890 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33891 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33892 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33893 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33894 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33895 argument. For example,
33896 .code
33897 ETRN #brigadoon
33898 .endd
33899 runs the command
33900 .code
33901 exim -R brigadoon
33902 .endd
33903 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33904 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33905 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33906 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33907 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33908
33909 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33910 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33911 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33912 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33913 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33914 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33915 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33916 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33917
33918 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33919 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33920 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33921 whatever the form of its argument. For
33922 example:
33923 .code
33924 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33925 $sender_host_address
33926 .endd
33927 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33928 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33929 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33930 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33931 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33932 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33933 for it to change them before running the command.
33934
33935
33936
33937 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33938 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33939 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33940 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33941 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33942 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33943 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33944 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33945 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33946 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33947 runs for RCPT commands:
33948 .code
33949 accept hosts = :
33950 .endd
33951 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33952
33953
33954
33955 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33956 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33957 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33958 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33959 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33960 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33961 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33962 envelope along with the message.
33963
33964 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33965 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33966 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33967 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33968 can be used to specify it.
33969
33970 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33971 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33972 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33973 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33974 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33975
33976 .vindex "&$host$&"
33977 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33978 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33979 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33980 router:
33981 .code
33982 begin routers
33983 route_append:
33984 driver = manualroute
33985 transport = smtp_appendfile
33986 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33987
33988 begin transports
33989 smtp_appendfile:
33990 driver = appendfile
33991 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33992 batch_max = 1000
33993 use_bsmtp
33994 user = exim
33995 .endd
33996 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33997 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33998 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33999
34000
34001
34002 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34003 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34004 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34005 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34006 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34007 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34008 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34009 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34010 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34011 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34012
34013 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34014 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34015
34016 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34017 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34018 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34019 make some use of automatically, for example:
34020 .code
34021 554 Unexpected end of file
34022 Transaction started in line 10
34023 Error detected in line 14
34024 .endd
34025 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34026 file, for example:
34027 .code
34028 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34029 The error message was:
34030
34031 501 '>' missing at end of address
34032
34033 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34034 The error was detected in line 12.
34035 The SMTP command at fault was:
34036
34037 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34038
34039 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34040 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34041 .endd
34042 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34043 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34044 accepted.
34045 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34046 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34047
34048
34049
34050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34052
34053 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34054 "Customizing messages"
34055 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34056 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34057 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34058 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34059 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34060
34061 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34062 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34063 option. Exim also adds the line
34064 .code
34065 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34066 .endd
34067 to all warning and bounce messages,
34068
34069
34070 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34071 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34072 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34073 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34074 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34075 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34076 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34077
34078 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34079 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34080 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34081 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34082 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34083 item.
34084
34085 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34086 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34087 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34088 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34089 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34090 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34091 option, rounded to a whole number.
34092
34093 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34094
34095 .ilist
34096 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34097 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34098 .next
34099 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34100 failing addresses with their error messages.
34101 .next
34102 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34103 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34104 .next
34105 .new
34106 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34107 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34108 .wen
34109 .endlist
34110
34111 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34112 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34113 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34114 .code
34115 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34116 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34117 {: returning message to sender}}
34118 ****
34119 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34120
34121 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34122 {that you sent }{sent by
34123
34124 <$sender_address>
34125
34126 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34127 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34128 ****
34129 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34130 ****
34131 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34132 ------
34133 ****
34134 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34135 only the first
34136 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34137 ****
34138 .endd
34139 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34140 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34141 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34142 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34143 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34144 text sections:
34145
34146 .ilist
34147 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34148 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34149 .next
34150 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34151 the delayed addresses.
34152 .next
34153 The third item then ends the message.
34154 .endlist
34155
34156 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34157 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34158 .code
34159 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34160 $warn_message_delay
34161 ****
34162 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34163
34164 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34165 {that you sent }{sent by
34166
34167 <$sender_address>
34168
34169 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34170 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34171
34172 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34173 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34174 The date of the message is: $h_date
34175
34176 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34177 ****
34178 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34179 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34180 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34181 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34182 the message will be returned to you.
34183 .endd
34184 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34185 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34186 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34187 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34188 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34189 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34190 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34191 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34192 handled them.
34193
34194
34195
34196
34197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34199
34200 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34201 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34202 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34203
34204
34205
34206 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34207 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34208 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34209 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34210 routing explicitly:
34211 .code
34212 send_to_smart_host:
34213 driver = manualroute
34214 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34215 transport = remote_smtp
34216 .endd
34217 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34218 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34219 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34220 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34221 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34222
34223
34224
34225
34226 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34227 .cindex "mailing lists"
34228 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34229 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34230 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34231
34232 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34233 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34234 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34235 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34236 .code
34237 lists:
34238 driver = redirect
34239 domains = lists.example
34240 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34241 forbid_pipe
34242 forbid_file
34243 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34244 no_more
34245 .endd
34246 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34247 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34248 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34249 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34250
34251 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34252 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34253 a mailing list.
34254
34255 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34256 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34257 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34258 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34259 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34260
34261 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34262 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34263 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34264 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34265 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34266 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34267 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34268 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34269 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34270
34271
34272
34273 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34274 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34275 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34276 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34277 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34278 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34279 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34280
34281 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34282 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34283 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34284 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34285 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34286
34287
34288
34289 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34290 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34291 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34292 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34293 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34294 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34295 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34296 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34297 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34298 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34299
34300 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34301 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34302 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34303 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34304 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34305 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34306 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34307 pre-existing messages.
34308
34309 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34310 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34311 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34312 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34313 one level of expansion anyway.
34314
34315
34316
34317 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34318 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34319 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34320 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34321 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34322 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34323
34324 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34325 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34326 .code
34327 lists_request:
34328 driver = redirect
34329 domains = lists.example
34330 local_part_suffix = -request
34331 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34332 no_more
34333
34334 lists_post:
34335 driver = redirect
34336 domains = lists.example
34337 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34338 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34339 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34340 forbid_pipe
34341 forbid_file
34342 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34343 no_more
34344
34345 lists_closed:
34346 driver = redirect
34347 domains = lists.example
34348 allow_fail
34349 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34350 .endd
34351 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34352 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34353 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34354 mailing list.
34355
34356 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34357 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34358 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34359 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34360 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34361 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34362 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34363 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34364 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34365
34366 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34367 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34368 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34369
34370
34371
34372
34373 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34374 .cindex "VERP"
34375 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34376 .cindex "envelope sender"
34377 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34378 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34379 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34380 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34381 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34382 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34383
34384 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34385 .oindex &%return_path%&
34386 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34387 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34388 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34389 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34390 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34391 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34392 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34393 .code
34394 verp_smtp:
34395 driver = smtp
34396 max_rcpt = 1
34397 return_path = \
34398 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34399 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34400 .endd
34401 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34402 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34403 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34404 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34405 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34406 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34407 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34408 rewritten as
34409 .code
34410 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34411 .endd
34412 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34413 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34414 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34415 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34416 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34417 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34418
34419 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34420 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34421 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34422 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34423 .code
34424 dnslookup:
34425 driver = dnslookup
34426 domains = ! +local_domains
34427 transport = \
34428 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34429 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34430 no_more
34431 .endd
34432 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34433 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34434 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34435 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34436 address.
34437
34438 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34439 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34440 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34441 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34442 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34443 .code
34444 verp_dnslookup:
34445 driver = dnslookup
34446 domains = ! +local_domains
34447 transport = remote_smtp
34448 errors_to = \
34449 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34450 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34451 no_more
34452 .endd
34453 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34454 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34455 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34456 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34457 them.
34458
34459 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34460 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34461 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34462 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34463 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34464 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34465 used).
34466
34467
34468
34469
34470
34471
34472 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34473 .cindex "virtual domains"
34474 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34475 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34476 meanings:
34477
34478 .ilist
34479 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34480 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34481 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34482 .next
34483 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34484 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34485 have login accounts on that host.
34486 .endlist
34487
34488 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34489 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34490 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34491 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34492 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34493 to a router of this form:
34494 .code
34495 virtual:
34496 driver = redirect
34497 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34498 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34499 no_more
34500 .endd
34501 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34502 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34503 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34504 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34505 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34506 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34507
34508 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34509 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34510 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34511 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34512
34513 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34514 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34515 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34516 .code
34517 my_domains:
34518 driver = accept
34519 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34520 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34521 transport = my_mailboxes
34522 .endd
34523 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34524 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34525 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34526 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34527 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34528 follows:
34529 .code
34530 my_mailboxes:
34531 driver = appendfile
34532 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34533 user = mail
34534 .endd
34535 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34536 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34537
34538 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34539 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34540 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34541 information about the domains.
34542
34543
34544
34545 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34546 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34547 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34548 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34549 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34550 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34551 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34552 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34553 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34554 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34555 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34556 example, consider this router:
34557 .code
34558 userforward:
34559 driver = redirect
34560 check_local_user
34561 file = $home/.forward
34562 local_part_suffix = -*
34563 local_part_suffix_optional
34564 allow_filter
34565 .endd
34566 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34567 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34568 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34569 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34570 .code
34571 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34572 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34573 endif
34574 .endd
34575 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34576 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34577 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34578 control over which suffixes are valid.
34579
34580 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34581 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34582 another MTA:
34583 .code
34584 userforward:
34585 driver = redirect
34586 check_local_user
34587 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34588 local_part_suffix = -*
34589 local_part_suffix_optional
34590 allow_filter
34591 .endd
34592 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34593 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34594 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34595 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34596 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34597
34598
34599
34600 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34601 .cindex "vacation processing"
34602 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34603 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34604 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34605 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34606 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34607
34608 .ilist
34609 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34610 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34611 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34612 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34613 .code
34614 spqr, vacation-spqr
34615 .endd
34616 .next
34617 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34618 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34619 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34620 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34621 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34622 message.
34623 .endlist
34624
34625 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34626 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34627
34628
34629
34630 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34631 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34632 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34633 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34634 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34635 each day's messages.
34636
34637 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34638 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34639 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34640 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34641
34642
34643
34644 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34645 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34646 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34647 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34648 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34649 permanently connected.
34650
34651 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34652 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34653 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34654
34655
34656 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34657 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34658 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34659 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34660 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34661 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34662 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34663 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34664
34665 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34666 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34667 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34668 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34669 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34670 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34671 if required.
34672
34673 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34674 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34675 intermittent host. For example:
34676 .code
34677 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34678 .endd
34679 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34680 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34681 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34682 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34683 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34684 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34685 immediately.
34686
34687 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34688 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34689 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34690 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34691 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34692 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34693 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34694
34695
34696
34697 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34698 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34699 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34700 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34701 delivered immediately.
34702
34703 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34704 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34705 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34706 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34707 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34708 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34709 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34710 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34711 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34712 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34713 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34714 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34715 single SMTP connection.
34716
34717
34718
34719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34721
34722 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34723 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34724 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34725 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34726 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34727 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34728 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34729 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34730 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34731 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34732 messages this way.
34733
34734 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34735 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34736 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34737 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34738 email is not desirable.
34739
34740 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34741 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34742 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34743 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34744 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34745 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34746 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34747
34748 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34749 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34750 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34751 before sending a message to the smart host.
34752
34753 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34754 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34755 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34756
34757 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34758 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34759 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34760 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34761 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34762 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34763 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34764
34765 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34766 following ways:
34767
34768 .ilist
34769 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34770 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34771 .next
34772 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34773 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34774 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34775 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34776 successful, a zero return code is given.
34777 .next
34778 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34779 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34780 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34781 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34782 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34783 are.
34784 .next
34785 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34786 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34787 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34788 .next
34789 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34790 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34791 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34792 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34793 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34794 .next
34795 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34796 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34797 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34798 .next
34799 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34800 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34801 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34802 are ever generated.
34803 .next
34804 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34805 .next
34806 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34807 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34808 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34809 .endlist
34810
34811 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34812 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34813 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34814 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34815 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34816 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34817
34818
34819
34820
34821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34823
34824 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34825 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34826 .cindex "log" "types of"
34827 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34828 and the panic log:
34829
34830 .ilist
34831 .cindex "main log"
34832 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34833 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34834 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34835 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34836 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34837 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34838 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34839 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34840 .next
34841 .cindex "reject log"
34842 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34843 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34844 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34845 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34846 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34847 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34848 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34849 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34850 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34851 false.
34852 .next
34853 .cindex "panic log"
34854 .cindex "system log"
34855 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34856 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34857 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34858 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34859 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34860 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34861 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34862 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34863 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34864 .endlist
34865
34866 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34867 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34868 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34869 .code
34870 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34871 by QUIT
34872 .endd
34873 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34874 ways of changing this:
34875
34876 .ilist
34877 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34878 you set
34879 .code
34880 timezone = UTC
34881 .endd
34882 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34883 .next
34884 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34885 example:
34886 .code
34887 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34888 .endd
34889 .endlist
34890
34891 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34892 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34893 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34894 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34895 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34896 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34897
34898
34899
34900
34901 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34902 .cindex "log" "destination"
34903 .cindex "log" "to file"
34904 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34905 .cindex "syslog"
34906 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34907 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34908 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34909 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34910 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34911 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34912 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34913
34914 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34915 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34916 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34917 references to the host name:
34918 .code
34919 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34920 .endd
34921 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34922 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34923 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34924 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34925 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34926 log at all.
34927
34928 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34929 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34930 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34931 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34932 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34933 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34934 implying the use of a default path.
34935
34936 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34937 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34938 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34939 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34940 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34941 equivalent to the setting:
34942 .code
34943 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34944 .endd
34945 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34946 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34947 that is where the logs are written.
34948
34949 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34950 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34951
34952 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34953 .display
34954 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34955 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34956 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34957 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34958 .endd
34959 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34960 error is logged.
34961
34962
34963
34964 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34965 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34966 .cindex "cycling logs"
34967 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34968 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34969 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34970 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34971 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34972 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34973 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34974
34975 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34976 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34977 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34978 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34979 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34980 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34981 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34982 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34983 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34984 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34985 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34986 renamed.
34987
34988
34989
34990 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34991 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34992 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34993 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34994 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34995 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34996 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34997 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34998 .code
34999 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35000 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35001 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35002 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35003 .endd
35004 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35005 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35006 .code
35007 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35008 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35009 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35010 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35011 .endd
35012 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35013 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35014 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35015 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35016
35017 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35018 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35019 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35020 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35021 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35022 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35023 log names:
35024 .code
35025 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35026 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35027 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35028 /var/log/exim/panic
35029 .endd
35030
35031
35032 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35033 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35034 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35035 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35036 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35037 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35038 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35039 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35040 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35041 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35042 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35043 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35044 the time and host name to each line.
35045 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35046
35047 .ilist
35048 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35049 .next
35050 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35051 .next
35052 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35053 .endlist
35054
35055 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35056 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35057 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35058 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35059
35060 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35061 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35062 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35063 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35064 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35065 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35066 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35067 RFC 3164, you should set
35068 .code
35069 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35070 .endd
35071 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35072 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35073
35074 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35075 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35076 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35077 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35078 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35079 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35080 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35081 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35082 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35083 .code
35084 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35085 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35086 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35087 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35088 [5/5] mple>)
35089 .endd
35090 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35091 (LOG_NOTICE):
35092 .code
35093 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35094 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35095 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35096 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35097 [5\18] .example>)
35098 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35099 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35100 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35101 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35102 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35103 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35104 [12\18] F From: <>
35105 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35106 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35107 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35108 [16\18] le>
35109 [17\18] B Bcc:
35110 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35111 .endd
35112 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35113 without modification.
35114
35115 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35116 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35117 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35118 where it is.
35119
35120
35121
35122 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35123 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35124 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35125 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35126 timestamp. The flags are:
35127 .display
35128 &`<=`& message arrival
35129 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35130 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35131 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35132 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35133 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35134 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35135 .endd
35136
35137
35138 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35139 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35140 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35141 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35142 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35143 .code
35144 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35145 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35146 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35147 .endd
35148 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35149 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35150 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35151 .code
35152 R=<message id>
35153 .endd
35154 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35155
35156 .cindex "HELO"
35157 .cindex "EHLO"
35158 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35159 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35160 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35161 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35162 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35163 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35164 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35165 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35166 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35167 name in parentheses.
35168
35169 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35170 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35171 the log containing text like these examples:
35172 .code
35173 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35174 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35175 .endd
35176 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35177 on.
35178
35179 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35180 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35181 of Exim.
35182
35183 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35184 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35185 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35186 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35187 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35188 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35189 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35190 suite that was used.
35191
35192 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35193 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35194 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35195 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35196 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35197 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35198 authenticator name.
35199
35200 .cindex "size" "of message"
35201 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35202 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35203 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35204 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35205 other).
35206
35207 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35208 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35209
35210
35211
35212 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35213 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35214 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35215 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35216 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35217 to fit it on the page:
35218 .code
35219 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35220 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35221 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35222 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35223 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35224 .endd
35225 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35226 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35227 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35228 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35229 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35230
35231 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35232 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35233 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35234 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35235
35236 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35237 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35238 .display
35239 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35240 .endd
35241 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35242 parentheses afterwards.
35243
35244 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35245 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35246 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35247 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35248 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35249 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35250
35251 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35252 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35253 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35254 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35255 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35256
35257 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35258 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35259
35260 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35261 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35262
35263
35264 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35265 .cindex "discarded messages"
35266 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35267 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35268 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35269 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35270 .code
35271 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35272 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35273 .endd
35274 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35275 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35276 .code
35277 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35278 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35279 .endd
35280
35281
35282 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35283 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35284 .code
35285 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35286 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35287 .endd
35288 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35289 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35290 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35291 .code
35292 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35293 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35294 .endd
35295 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35296 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35297 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35298
35299
35300
35301 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35302 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35303 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35304 following form is logged:
35305 .code
35306 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35307 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35308 .endd
35309 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35310 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35311 .code
35312 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35313 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35314 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35315 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35316 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35317 .endd
35318 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35319 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35320 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35321 flagged with &`**`&.
35322
35323
35324
35325 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35326 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35327 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35328 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35329 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35330
35331
35332
35333 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35334 A line of the form
35335 .code
35336 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35337 .endd
35338 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35339 at the end of its processing.
35340
35341
35342
35343
35344 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35345 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35346 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35347 the following table:
35348 .display
35349 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35350 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35351 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35352 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35353 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35354 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35355 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35356 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35357 &`H `& host name and IP address
35358 &`I `& local interface used
35359 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35360 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35361 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35362 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35363 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35364 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35365 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35366 &`S `& size of message
35367 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35368 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35369 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35370 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35371 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35372 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35373 .endd
35374
35375
35376 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35377 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35378 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35379
35380 .ilist
35381 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35382 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35383 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35384 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35385 during the first delivery attempt.
35386 .next
35387 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35388 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35389 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35390 .next
35391 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35392 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35393 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35394 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35395 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35396 doing.
35397 .next
35398 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35399 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35400 message:
35401 .olist
35402 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35403 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35404 .next
35405 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35406 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35407 .next
35408 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35409 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35410 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35411 .code
35412 errors_to = <>
35413 .endd
35414 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35415 .endlist olist
35416 .endlist ilist
35417
35418
35419
35420
35421
35422 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35423 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35424 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35425 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35426 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35427 example:
35428 .code
35429 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35430 .endd
35431 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35432 selection marked by asterisks:
35433 .display
35434 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35435 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35436 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35437 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35438 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35439 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35440 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35441 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35442 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35443 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35444 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35445 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35446 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35447 .new
35448 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35449 .wen
35450 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35451 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35452 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35453 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35454 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35455 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35456 &` pid `& Exim process id
35457 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35458 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35459 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35460 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35461 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35462 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35463 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35464 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35465 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35466 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35467 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35468 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35469 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35470 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35471 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35472 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35473 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35474 .new
35475 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35476 .wen
35477 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35478 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35479 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35480 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35481
35482 &` all `& all of the above
35483 .endd
35484 More details on each of these items follows:
35485
35486 .ilist
35487 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35488 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35489 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35490 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35491 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35492 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35493 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35494 .next
35495 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35496 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35497 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35498 this log selector is set.
35499 .next
35500 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35501 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35502 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35503 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35504 such users cannot access the log).
35505 .next
35506 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35507 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35508 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35509 parentheses between them.
35510 .next
35511 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35512 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35513 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35514 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35515 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35516 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35517 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35518 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35519 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35520 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35521 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35522 between the caller and Exim.
35523 .next
35524 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35525 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35526 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35527 .next
35528 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35529 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35530 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35531 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35532 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35533 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35534 .next
35535 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35536 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35537 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35538 .next
35539 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35540 .cindex "size" "of message"
35541 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35542 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35543 .next
35544 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35545 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35546 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35547 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35548 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35549 .next
35550 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35551 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35552 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35553 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35554 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35555 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35556 .next
35557 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35558 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35559 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35560 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35561 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35562 .next
35563 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35564 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35565 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35566 client's ident port times out.
35567 .next
35568 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35569 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35570 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35571 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35572 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35573 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35574 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35575 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35576 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35577 rejection lines
35578 .new
35579 and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35580 .wen
35581 .next
35582 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35583 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35584 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35585 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35586 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35587 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35588 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35589 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35590 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35591 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35592 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35593 .next
35594 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35595 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35596 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35597 .next
35598 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35599 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35600 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35601 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35602 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35603 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35604 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35605 .next
35606 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35607 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35608 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35609 immediately after the time and date.
35610 .next
35611 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35612 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35613 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35614 .next
35615 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35616 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35617 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35618 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35619 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35620 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35621 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35622 message has been successfully received.
35623 .next
35624 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35625 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35626 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35627 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35628 .next
35629 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35630 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35631 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35632 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35633 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35634 has taken place.
35635 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35636 in the list.
35637 .next
35638 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35639 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35640 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35641 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35642 .next
35643 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35644 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35645 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35646 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35647 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35648 .next
35649 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35650 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35651 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35652 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35653 attempt.
35654 .next
35655 .cindex "log" "return path"
35656 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35657 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35658 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35659 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35660 .next
35661 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35662 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35663 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35664 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35665 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35666 .next
35667 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35668 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35669 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35670 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35671 detail is lost.
35672 .next
35673 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35674 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35675 it is too big.
35676 .next
35677 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35678 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35679 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35680 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35681 it.
35682 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35683 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35684 .next
35685 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35686 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35687 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35688 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35689 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35690 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35691 response.
35692 .next
35693 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35694 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35695 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35696 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35697 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35698 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35699 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35700 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35701 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35702 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35703
35704 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35705 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35706 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35707 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35708 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35709 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35710 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35711 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35712 .next
35713 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35714 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35715 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35716 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35717 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35718 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35719 .next
35720 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35721 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35722 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35723 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35724 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35725 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35726 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35727 already have their own log lines.
35728
35729 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35730 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35731 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35732 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35733 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35734 the same logging options.
35735
35736 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35737 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35738 .code
35739 C=EHLO,QUIT
35740 .endd
35741 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35742 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35743 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35744 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35745 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35746 .next
35747 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35748 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35749 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35750 was accepted or used.
35751 .next
35752 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35753 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35754 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35755 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35756 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35757 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35758 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35759 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35760 .next
35761 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35762 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35763 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35764 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35765 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35766 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35767 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35768 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35769 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35770 .next
35771 .cindex "log" "subject"
35772 .cindex "subject, logging"
35773 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35774 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35775 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35776 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35777 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35778 .next
35779 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35780 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35781 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35782 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35783 .next
35784 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35785 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35786 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35787 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35788 .next
35789 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35790 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35791 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35792 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35793 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35794 .next
35795 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35796 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35797 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35798 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35799 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35800 .next
35801 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35802 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35803 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35804 .endlist
35805
35806
35807 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35808 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35809 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35810 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35811 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35812 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35813 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35814 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35815 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35816 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35817 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35818 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35819 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35820
35821 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35822 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35823 &%message_logs%& option false.
35824 .ecindex IIDloggen
35825
35826
35827
35828
35829 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35830 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35831
35832 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35833 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35834 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35835 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35836 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35837
35838 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35839 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35840 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35841 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35842 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35843 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35844 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35845 various criteria"
35846 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35847 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35848 "extract statistics from the log"
35849 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35850 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35851 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35852 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35853 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35854 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35855 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35856 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35857 .endtable
35858
35859 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35860 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35861 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35862
35863
35864
35865
35866 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35867 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35868 .cindex "process, querying"
35869 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35870 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35871 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35872 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35873 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35874 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35875 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35876 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35877 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35878
35879 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35880 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35881 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35882
35883
35884 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35885 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35886 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35887 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35888 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35889 options:
35890 .display
35891 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35892 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35893 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35894 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35895 .endd
35896 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35897 .code
35898 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35899 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35900 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35901 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35902 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35903 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35904 .endd
35905 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35906 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35907
35908
35909
35910 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35911 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35912 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35913 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35914 .code
35915 exim -bpu
35916 .endd
35917 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35918 .code
35919 exim -bp
35920 .endd
35921 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35922 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35923
35924 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35925 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35926
35927 .vlist
35928 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35929 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35930 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35931 .code
35932 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35933 .endd
35934 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35935 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35936 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35937
35938 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35939 Match against the size field.
35940
35941 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35942 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35943
35944 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35945 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35946
35947 .vitem &*-z*&
35948 Match only frozen messages.
35949
35950 .vitem &*-x*&
35951 Match only non-frozen messages.
35952 .endlist
35953
35954 The following options control the format of the output:
35955
35956 .vlist
35957 .vitem &*-c*&
35958 Display only the count of matching messages.
35959
35960 .vitem &*-l*&
35961 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35962 the default.
35963
35964 .vitem &*-i*&
35965 Display message ids only.
35966
35967 .vitem &*-b*&
35968 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35969
35970 .vitem &*-R*&
35971 Display messages in reverse order.
35972
35973 .vitem &*-a*&
35974 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35975 .endlist
35976
35977 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35978
35979
35980
35981 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35982 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35983 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35984 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35985 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35986 running a command such as
35987 .code
35988 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35989 .endd
35990 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35991 it, as in the following example:
35992 .code
35993 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35994 .endd
35995 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35996 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35997 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35998 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35999
36000 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36001 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36002 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36003 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36004 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36005 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36006 sender.
36007
36008 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36009 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36010 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36011 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36012 level"& addresses).
36013
36014
36015
36016
36017 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36018 "SECTextspeinf"
36019 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36020 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36021 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36022 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36023 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36024 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36025 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36026 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36027 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36028 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36029 .display
36030 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36031 .endd
36032 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36033
36034 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36035 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36036 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36037
36038 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36039 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36040 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36041 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36042 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36043
36044 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36045 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36046 regular expression.
36047
36048 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36049 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36050
36051 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36052 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36053 normally.
36054
36055 Example of &%-M%&:
36056 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36057 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36058 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36059 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36060 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36061 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36062 search term.
36063
36064 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36065 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36066 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36067 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36068 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36069
36070
36071 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36072 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36073 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36074 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36075 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36076 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36077 the &%--help%& option.
36078
36079
36080 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36081 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36082 .cindex "cycling logs"
36083 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36084 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36085 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36086 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36087 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36088 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36089 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36090 .ilist
36091 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36092 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36093 .next
36094 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36095 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36096 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36097 configuration.
36098 .endlist
36099
36100 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36101 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36102 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36103 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36104 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36105 logs are handled similarly.
36106
36107 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36108 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36109 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36110 any existing log files.
36111
36112 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36113 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36114 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36115 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36116 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36117 .code
36118 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36119 .endd
36120 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36121 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36122
36123
36124
36125 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36126 .cindex "statistics"
36127 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36128 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36129 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36130 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36131 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36132
36133 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36134 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36135 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36136 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36137 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36138 .code
36139 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36140 .endd
36141 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36142 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36143 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36144 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36145 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36146 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36147 also produced per user.
36148
36149 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36150 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36151 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36152 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36153 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36154
36155 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36156 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36157 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36158 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36159 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36160 an entirely separate message.
36161
36162 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36163 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36164 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36165 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36166 least one address that failed.
36167
36168 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36169 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36170 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36171 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36172 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36173 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36174 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36175
36176 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36177 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36178 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36179
36180 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36181 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36182 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36183 .code
36184 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36185 .endd
36186
36187 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36188 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36189 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36190 .cindex "checking access"
36191 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36192 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36193 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36194 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36195 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36196 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36197
36198 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36199 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36200 .code
36201 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36202 .endd
36203 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36204 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36205 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36206 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36207 .code
36208 Rejected:
36209 550 Relay not permitted
36210 .endd
36211 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36212 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36213 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36214 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36215 you can use:
36216 .code
36217 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36218 -f himself@there.example
36219 .endd
36220 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36221 mandatory arguments.
36222
36223 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36224 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36225 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36226
36227
36228
36229 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36230 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36231 .cindex "building DBM files"
36232 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36233 .cindex "lower casing"
36234 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36235 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36236 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36237 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36238 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36239 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36240
36241 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36242 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36243 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36244 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36245 files.
36246
36247 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36248 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36249 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36250 well.
36251
36252 .cindex "USE_DB"
36253 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36254 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36255 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36256 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36257 .code
36258 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36259 .endd
36260 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36261 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36262
36263 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36264 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36265 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36266 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36267 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36268 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36269
36270 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36271 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36272 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36273 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36274 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36275 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36276 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36277 return code is 2.
36278
36279
36280
36281
36282 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36283 .cindex "retry" "times"
36284 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36285 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36286 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36287 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36288 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36289 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36290 output. For example:
36291 .code
36292 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36293 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36294 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36295 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36296 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36297 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36298 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36299 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36300 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36301 past final cutoff time
36302 .endd
36303 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36304 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36305 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36306 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36307 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36308 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36309 run very often.
36310
36311 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36312 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36313 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36314 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36315 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36316 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36317
36318
36319
36320 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36321 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36322 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36323 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36324 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36325 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36326 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36327
36328 .ilist
36329 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36330 .next
36331 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36332 for remote hosts
36333 .next
36334 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36335 .next
36336 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36337 .next
36338 &'misc'&: other hints data
36339 .endlist
36340
36341 The &'misc'& database is used for
36342
36343 .ilist
36344 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36345 .next
36346 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36347 &(smtp)& transport)
36348 .endlist
36349
36350
36351
36352 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36353 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36354 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36355 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36356 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36357 .code
36358 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36359 .endd
36360 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36361 .code
36362 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36363 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36364 .endd
36365 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36366 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36367 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36368 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36369 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36370 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36371 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36372 and a textual description of the error.
36373
36374 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36375 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36376 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36377 exceeded.
36378
36379 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36380 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36381 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36382 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36383 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36384 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36385 cross-references.
36386
36387
36388
36389 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36390 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36391 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36392 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36393 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36394 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36395 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36396 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36397 updated sufficiently often.
36398
36399 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36400 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36401 the retry database:
36402 .code
36403 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36404 .endd
36405 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36406 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36407 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36408 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36409 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36410 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36411 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36412 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36413 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36414 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36415 whenever it removes information from the database.
36416
36417 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36418 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36419 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36420 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36421 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36422
36423 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36424 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36425 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36426 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36427 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36428 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36429 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36430 tidied.
36431
36432 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36433 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36434
36435
36436
36437
36438 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36439 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36440 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36441 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36442 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36443 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36444 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36445 displayed.
36446
36447 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36448 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36449 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36450 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36451 by new data, for example:
36452 .code
36453 > 4 951102:1000
36454 .endd
36455 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36456 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36457 used as optional separators.
36458
36459
36460
36461
36462 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36463 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36464 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36465 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36466 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36467 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36468 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36469 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36470 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36471 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36472 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36473 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36474 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36475
36476 .vlist
36477 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36478 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36479
36480 .vitem &%-flock%&
36481 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36482 supports it.
36483
36484 .vitem &%-interval%&
36485 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36486 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36487
36488 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36489 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36490
36491 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36492 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36493
36494 .vitem &%-q%&
36495 Suppress verification output.
36496
36497 .vitem &%-retries%&
36498 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36499 the lock (default 10).
36500
36501 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36502 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36503 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36504 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36505 subsequently sees.
36506
36507 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36508 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36509 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36510 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36511
36512 .vitem &%-v%&
36513 Generate verbose output.
36514 .endlist
36515
36516 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36517 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36518 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36519 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36520 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36521 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36522 more than 30 minutes old.
36523
36524 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36525 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36526 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36527 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36528 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36529 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36530
36531 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36532 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36533 suppresses all output except error messages.
36534
36535 A command such as
36536 .code
36537 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36538 .endd
36539 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36540 .display
36541 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36542 <&'some commands'&>
36543 &`End`&
36544 .endd
36545 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36546 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36547 such as
36548 .code
36549 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36550 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36551 .endd
36552 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36553 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36554 .ecindex IIDutils
36555
36556
36557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36559
36560 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36561 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36562 .cindex "X-windows"
36563 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36564 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36565 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36566 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36567 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36568 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36569 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36570 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36571
36572
36573
36574 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36575 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36576 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36577 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36578 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36579 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36580 parameters are for.
36581
36582 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36583 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36584 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36585 .code
36586 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36587 .endd
36588 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36589 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36590 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36591 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36592 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36593
36594 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36595 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36596 .code
36597 Eximon*background: gray94
36598 .endd
36599 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36600 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36601 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36602 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36603 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36604 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36605 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36606 .code
36607 xrdb -merge <<End
36608 Eximon*highlight: gray
36609 End
36610 .endd
36611 .cindex "admin user"
36612 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36613 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36614
36615 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36616 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36617 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36618 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36619 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36620
36621 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36622 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36623 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36624 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36625 different parts of the display.
36626
36627
36628
36629
36630 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36631 .cindex "stripchart"
36632 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36633 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36634 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36635 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36636 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36637 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36638 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36639 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36640 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36641
36642 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36643 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36644 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36645 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36646
36647 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36648 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36649 to a single partition.
36650
36651 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36652 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36653 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36654 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36655 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36656 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36657 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36658
36659
36660
36661
36662 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36663 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36664 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36665 .cindex "window size"
36666 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36667 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36668 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36669 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36670 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36671 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36672
36673 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36674 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36675 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36676 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36677
36678 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36679 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36680 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36681 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36682 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36683 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36684
36685 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36686 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36687 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36688
36689
36690
36691 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36692 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36693 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36694 the main log is maintained.
36695 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36696 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36697 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36698 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36699 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36700
36701 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36702 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36703 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36704 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36705 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36706 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36707 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36708 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36709 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36710 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36711 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36712
36713 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36714 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36715 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36716 It cannot go further back up the log.
36717
36718 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36719 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36720 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36721 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36722 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36723 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36724
36725 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36726 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36727 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36728 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36729 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36730 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36731
36732 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36733 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36734 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36735 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36736 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36737 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36738 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36739 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36740 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36741 window.
36742
36743
36744
36745 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36746 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36747 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36748 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36749 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36750 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36751 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36752 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36753 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36754 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36755
36756 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36757 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36758 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36759 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36760 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36761 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36762 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36763
36764 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36765 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36766 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36767 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36768 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36769 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36770 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36771
36772 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36773 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36774 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36775 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36776
36777 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36778 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36779 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36780 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36781 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36782 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36783 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36784 not shown.
36785
36786 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36787 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36788
36789 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36790 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36791 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36792 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36793 display is updated.
36794
36795
36796
36797 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36798 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36799 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36800 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36801 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36802 any selected text.
36803
36804 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36805 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36806 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36807 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36808 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36809 .code
36810 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36811 .endd
36812 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36813 follows:
36814
36815 .ilist
36816 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36817 in a new text window.
36818 .next
36819 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36820 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36821 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36822 .next
36823 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36824 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36825 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36826 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36827 .next
36828 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36829 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36830 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36831 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36832 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36833 .next
36834 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36835 that the message be frozen.
36836 .next
36837 .cindex "thawing messages"
36838 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36839 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36840 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36841 that the message be thawed.
36842 .next
36843 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36844 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36845 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36846 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36847 .next
36848 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36849 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36850 message.
36851 .next
36852 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36853 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36854 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36855 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36856 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36857 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36858 which case no action is taken.
36859 .next
36860 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36861 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36862 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36863 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36864 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36865 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36866 case no action is taken.
36867 .next
36868 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36869 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36870 .next
36871 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36872 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36873 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36874 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36875 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36876 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36877 the address is qualified with that domain.
36878 .endlist
36879
36880 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36881 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36882 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36883 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36884 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36885 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36886 if no output is generated.
36887
36888 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36889 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36890 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36891 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36892
36893 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36894 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36895 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36896 .ecindex IIDeximon
36897
36898
36899
36900
36901
36902 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36904
36905 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36906 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36907 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36908 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36909
36910 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36911 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36912 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36913 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36914 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36915 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36916
36917 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36918 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36919 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36920 as soon as possible.
36921
36922
36923 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36924 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36925 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36926 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36927 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36928 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36929
36930 .ilist
36931 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36932 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36933 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36934 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36935 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36936 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36937
36938 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36939 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36940 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36941 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36942 .next
36943
36944 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36945 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36946 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36947 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36948 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36949 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36950 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36951 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36952 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36953 separate commands.
36954
36955 .next
36956 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36957 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36958 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36959 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36960 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36961 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36962 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36963 .next
36964 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36965 is disabled.
36966 .next
36967 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36968 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36969 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36970 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36971 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36972 .endlist
36973
36974
36975
36976 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36977 .cindex "setuid"
36978 .cindex "root privilege"
36979 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36980 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36981 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36982 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36983 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36984 is required for two things:
36985
36986 .ilist
36987 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36988 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36989 not required.
36990 .next
36991 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36992 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36993 configuration.
36994 .endlist
36995
36996 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36997 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36998 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36999 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37000 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37001 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37002 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37003 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37004
37005 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37006 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37007 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37008
37009 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37010 uid and gid in the following cases:
37011
37012 .ilist
37013 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37014 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37015 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37016 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37017 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37018 the calling process.
37019 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37020 option may not be used at all.
37021 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37022 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37023 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37024 .next
37025 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37026 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37027 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37028 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37029 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37030 calling process.
37031 .next
37032 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37033 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37034 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37035 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37036 testing address verification
37037 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37038 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37039 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37040 option).
37041 .next
37042 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37043 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37044 .endlist
37045
37046 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37047
37048 .ilist
37049 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37050 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37051 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37052 will be used during message reception.
37053 .next
37054 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37055 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37056 .next
37057 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37058 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37059 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37060 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37061 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37062 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37063 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37064 generating bounce and warning messages.
37065
37066 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37067 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37068 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37069 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37070 .next
37071 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37072 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37073 .endlist
37074
37075
37076
37077
37078 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37079 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37080 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37081 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37082 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37083 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37084 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37085 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37086 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37087 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37088 to any other uid.
37089
37090 .cindex SIGHUP
37091 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37092 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37093 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37094 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37095
37096 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37097 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37098 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37099 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37100 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37101
37102 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37103 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37104 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37105 effect.
37106
37107 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37108 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37109 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37110
37111 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37112 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37113 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37114 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37115 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37116 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37117 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37118 address this problem at this time.
37119
37120 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37121 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37122 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37123 be used in the most straightforward way.
37124
37125 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37126 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37127
37128 .ilist
37129 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37130 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37131 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37132 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37133 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37134 .next
37135 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37136 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37137 .next
37138 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37139 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37140 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37141 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37142 .next
37143 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37144 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37145
37146 .olist
37147 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37148 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37149 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37150 .next
37151 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37152 owned by the Exim user.
37153 .next
37154 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37155 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37156 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37157 .endlist olist
37158 .endlist ilist
37159
37160
37161 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37162 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37163 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37164 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37165
37166 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37167 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37168
37169
37170
37171
37172 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37173 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37174 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37175
37176
37177
37178 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37179 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37180 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37181 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37182 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37183 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37184 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37185
37186 .ilist
37187 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37188 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37189 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37190 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37191 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37192 .next
37193 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37194 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37195 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37196 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37197 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37198 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37199 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37200 .next
37201 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37202 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37203 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37204 .next
37205 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37206 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37207 .next
37208 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37209 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37210 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37211 .next
37212 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37213 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37214 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37215 of opaque strings.
37216 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37217 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37218 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37219 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37220 .endlist
37221
37222
37223
37224
37225 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37226 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37227 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37228 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37229 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37230 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37231 are some issues to be aware of:
37232
37233 .ilist
37234 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37235 .next
37236 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37237 .next
37238 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37239 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37240 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37241 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37242 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37243 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37244 data.
37245 .next
37246 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37247 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37248 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37249 .next
37250 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37251 expected to yield one result.
37252 .endlist
37253
37254
37255
37256
37257 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37258 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37259 .cindex "IP source routing"
37260 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37261 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37262 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37263 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37264
37265
37266
37267 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37268 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37269 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37270
37271
37272
37273
37274 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37275 .cindex "trusted users"
37276 .cindex "admin user"
37277 .cindex "privileged user"
37278 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37279 .cindex "user" "admin"
37280 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37281 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37282 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37283 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37284 permit a remote host to be specified.
37285
37286 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37287 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37288 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37289 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37290 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37291 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37292 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37293
37294 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37295 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37296 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37297 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37298 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37299
37300 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37301 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37302 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37303 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37304 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37305
37306 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37307 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37308 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37309 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37310 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37311 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37312 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37313 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37314
37315 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37316 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37317 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37318 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37319 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37320 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37321 files.
37322
37323
37324
37325 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37326 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37327 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37328 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37329 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37330 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37331
37332
37333
37334 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37335 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37336 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37337 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37338 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37339 this.
37340
37341
37342
37343 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37344 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37345 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37346 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37347 converted output.
37348
37349
37350
37351 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37352 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37353 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37354 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37355 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37356
37357
37358
37359 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37360 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37361 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37362 loading it.
37363
37364
37365 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37366 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37367 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37368 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37369 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37370 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37371 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37372
37373 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37374 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37375 string.
37376
37377
37378
37379 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37380 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37381 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37382 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37383
37384
37385
37386 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37387 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37388 enough to hold the result.
37389 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37390
37391
37392
37393
37394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37396
37397 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37398 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37399 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37400 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37401 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37402 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37403 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37404 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37405 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37406 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37407 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37408 themselves are recoverable.
37409
37410 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37411 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37412 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37413
37414 .ilist
37415 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37416 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37417 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37418 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37419 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37420 .next
37421 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37422 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37423 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37424 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37425 will always be the case.
37426 .next
37427 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37428 .next
37429 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37430 signature.
37431 .endlist
37432 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37433
37434 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37435 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37436 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37437 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37438 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37439 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37440 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37441 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37442 attempt.
37443
37444 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37445 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37446 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37447 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37448 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37449 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37450 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37451 normally the Exim user.
37452
37453 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37454 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37455 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37456 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37457 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37458 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37459 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37460 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37461
37462 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37463 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37464 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37465 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37466
37467 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37468 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37469
37470 .vlist
37471 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37472 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37473 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37474 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37475 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37476 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37477 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37478 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37479 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37480 newlines.
37481
37482 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37483 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37484 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37485 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37486 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37487 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37488
37489 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37490 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37491 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37492 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37493 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37494 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37495
37496 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37497 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37498 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37499
37500 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37501 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37502 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37503 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37504 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37505
37506 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37507 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37508 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37509 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37510 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37511
37512 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37513 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37514 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37515
37516 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37517 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37518 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37519
37520 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37521 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37522 present.
37523
37524 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37525 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37526 present if the number is greater than zero.
37527
37528 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37529 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37530 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37531
37532 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37533 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37534 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37535
37536 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37537 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37538 command.
37539
37540 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37541 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37542 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37543 messages.
37544
37545 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37546 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37547 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37548 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37549
37550 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37551 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37552 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37553
37554 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37555 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37556 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37557 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37558 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37559 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37560
37561 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37562 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37563 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37564 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37565 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37566
37567 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37568 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37569 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37570 generated messages.
37571
37572 .vitem &%-local%&
37573 The message is from a local sender.
37574
37575 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37576 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37577
37578 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37579 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37580 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37581 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37582
37583 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37584 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37585 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37586
37587 .vitem &%-N%&
37588 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37589 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37590 &%-N%& is assumed.
37591
37592 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37593 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37594 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37595
37596 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37597 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37598 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37599
37600 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37601 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37602 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37603
37604 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37605 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37606 certificate was verified by the server.
37607
37608 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37609 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37610 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37611
37612 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37613 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37614 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37615 certificate.
37616 .endlist
37617
37618 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37619 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37620 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37621 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37622 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37623 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37624 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37625 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37626 addresses are complete.
37627
37628 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37629 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37630 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37631 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37632 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37633 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37634 .code
37635 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37636 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37637 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37638 .endd
37639 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37640 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37641 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37642 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37643 example:
37644 .code
37645 4
37646 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37647 darcy@austen.fict.example
37648 rdo@foundation
37649 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37650 .endd
37651 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37652 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37653 line is of the following form:
37654 .display
37655 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37656 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37657 .endd
37658 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37659 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37660 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37661 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37662 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37663 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37664 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37665 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37666
37667
37668 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37669 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37670 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37671 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37672 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37673 following:
37674
37675 .table2 50pt
37676 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37677 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37678 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37679 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37680 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37681 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37682 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37683 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37684 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37685 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37686 .endtable
37687
37688 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37689 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37690 typical set of headers:
37691 .code
37692 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37693 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37694 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37695 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37696 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37697 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37698 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37699 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37700 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37701 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37702 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37703 .endd
37704 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37705 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37706 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37707 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37708 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37709 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37710
37711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37713
37714 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37715 "DKIM Support"
37716 .cindex "DKIM"
37717
37718 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37719 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37720 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37721 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37722
37723 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37724 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37725
37726 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37727 .olist
37728 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37729 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37730 (including transport filters)
37731 except cutthrough delivery.
37732 .next
37733 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37734 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37735 different signature contexts.
37736 .endlist
37737
37738 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37739 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37740 Exim's standard controls.
37741
37742 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37743 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37744 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37745 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37746 .code
37747 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37748 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37749 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37750 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37751 .endd
37752 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37753 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37754 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37755 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37756 senders).
37757
37758
37759 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37760 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37761
37762 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37763 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37764
37765 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37766 MANDATORY:
37767 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37768 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37769
37770 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37771 MANDATORY:
37772 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37773 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37774 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37775 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37776
37777 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37778 MANDATORY:
37779 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37780 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37781 The result can either
37782 .ilist
37783 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37784 .next
37785 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37786 the private key.
37787 .next
37788 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37789 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37790 is set.
37791 .endlist
37792
37793 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37794 OPTIONAL:
37795 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37796 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37797 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37798 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37799
37800 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37801 OPTIONAL:
37802 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37803 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37804 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37805 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37806 variables here.
37807
37808 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37809 OPTIONAL:
37810 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37811 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37812 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37813 used.
37814
37815
37816 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37817 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37818
37819 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37820 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37821 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37822 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37823 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37824 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37825 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37826
37827 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37828 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37829 runtime of the ACL.
37830
37831 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37832 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37833 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37834 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37835
37836 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37837 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37838 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37839 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37840 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37841 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37842 it defaults as:
37843 .code
37844 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37845 .endd
37846 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37847 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37848 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37849 .code
37850 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37851 .endd
37852 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37853 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37854 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37855 .code
37856 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37857 .endd
37858
37859 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37860 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37861
37862
37863 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37864 available (from most to least important):
37865
37866
37867 .vlist
37868 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37869 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37870 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37871 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37872 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37873 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37874 .ilist
37875 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37876 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37877 .next
37878 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37879 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37880 .next
37881 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37882 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37883 .next
37884 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37885 .endlist
37886 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37887 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37888 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37889 .ilist
37890 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37891 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37892 .next
37893 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37894 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37895 .next
37896 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37897 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37898 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37899 .next
37900 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37901 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37902 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37903 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37904 .endlist
37905 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37906 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37907 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37908 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37909 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37910 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37911 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37912 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37913 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37914 The key record selector string.
37915 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37916 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37917 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37918 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37919 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37920 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37921 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37922 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37923 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37924 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37925 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37926 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37927 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37928 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37929 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37930 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37931 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37932 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37933 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37934 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37935 integer size comparisons against this value.
37936 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37937 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37938 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37939 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37940 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37941 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37942 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37943 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37944 in the key record.
37945 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37946 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37947 in the key record.
37948 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37949 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37950 .endlist
37951
37952 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37953
37954 .vlist
37955 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37956 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37957 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37958 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37959 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37960
37961 .code
37962 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37963 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37964 sender_domains = gmail.com
37965 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37966 dkim_status = none
37967 .endd
37968
37969 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37970 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37971 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37972 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37973
37974 .code
37975 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37976 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37977 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37978 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37979 .endd
37980
37981 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37982 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37983 for more information of what they mean.
37984 .endlist
37985
37986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37988
37989 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37990 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37991 .cindex "adding drivers"
37992 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37993 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37994 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37995 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37996
37997 .olist
37998 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37999 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38000 .next
38001 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38002 .display
38003 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38004 .endd
38005 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38006 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38007 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38008 .next
38009 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38010 .code
38011 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38012 .endd
38013 .next
38014 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38015 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38016 .next
38017 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38018 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38019 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38020 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38021 simple form that most lookups have.
38022 .next
38023 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38024 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38025 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38026 .next
38027 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38028 &_src_&.
38029 .next
38030 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38031 as for other drivers and lookups.
38032 .endlist
38033
38034 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38035 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38036 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38037 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38038 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38039
38040 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38041 the interface that is expected.
38042
38043
38044
38045
38046 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38048
38049 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38050 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38051 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38052 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38053 . processors.
38054 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38055
38056 .literal xml
38057 <?sdop
38058 format="newpage"
38059 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38060 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38061 ?>
38062 .literal off
38063
38064 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38065 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38066 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38067
38068
38069 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38070 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////